CROSS-REFERENCE TO RELATED APPLICATIONS
[0001] This non-provisional patent application is a continuation-in-part application under
35 U.S.C. §120 of
U.S. Patent Application Ser. No. 13/097,891, entitled "Tissue Thickness Compensator For A Surgical Stapler Comprising An Adjustable
Anvil", filed on April 29, 2011, which is a continuation-in-part application under
35 U.S.C. §120 of
U.S. Patent Application Ser. No. 12/894,377, entitled "Selectively Orientable Implantable Fastener Cartridge", filed on September
30, 2010, the entire disclosures of which are hereby incorporated by reference herein.
BACKGROUND
[0002] The present invention relates to surgical instruments and, in various embodiments,
to surgical cutting and stapling instruments and staple cartridges therefor that are
designed to cut and staple tissue.
SUMMARY
[0003] The following is a non-exhaustive list of embodiments of the present invention that
are or may be claimed.
- 1. A fastener cartridge assembly for a surgical instrument, the fastener cartridge
assembly comprising:
a support portion comprising a fastener cavity;
a nonwoven compensator positioned relative to the support portion, wherein the nonwoven
compensator comprises a plurality of spring fibers dispersed throughout; and
a fastener moveable between an initial position and a fired position, wherein the
fastener is at least partially positioned in the fastener cavity when the fastener
is in its initial position, and wherein the fastener is configured to compress the
nonwoven compensator when the fastener is moved between its initial position and its
fired position.
- 2. The fastener cartridge assembly of Embodiment 1, wherein at least one spring fiber
comprises a resilient material, and wherein the spring fiber is deformed when the
fastener compresses the nonwoven compensator.
- 3. The fastener cartridge assembly of Embodiment 1 or Embodiment 2, wherein the fastener
comprises:
a base;
a first leg extending from the base; and
a second leg extending from the base, wherein the first leg and the second leg are
configured to bend towards the base when the fastener is moved to its fired position;
wherein the fastener captures a portion of the nonwoven compensator between the base
and at least one of the first leg and the second leg when the fastener is moved to
its fired position.
- 4. The fastener cartridge assembly of Embodiment 3, further comprising:
a slot extending through at least a portion of the support portion; and
a firing member configured to translate within the slot, wherein the firing member
is configured to engage the base of the fastener as the firing member translates such
that the fastener is ejected from the fastener cavity.
- 5. The fastener cartridge assembly of any preceding Embodiment, wherein the nonwoven
compensator is releasably attached to a deck of the support portion by an adhesive.
- 6. The fastener cartridge assembly of any preceding Embodiment, wherein the spring
fibers are randomly dispersed and randomly oriented throughout the nonwoven compensator.
- 7. The fastener cartridge assembly of any preceding Embodiment, wherein the nonwoven
compensator comprises a plurality of non-spring fibers.
- 8. The fastener cartridge assembly of any preceding Embodiment, wherein the spring
fibers comprise a synthetic bioabsorbable material.
- 9. The fastener cartridge assembly of any preceding Embodiment, wherein the spring
fibers comprise a material selected from a group comprising poly(dioxanone) (PDO),
polylactides (PLA), polyglycolides (PGA), polycaprolactones (PCL), polycarbonates,
and their copolymers.
- 10. The fastener cartridge assembly of any preceding Embodiment, wherein the spring
fibers are heat formed to hold a substantially coil-like shape.
- 11. The fastener cartridge assembly of any preceding Embodiment, wherein the nonwoven
compensator is needle punched and comprises a haemostatic material.
- 12. A fastener cartridge for a surgical instrument, the fastener cartridge comprising:
a body comprising a first body portion and a second body portion, wherein the first
body portion comprises fastener cavities, wherein the second body portion comprises
a compressible portion, wherein the compressible portion comprises a plurality of
spring fibers dispersed throughout, and wherein the spring fibers are at least partially
resilient; and
fasteners, wherein each fastener is aligned with a fastener cavity of the first body
portion.
- 13. The fastener cartridge of Embodiment 12, wherein at least one fastener is moveable
between an initial position and a fired position, and wherein the fastener is configured
to compress a portion of the compressible portion when the fastener is moved to its
fired position.
- 14. The fastener cartridge of Embodiment 13, wherein the compressible portion comprises
a homogeneous absorbable polymer matrix.
- 15. The fastener cartridge of any one of Embodiments 12-14 further comprising:
a slot extending through at least a portion of the first body portion; and
a firing member configured to translate within the slot, wherein the firing member
is configured to engage at least one fastener as the firing member translates such
that the firing member ejects the at least one fastener from the first body portion.
- 16. An end effector assembly for a surgical instrument, the end effector assembly
comprising:
an anvil;
a fastener cartridge comprising:
a cartridge body comprising a fastener cavity; and
a fastener, wherein the fastener is at least partially positioned in a fastener cavity
when the fastener is in an initial position; and
a nonwoven compensator positioned intermediate the fastener cartridge and the anvil,
wherein the nonwoven compensator comprises a plurality of spring fibers dispersed
throughout, and wherein the spring fibers are at least partially resilient.
- 17. The end effector assembly of Embodiment 16, wherein the nonwoven compensator is
releasably secured to at least one of the fastener cartridge and the anvil, and wherein
the nonwoven compensator comprises a nonwoven material.
- 18. The end effector assembly of Embodiment 17, wherein the fastener is moveable from
its initial position to a fired position, and wherein the fastener is configured to
compress a portion of the nonwoven compensator when the fastener is moved to its fired
position.
- 19. The end effector assembly of Embodiment 18, wherein the anvil comprises a forming
pocket in a tissue contacting surface, and wherein the forming pocket deforms the
fastener when the fastener is moved from its initial position to its fired position.
- 20. The end effector assembly of Embodiment 18 or Embodiment 19, wherein the nonwoven
compensator is configured to disengage from the end effector assembly when the fastener
compresses the said portion of the nonwoven compensator.
BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE DRAWINGS
[0004] The features and advantages of this invention, and the manner of attaining them,
will become more apparent and the invention itself will be better understood by reference
to the following description of embodiments of the invention taken in conjunction
with the accompanying drawings, wherein:
[0005] FIG. 1 is a cross-sectional view of a surgical instrument embodiment;
[0006] FIG. 1A is a perspective view of one embodiment of an implantable staple cartridge;
[0007] FIGS. 1B-1E illustrate portions of an end effector clamping and stapling tissue with
an implantable staple cartridge;
[0008] FIG. 2 is a partial cross-sectional side view of another end effector coupled to
a portion of a surgical instrument with the end effector supporting a surgical staple
cartridge and with the anvil thereof in an open position;
[0009] FIG. 3 is another partial cross-sectional side view of the end effector of FIG. 2
in a closed position;
[0010] FIG. 4 is another partial cross-sectional side view of the end effector of FIGS.
2 and 3 as the knife bar is starting to advance through the end effector;
[0011] FIG. 5 is another partial cross-sectional side view of the end effector of FIGS.
2-4 with the knife bar partially advanced therethrough;
[0012] FIGS. 6A-6D diagram the deformation of a surgical staple positioned within a collapsible
staple cartridge body in accordance with at least one embodiment;
[0013] FIG. 7A is a diagram illustrating a staple positioned in a crushable staple cartridge
body;
[0014] FIG. 7B is a diagram illustrating the crushable staple cartridge body of FIG. 7A
being crushed by an anvil;
[0015] FIG. 7C is a diagram illustrating the crushable staple cartridge body of FIG. 7A
being further crushed by the anvil;
[0016] FIG. 7D is a diagram illustrating the staple of FIG. 7A in a fully formed configuration
and the crushable staple cartridge of FIG. 7A in a fully crushed condition;
[0017] FIG. 8 is a top view of a staple cartridge in accordance with at least one embodiment
comprising staples embedded in a collapsible staple cartridge body;
[0018] FIG. 9 is an elevational view of the staple cartridge of FIG. 8;
[0019] FIG. 10 is an exploded perspective view of an alternative embodiment of a compressible
staple cartridge comprising staples therein and a system for driving the staples against
an anvil;
[0020] FIG. 10A is a partial cut-away view of an alternative embodiment of the staple cartridge
of FIG. 10;
[0021] FIG. 11 is a cross-sectional view of the staple cartridge of FIG. 10;
[0022] FIG. 12 is an elevational view of a sled configured to traverse the staple cartridge
of FIG. 10 and move the staples to toward the anvil;
[0023] FIG. 13 is a diagram of a staple driver which can be lifted toward the anvil by the
sled of FIG. 12;
[0024] FIG. 14 is a perspective view of a staple cartridge comprising a rigid support portion
and a compressible tissue thickness compensator for use with a surgical stapling instrument
in accordance with at least one embodiment of the invention;
[0025] FIG. 15 is a partially exploded view of the staple cartridge of FIG. 14;
[0026] FIG. 16 is a fully exploded view of the staple cartridge of FIG. 14;
[0027] FIG. 17 is another exploded view of the staple cartridge of FIG. 14 without a warp
covering the tissue thickness compensator;
[0028] FIG. 18 is a perspective view of a cartridge body, or support portion, of the staple
cartridge of FIG. 14;
[0029] FIG. 19 is a top perspective view of a sled movable within the staple cartridge of
FIG. 14 to deploy staples from the staple cartridge;
[0030] FIG. 20 is a bottom perspective view of the sled of FIG. 19;
[0031] FIG. 21 is an elevational view of the sled of FIG. 19;
[0032] FIG. 22 is a top perspective view of a driver configured to support one or more staples
and to be lifted upwardly by the sled of FIG. 19 to eject the staples from the staple
cartridge;
[0033] FIG. 23 is a bottom perspective view of the driver of FIG. 22;
[0034] FIG. 24 is a wrap configured to at least partially surround a compressible tissue
thickness compensator of a staple cartridge;
[0035] FIG. 25 is a partial cut away view of a staple cartridge comprising a rigid support
portion and a compressible tissue thickness compensator illustrated with staples being
moved from an unfired position to a fired position during a first sequence;
[0036] FIG. 26 is an elevational view of the staple cartridge of FIG. 25;
[0037] FIG. 27 is a detail elevational view of the staple cartridge of FIG. 25;
[0038] FIG. 28 is a cross-sectional end view of the staple cartridge of FIG. 25;
[0039] FIG. 29 is a bottom view of the staple cartridge of FIG. 25;
[0040] FIG. 30 is a detail bottom view of the staple cartridge of FIG. 25;
[0041] FIG. 31 is a longitudinal cross-sectional view of an anvil in a closed position and
a staple cartridge comprising a rigid support portion and a compressible tissue thickness
compensator illustrated with staples being moved from an unfired position to a fired
position during a first sequence;
[0042] FIG. 32 is another cross-sectional view of the anvil and the staple cartridge of
FIG. 31 illustrating the anvil in an open position after the firing sequence has been
completed;
[0043] FIG. 33 is a partial detail view of the staple cartridge of FIG. 31 illustrating
the staples in an unfired position;
[0044] FIG. 34 is a cross-sectional elevational view of a staple cartridge comprising a
rigid support portion and a compressible tissue thickness compensator illustrating
the staples in an unfired position;
[0045] FIG. 35 is a detail view of the staple cartridge of FIG. 34;
[0046] FIG. 36 is an elevational view of an anvil in an open position and a staple cartridge
comprising a rigid support portion and a compressible tissue thickness compensator
illustrating the staples in an unfired position;
[0047] FIG. 37 is an elevational view of an anvil in a closed position and a staple cartridge
comprising a rigid support portion and a compressible tissue thickness compensator
illustrating the staples in an unfired position and tissue captured between the anvil
and the tissue thickness compensator;
[0048] FIG. 38 is a detail view of the anvil and staple cartridge of FIG. 37;
[0049] FIG. 39 is an elevational view of an anvil in a closed position and a staple cartridge
comprising a rigid support portion and a compressible tissue thickness compensator
illustrating the staples in an unfired position illustrating thicker tissue positioned
between the anvil and the staple cartridge;
[0050] FIG. 40 is a detail view of the anvil and staple cartridge of FIG. 39;
[0051] FIG. 41 is an elevational view of the anvil and staple cartridge of FIG. 39 illustrating
tissue having different thicknesses positioned between the anvil and the staple cartridge;
[0052] FIG. 42 is a detail view of the anvil and staple cartridge of FIG. 39 as illustrated
in FIG. 41;
[0053] FIG. 43 is a diagram illustrating a tissue thickness compensator which is compensating
for different tissue thickness captured within different staples;
[0054] FIG. 44 is a diagram illustrating a tissue thickness compensator applying a compressive
pressure to one or more vessels that have been transected by a staple line;
[0055] FIG. 45 is a diagram illustrating a circumstance wherein one or more staples have
been improperly formed;
[0056] FIG. 46 is a diagram illustrating a tissue thickness compensator which could compensate
for improperly formed staples;
[0057] FIG. 47 is a diagram illustrating a tissue thickness compensator positioned in a
region of tissue in which multiple staples lines have intersected;
[0058] FIG. 48 is a diagram illustrating tissue captured within a staple;
[0059] FIG. 49 is a diagram illustrating tissue and a tissue thickness compensator captured
within a staple;
[0060] FIG. 50 is a diagram illustrating tissue captured within a staple;
[0061] FIG. 51 is a diagram illustrating thick tissue and a tissue thickness compensator
captured within a staple;
[0062] FIG. 52 is a diagram illustrating thin tissue and a tissue thickness compensator
captured within a staple;
[0063] FIG. 53 is a diagram illustrating tissue having an intermediate thickness and a tissue
thickness compensator captured within a staple;
[0064] FIG. 54 is a diagram illustrating tissue having another intermediate thickness and
a tissue thickness compensator captured within a staple;
[0065] FIG. 55 is a diagram illustrating thick tissue and a tissue thickness compensator
captured within a staple;
[0066] FIG. 56 is a partial cross-sectional view of an end effector of a surgical stapling
instrument illustrating a firing bar and staple-firing sled in a retracted, unfired
position;
[0067] FIG. 57 is another partial cross-sectional view of the end effector of FIG. 56 illustrating
the firing bar and the staple-firing sled in a partially advanced position;
[0068] FIG. 58 is a cross-sectional view of the end effector of FIG. 56 illustrating the
firing bar in a fully advanced, or fired, position;
[0069] FIG. 59 is a cross-sectional view of the end effector of FIG. 56 illustrating the
firing bar in a retracted position after being fired and the staple-firing sled left
in its fully fired position;
[0070] FIG. 60 is a detail view of the firing bar in the retracted position of FIG. 59;
[0071] FIG. 61 is a perspective view of a tissue thickness compensator in an end effector
of a surgical instrument according to at least one embodiment;
[0072] FIG. 62 is a detail view of nonwoven material of the tissue thickness compensator
of FIG. 61;
[0073] FIG. 63 is an elevational view depicting the tissue thickness compensator of FIG.
61 implanted against tissue and released from the end effector;
[0074] FIG. 64 is a detail view of nonwoven material of a tissue thickness compensator according
to at least one embodiment;
[0075] FIG. 65 is a schematic depicting clusters of randomly oriented crimped fibers according
to at least one embodiment;
[0076] FIG. 66 is a schematic depicting a cluster of randomly oriented crimped fibers according
to at least one embodiment;
[0077] FIG. 67 is a schematic depicting an arrangement of crimped fibers according to at
least one embodiment;
[0078] FIG. 68 is a schematic depicting an arrangement of crimped fibers according to at
least one embodiment;
[0079] FIG. 69 is a schematic depicting an arrangement of crimped fibers according to at
least one embodiment;
[0080] FIG. 70 is a plan cross-sectional view of coiled fibers in a tissue thickness compensator
according to at least one embodiment;
[0081] FIG. 70A is a plan cross-sectional view of the coiled fibers of FIG. 70;
[0082] FIG. 70B is a cross-sectional detail view of the tissue thickness compensator of
FIG. 70;
[0083] FIG. 71 is a perspective view of a tissue thickness compensator in an end effector
of a surgical instrument according to at least one embodiment;
[0084] FIG. 72 is a diagram depicting deformation of the tissue thickness compensator of
FIG. 71;
[0085] FIG. 73 is a schematic of woven suture for a tissue thickness compensator depicting
the woven suture in a loaded configuration according to at least one embodiment;
[0086] FIG. 74 is a schematic of the woven suture of FIG. 73 depicting the woven suture
in a released configuration;
[0087] FIG. 75 is a plan view of a tissue thickness compensator having the woven suture
of FIG. 73 in an end effector of a surgical instrument;
[0088] FIG. 76 is a perspective view of a tissue thickness compensator in an end effector
of a surgical instrument according to at least one embodiment;
[0089] FIG. 77 is a partial plan view of the tissue thickness compensator of FIG. 76;
[0090] FIG. 78 is an exploded view of the fastener cartridge assembly of the end effector
and tissue thickness compensator of FIG. 61;
[0091] FIG. 79 is a partial cross-sectional view of the fastener cartridge assembly of FIG.
78 depicting unfired, partially fired, and fired fasteners;
[0092] FIG. 80 is an elevational view of the fastener cartridge assembly of FIG. 78 depicting
a driver firing fasteners from staple cavities of the fastener cartridge assembly
into the tissue thickness compensator;
[0093] FIG. 81 is a detail view of the fastener cartridge assembly of FIG. 80;
[0094] FIG. 82 is an elevational view of the tissue thickness compensator of FIG. 61 and
tissue captured within fired fasteners;
[0095] FIG. 83 is an elevational view of the tissue thickness compensator of FIG. 61 and
tissue captured within fired fasteners;
[0096] FIG. 84 is a perspective view of a tissue thickness compensator in an end effector
of a surgical instrument according to at least one embodiment;
[0097] FIG. 85 is a diagram depicting deformation of a deformable tube of the tissue thickness
compensator of FIG. 84;
[0098] FIG. 86 is a detail view of the deformable tube of the tissue thickness compensator
of FIG. 84;
[0099] FIG. 87 is a diagram depicting deformation of a deformable tube of a tissue thickness
compensator according to at least one embodiment;
[0100] FIG. 88 is an elevational view of a tissue thickness compensator comprising a tubular
element implanted against tissue according to at least one embodiment;
[0101] FIG. 89 is an elevational view of a tissue thickness compensator comprising tubular
elements implanted against tissue according to at least one embodiment;
[0102] FIG. 90 is a partial perspective view of a deformable tube comprising a tubular lattice
according to at least one embodiment;
[0103] FIG. 91 is an elevational view of a tubular strand of the deformable tube of FIG.
90.
[0104] FIG. 92 is an elevational view of the deformable tube of FIG. 90;
[0105] FIG. 93 is an elevational view of multiple tubular strands for the deformable tube
of FIG. 90 according to various embodiments;
[0106] FIG. 94 is an elevational view of the tubular lattice of FIG. 90 implanted against
tissue;
[0107] FIG. 95 is a partial perspective view of a deformable tube according to at least
one embodiment;
[0108] FIG. 96 is a partial perspective view of a deformable tube according to at least
one embodiment;
[0109] FIG. 97 is a partial perspective view of a deformable tube according to at least
one embodiment;
[0110] FIG. 98 is an elevational view of the deformable tube of FIG. 97;
[0111] FIG. 99 is a partial perspective view of a deformable tube according to at least
one embodiment;
[0112] FIG. 100 is a partial perspective view of a deformable tube according to at least
one embodiment;
[0113] FIG. 101 is a partial perspective view of a deformable tube according to at least
one embodiment;
[0114] FIG. 102 is a perspective view of a tissue thickness compensator positioned in an
end effector of a surgical instrument according to at least one embodiment;
[0115] FIG. 103 is an elevational view of a tubular element of the tissue thickness compensator
of FIG. 102;
[0116] FIG. 104 is an elevational cross-sectional view of the tissue thickness compensator
and the end effector of FIG. 102 depicting the end effector in an unclamped configuration;
[0117] FIG. 105 is an elevational cross-sectional view of the tissue thickness compensator
and the end effector of FIG. 102 depicting the end effector in a clamped and fired
configuration;
[0118] FIG. 106 is an elevational cross-sectional view of a tissue thickness compensator
positioned in an end effector of a surgical instrument according to at least one embodiment;
[0119] FIG. 107 is an elevational cross-sectional view of the tissue thickness compensator
and the end effector of FIG. 106 depicting the end effector in a clamped and fired
configuration;
[0120] FIG. 108 is an elevational cross-sectional view of a tissue thickness compensator
in the end effector of a surgical instrument according to at least one embodiment;
[0121] FIG. 109 is a cross-sectional elevational view of a tissue thickness compensator
positioned in an end effector of a surgical instrument according to at least one embodiment;
[0122] FIG. 110 is a cross-sectional elevational view of the tissue thickness compensator
and the end effector of FIG. 109 depicting the end effector in a clamped and fired
configuration;
[0123] FIG. 111 is a perspective view of a tissue thickness compensator positioned in an
end effector of a surgical instrument according to at least one embodiment;
[0124] FIG. 112 is an elevational cross-sectional view of a tissue thickness compensator
positioned in an end effector of a surgical instrument according to at least one embodiment;
[0125] FIG. 113 is an elevational cross-sectional view of a tissue thickness compensator
positioned in an end effector of a surgical instrument according to at least one embodiment;
[0126] FIG. 114 is an elevational cross-sectional view of a tissue thickness compensator
positioned in an end effector of a surgical instrument according to at least one embodiment;
[0127] FIG. 115 is an elevational cross-sectional view of a tissue thickness compensator
positioned in an end effector of a surgical instrument according to at least one embodiment;
[0128] FIG. 116 is a partial plan view of a tissue thickness compensator positioned in an
end effector of a surgical instrument according to at least one embodiment;
[0129] FIG. 117 is a partial plan view of a tissue thickness compensator positioned in an
end effector of a surgical instrument according to at least one embodiment;
[0130] FIG. 118 is a partial elevational cross-sectional view of the tissue thickness compensator
and the end effector of FIG. 116 depicting the end effector in an unclamped configuration;
[0131] FIG. 119 is a partial elevational cross-sectional view of the tissue thickness compensator
and the end effector of FIG. 116 depicting the end effector in a clamped configuration;
[0132] FIG. 120 is a perspective view of a tissue thickness compensator in an end effector
of a surgical instrument according to at least one embodiment;
[0133] FIG. 121 is an elevational view of the tissue thickness compensator and the end effector
of FIG. 120;
[0134] FIG. 122 is a perspective view of the tissue thickness compensator and the end effector
of FIG. 120 depicting the anvil of the end effector moving towards a clamped configuration;
[0135] FIG. 123 is an elevational view of the tissue thickness compensator and the end effector
of FIG. 120 depicting the end effector in a clamped configuration;
[0136] FIG. 124 is an elevational cross-sectional view of tubular elements of the tissue
thickness compensator of FIG. 120 in an undeformed configuration;
[0137] FIG. 125 is an elevational cross-sectional view of tubular elements of the tissue
thickness compensator of FIG. 120 in a deformed configuration;
[0138] FIG. 126 is a perspective view of a tissue thickness compensator in an end effector
of a surgical instrument according to at least one embodiment;
[0139] FIG. 127 is an elevational cross-sectional view of the tissue thickness compensator
and the end effector of FIG. 126 depicting the end effector in a clamped configuration;
[0140] FIG. 128 is an elevational cross-sectional view of the tissue thickness compensator
and the end effector of FIG. 126 depicting the end effector in a fired and partially
unclamped configuration;
[0141] FIG. 129 is a perspective view of a tissue thickness compensator positioned in an
end effector of a surgical instrument according to at least one embodiment;
[0142] FIG. 130 is an elevational cross-sectional view of a tissue thickness compensator
secured to an anvil of an end effector of a surgical instrument according to at least
one embodiment;
[0143] FIG. 131 is an elevational cross-sectional view of the tissue thickness compensator
and the end effector of FIG. 130 depicting the end effector in a clamped configuration;
[0144] FIG. 132 is an elevational cross-sectional view of the tissue thickness compensator
and the end effector of FIG. 130 depicting the end effector in a fired and partially
unclamped configuration;
[0145] FIG. 133 is a detail view of the tissue thickness compensator and the end effector
of FIG. 132;
[0146] FIG. 134 is an elevational cross-sectional view of a tissue thickness compensator
clamped in an end effector of a surgical instrument depicting deployment of staples
by a staple-firing sled according to at least one embodiment;
[0147] FIG. 135 is an elevational cross-sectional view of the tissue thickness compensator
and the end effector of FIG. 134 depicting the end effector in a clamped configuration;
[0148] FIG. 136 is an elevational cross-sectional view of the tissue thickness compensator
and the end effector of FIG. 134 depicting the end effector in a fired configuration;
[0149] FIG. 137 is a perspective view of a tissue thickness compensator in an end effector
of a surgical instrument according to at least one embodiment;
[0150] FIG. 138 is a perspective view of a tubular element of the tissue thickness compensator
of FIG. 137;
[0151] FIG. 139 is a perspective view of the tubular element of FIG. 138 severed between
a first and second end;
[0152] FIG. 140 is a perspective view of the tissue thickness compensator of FIG. 137 depicting
a cutting element severing the tissue thickness compensator and staples engaging the
tissue thickness compensator;
[0153] FIG. 141 is perspective view of a frame configured to make the tissue thickness compensator
of FIG. 137 according to at least one embodiment;
[0154] FIG. 142 is an elevational cross-sectional view of the frame of FIG. 141 depicting
the tissue thickness compensator of FIG. 137 curing in the frame;
[0155] FIG. 143 is an elevational cross-sectional view of the tissue thickness compensator
removed from the frame of FIG. 142 and prepared for trimming by at least one cutting
instrument;
[0156] FIG. 144 is an elevational cross-sectional view of the tissue thickness compensator
of FIG. 143 after at least one cutting instrument has trimmed the tissue thickness
compensator;
[0157] FIG. 145 is an elevational cross-sectional view of the tissue thickness compensator
formed in the frame of FIG. 142 depicting severable tubes having various cross-sectional
geometries;
[0158] FIG. 146 is a perspective view of a tissue thickness compensator in an end effector
of a surgical instrument according to at least one embodiment;
[0159] FIG. 147 is a detail view of the tissue thickness compensator of FIG. 146 according
to at least one embodiment;
[0160] FIG. 148 is a partial perspective view of a tissue thickness compensator according
to at least one embodiment;
[0161] FIG. 149 is a partial perspective view of a tissue thickness compensator according
to at least one embodiment;
[0162] FIG. 150A is an elevational cross-sectional view of the tissue thickness compensator
and the end effector of FIG. 146 depicting the end effector in an unclamped configuration;
[0163] FIG. 150B is an elevational cross-sectional view of the tissue thickness compensator
and the end effector of FIG. 146 depicting the end effector in a clamped configuration;
[0164] FIG. 150C is an elevational cross-sectional view of the tissue thickness compensator
and the end effector of FIG. 146 depicting the end effector in a clamped and fired
configuration;
[0165] FIG. 150D is an elevational cross-sectional view of the tissue thickness compensator
of FIG. 146 captured in fired staples;
[0166] FIG. 150E is an elevational cross-sectional view of the tissue thickness compensator
of FIG. 146 captured in fired staples depicting further expansion of the tissue thickness
compensator;
[0167] FIG. 151 is a perspective cross-sectional view of a tissue thickness compensator
in an end effector of a surgical instrument according to at least one embodiment;
[0168] FIG. 152 is a partial elevational view of the tissue thickness compensator of FIG.
151 captured in a fired staple;
[0169] FIG. 153 is an elevational view of a deformable tube of the tissue thickness compensator
of FIG. 151;
[0170] FIG. 154 is an elevational view of a deformable tube according to at least one embodiment;
[0171] FIG. 155 is a perspective cross-sectional view of the tissue thickness compensator
of FIG. 151;
[0172] FIG. 156 is a perspective cross-sectional view of a tissue thickness compensator
in an end effector of a surgical instrument according to at least one embodiment;
[0173] FIG. 157 is a perspective view of a tissue thickness compensator according to at
least one embodiment;
[0174] FIG. 158 is a partial elevational cross-sectional view of the tissue thickness compensator
of FIG. 157 depicting a fastener engaged with tissue and with the tissue thickness
compensator;
[0175] FIG. 159 is a perspective cross-sectional view of a tissue thickness compensator
according to at least one embodiment;
[0176] FIG. 160 is an elevational view of a tissue thickness compensator according to at
least one embodiment;
[0177] FIG. 161 is an elevational view of a tissue thickness compensator according to at
least one embodiment;
[0178] FIG. 162 is an elevational view of a tissue thickness compensator positioned in a
circular end effector of a surgical instrument according to at least one embodiment;
[0179] FIG. 163 is an elevational view of a tissue thickness compensator according to at
least one embodiment;
[0180] FIG. 164 is an elevational view of a tissue thickness compensator according to at
least one embodiment;
[0181] FIG. 165 is an elevational view of a tissue thickness compensator according to at
least one embodiment;
[0182] FIG. 166 is an elevational view of a tissue thickness compensator according to at
least one embodiment;
[0183] FIG. 167 is an elevational view of a tissue thickness compensator according to at
least one embodiment;
[0184] FIG. 168 is a partial perspective view of a tissue thickness compensator according
to at least one embodiment;
[0185] FIG. 169 is a partial perspective view of a tissue thickness compensator positioned
in an end effector of a surgical instrument according to at least one embodiment;
[0186] FIG. 170 is a partial perspective view of a tissue thickness compensator with a fastener
positioned in the apertures thereof according to at least one embodiment;
[0187] FIG. 171 is a partial perspective view of the tissue thickness compensator of FIG.
169 depicting the tissue thickness compensator in an undeformed configuration;
[0188] FIG. 172 is a partial perspective view of the tissue thickness compensator of FIG.
169 depicting the tissue thickness compensator in a partially deformed configuration;
[0189] FIG. 173 is a partial perspective view of the tissue thickness compensator of FIG.
169 depicting the tissue thickness compensator in a deformed configuration;
[0190] FIG. 174 is a perspective view of a tissue thickness compensator according to at
least one embodiment;
[0191] FIG. 175 is a perspective view of an end effector of a stapling instrument comprising
an anvil and a staple cartridge in accordance with at least one embodiment;
[0192] FIG. 176 is a cross-sectional view of the end effector of FIG. 175 illustrating staples
positioned within the staple cartridge in an unfired state and a tissue thickness
compensator comprising a sealed vessel in an unpunctured state, wherein the vessel
is depicted with portions thereof removed for the purposes of illustration;
[0193] FIG. 177 is a cross-sectional view of the end effector of FIG. 175 illustrating the
staples of FIG. 176 in an at least partially fired state and the vessel in an at least
partially punctured state;
[0194] FIG. 178 is a perspective view of an end effector of a stapling instrument comprising
an anvil and a staple cartridge in accordance with at least one embodiment;
[0195] FIG. 179 is a cross-sectional view of the end effector of FIG. 178 illustrating staples
positioned within the staple cartridge in an unfired state and sealed vessels positioned
within a tissue thickness compensator of the staple cartridge in an unpunctured state,
wherein the vessels are depicted with portions thereof removed for the purposes of
illustration;
[0196] FIG. 180 is a cross-sectional view of the end effector of FIG. 178 illustrating the
staples of FIG. 179 in an at least partially fired state and the vessels in the staple
cartridge in an at least partially punctured state;
[0197] FIG. 181 is a perspective view of an end effector of a stapling instrument comprising
an anvil and a sealed vessel attached to the anvil in accordance with at least one
alternative embodiment wherein the vessel is depicted with portions thereof removed
for the purposes of illustration;
[0198] FIG. 182 is a cross-sectional view of the end effector of FIG. 181 illustrating staples
at least partially fired from a staple cartridge and the vessels attached to the anvil
in an at least partially punctured state;
[0199] FIG. 183 is a cross-sectional view of the vessel attached to the anvil of FIG. 181
illustrated in an expanded state;
[0200] FIG. 184 is a detail view of the vessel attached to the anvil of FIG. 183 illustrated
in an expanded state;
[0201] FIG. 185 illustrates a vessel extending in a direction transverse to a line of staples;
[0202] FIG. 186 illustrates a plurality of vessels extending in directions which are transverse
to a line of staples;
[0203] FIG. 187 is a cross-sectional view of a staple cartridge in accordance with various
embodiments;
[0204] FIG. 188 is a partial cross-section view of FIG. 187 in an implanted condition;
[0205] FIG. 189A is a partial perspective view of a tissue thickness compensator prior to
expansion;
[0206] FIG. 189B is a partial perspective view of a tissue thickness compensator of FIG.
189 during expansion;
[0207] FIG. 190 is a partial perspective view of a tissue thickness compensator comprising
a fluid swellable composition according to various embodiments;
[0208] FIG. 191 is a cross-sectional view of tissue positioned adjacent a tissue thickness
compensator according to various embodiments;
[0209] FIG. 192 is a partial cross-sectional view of FIG. 191 after the staple cartridge
has been fired;
[0210] FIG. 193 is a diagram illustrating the tissue thickness compensator of FIG. 191 implanted
adjacent the tissue;
[0211] FIG. 194 is a partial perspective view of a tissue thickness compensator according
to various embodiments;
[0212] FIG. 195 is a perspective view of a jaw configured to receive the tissue thickness
compensator of FIG. 194;
[0213] FIG. 196 is a partial cross-sectional view of a staple cartridge illustrating staples
being deployed from the staple cartridge;
[0214] FIG. 197 is a perspective view of an upper tissue thickness compensator and a lower
tissue thickness compensator positioned within an effector of a disposable loading
unit;
[0215] FIG. 198A is a cross-sectional view of the lower tissue thickness compensator of
FIG. 197 being manufactured in a mold in accordance with various embodiments;
[0216] FIG. 198B is a cross-sectional view of a trilayer tissue thickness compensator being
manufactured in a mold in accordance with various embodiments;
[0217] FIG. 199 is a cross-sectional view of an anvil comprising a tissue thickness compensator
comprising reinforcement material in accordance with various embodiments;
[0218] FIG. 200 is cross-sectional view of a tissue positioned intermediate the upper tissue
thickness compensator and lower tissue thickness compensator in accordance with various
embodiments;
[0219] FIG. 201 is a cross-sectional view of FIG. 200 illustrating staples being deployed
from the staple cartridge;
[0220] FIG. 202 is a cross-sectional view of FIG. 200 after the staple cartridge has been
fired;
[0221] FIG. 203A illustrates a needle configured to deliver a fluid to a tissue thickness
compensator attached to a staple cartridge according to various embodiments;
[0222] FIG. 203B is a cross-sectional view of a staple cartridge comprising a tissue thickness
compensator configured to receive the needle of FIG. 203A;
[0223] FIG. 204 illustrates a method of manufacturing a tissue thickness compensator according
to various embodiments;
[0224] FIG. 205 is a diagram and a method of forming an expanding thickness compensator
according to various embodiments;
[0225] FIG. 206 illustrates a micelle comprising a hydrogel precursor; and
[0226] FIG. 207 is a diagram of a surgical instrument comprising a tissue thickness compensator
and fluids that may be delivered to the tissue thickness compensator according to
various embodiments.
[0227] FIG. 208 is a partial perspective view of a tissue thickness compensator secured
to an anvil of an end effector of a surgical instrument according to at least one
embodiment.
[0228] FIG. 209 is a perspective view of a tubular element of the tissue thickness compensator
of FIG. 208.
[0229] FIG. 210 is a perspective view of the tubular element of FIG. 209 depicting the tubular
element severed into two halves and fluid contacting the hydrophilic substance within
each half.
[0230] FIG. 211 is a perspective view of a half of the severed tubular element of FIG. 210
depicting expansion of the severed tubular element.
[0231] Corresponding reference characters indicate corresponding parts throughout the several
views. The exemplifications set out herein illustrate certain embodiments of the invention,
in one form, and such exemplifications are not to be construed as limiting the scope
of the invention in any manner.
DETAILED DESCRIPTION
[0232] The Applicant of the present application also owns the U.S. Patent Applications identified
below which are each herein incorporated by reference in their respective entirety:
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 12/894,311, entitled SURGICAL INSTRUMENTS WITH RECONFIGURABLE SHAFT SEGMENTS (Attorney Docket
No. END6734USNP/100058);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 12/894,340, entitled SURGICAL STAPLE CARTRIDGES SUPPORTING NON-LINEARLY ARRANGED STAPLES AND
SURGICAL STAPLING INSTRUMENTS WITH COMMON STAPLE-FORMING POCKETS (Attorney Docket
No. END6735USNP/100059);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 12/894,327, entitled JAW CLOSURE ARRANGEMENTS FOR SURGICAL INSTRUMENTS (Attorney Docket No.
END6736USNP/100060);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 12/894,351, entitled SURGICAL CUTTING AND FASTENING INSTRUMENTS WITH SEPARATE AND DISTINCT FASTENER
DEPLOYMENT AND TISSUE CUTTING SYSTEMS (Attorney Docket No. END6839USNP/100524);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 12/894,338, entitled IMPLANTABLE FASTENER CARTRIDGE HAVING A NON-UNIFORM ARRANGEMENT (Attorney
Docket No. END6840USNP/100525);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 12/894,369, entitled IMPLANTABLE FASTENER CARTRIDGE COMPRISING A SUPPORT RETAINER (Attorney
Docket No. END6841USNP/100526);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 12/894,312, entitled IMPLANTABLE FASTENER CARTRIDGE COMPRISING MULTIPLE LAYERS (Attorney Docket
No. END6842USNP/100527);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 12/894,377, entitled SELECTIVELY ORIENTABLE IMPLANTABLE FASTENER CARTRIDGE (Attorney Docket
No. END6843USNP/100528);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 12/894,339, entitled SURGICAL STAPLING INSTRUMENT WITH COMPACT ARTICULATION CONTROL ARRANGEMENT
(Attorney Docket No. END6847USNP/100532);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 12/894,360, entitled SURGICAL STAPLING INSTRUMENT WITH A VARIABLE STAPLE FORMING SYSTEM (Attorney
Docket No. END6848USNP/100533);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 12/894,322, entitled SURGICAL STAPLING INSTRUMENT WITH INTERCHANGEABLE STAPLE CARTRIDGE ARRANGEMENTS
(Attorney Docket No. END6849USNP/100534);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 12/894,350, entitled SURGICAL STAPLE CARTRIDGES WITH DETACHABLE SUPPORT STRUCTURES AND SURGICAL
STAPLING INSTRUMENTS WITH SYSTEMS FOR PREVENTING ACTUATION MOTIONS WHEN A CARTRIDGE
IS NOT PRESENT (Attorney Docket No. END6855USNP/100540);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 12/894,383, entitled IMPLANTABLE FASTENER CARTRIDGE COMPRISING BIOABSORBABLE LAYERS (Attorney
Docket No. END6856USNP/100541);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 12/894,389, entitled COMPRESSIBLE FASTENER CARTRIDGE (Attorney Docket No. END6857USNP/100542);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 12/894,345, entitled FASTENERS SUPPORTED BY A FASTENER CARTRIDGE SUPPORT (Attorney Docket No.
END6858USNP/100543);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 12/894,306, entitled COLLAPSIBLE FASTENER CARTRIDGE (Attorney Docket No. END6859USNP/100544);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 12/894,318, entitled FASTENER SYSTEM COMPRISING A PLURALITY OF CONNECTED RETENTION MATRIX ELEMENTS
(Attorney Docket No. END6860USNP/100546);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 12/894,330, entitled FASTENER SYSTEM COMPRISING A RETENTION MATRIX AND AN ALIGNMENT MATRIX (Attorney
Docket No. END6861USNP/100547);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 12/894,361, entitled FASTENER SYSTEM COMPRISING A RETENTION MATRIX (Attorney Docket No. END6862USNP/100548);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 12/894,367, entitled FASTENING INSTRUMENT FOR DEPLOYING A FASTENER SYSTEM COMPRISING A RETENTION
MATRIX (Attorney Docket No. END6863USNP/100549);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 12/894,388, entitled FASTENER SYSTEM COMPRISING A RETENTION MATRIX AND A COVER (Attorney Docket
No. END6864USNP/100550);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 12/894,376, entitled FASTENER SYSTEM COMPRISING A PLURALITY OF FASTENER CARTRIDGES (Attorney
Docket No. END6865USNP/100551);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 13/097,865, entitled SURGICAL STAPLER ANVIL COMPRISING A PLURALITY OF FORMING POCKETS (Attorney
Docket No. END6735USCIP1/100059CIP1);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 13/097,936, entitled TISSUE THICKNESS COMPENSATOR FOR A SURGICAL STAPLER (Attorney Docket No.
END6736USCIP1/100060CIP1);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 13/097,954, entitled STAPLE CARTRIDGE COMPRISING A VARIABLE THICKNESS COMPRESSIBLE PORTION (Attorney
Docket No. END6840USCIP1/100525CIP1);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 13/097,856, entitled STAPLE CARTRIDGE COMPRISING STAPLES POSITIONED WITHIN A COMPRESSIBLE PORTION
THEREOF (Attorney Docket No. END6841USCIP1/100526CIP1);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 13/097,928, entitled TISSUE THICKNESS COMPENSATOR COMPRISING DETACHABLE PORTIONS (Attorney Docket
No. END6842USCIP1/100527CIP1);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 13/097,891, entitled TISSUE THICKNESS COMPENSATOR FOR A SURGICAL STAPLER COMPRISING AN ADJUSTABLE
ANVIL (Attorney Docket No. END6843USCIP1/100528CIP1);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 13/097,948, entitled STAPLE CARTRIDGE COMPRISING AN ADJUSTABLE DISTAL PORTION (Attorney Docket
No. END6847USCIP1/100532CIP1);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 13/097,907, entitled COMPRESSIBLE STAPLE CARTRIDGE ASSEMBLY (Attorney Docket No. END6848USCIP1/100533CIP1);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 13/097,861, entitled TISSUE THICKNESS COMPENSATOR COMPRISING PORTIONS HAVING DIFFERENT PROPERTIES
(Attorney Docket No. END6849USCIP1/100534CIP1);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 13/097,869, entitled STAPLE CARTRIDGE LOADING ASSEMBLY (Attorney Docket No. END6855USCIP1/100540CIP1);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 13/097,917, entitled COMPRESSIBLE STAPLE CARTRIDGE COMPRISING ALIGNMENT MEMBERS (Attorney Docket
No. END6856USCIP1/100541CIP1);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 13/097,873, entitled STAPLE CARTRIDGE COMPRISING A RELEASABLE PORTION (Attorney Docket No. END6857USCIP1/100542CIP1);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 13/097,938, entitled STAPLE CARTRIDGE COMPRISING COMPRESSIBLE DISTORTION RESISTANT COMPONENTS
(Attorney Docket No. END6858USCIP1/100543CIP1);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 13/097,924, entitled STAPLE CARTRIDGE COMPRISING A TISSUE THICKNESS COMPENSATOR (Attorney Docket
No. END6859USCIP1/100544CIP1);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 13/242,029, entitled SURGICAL STAPLER WITH FLOATING ANVIL (Attorney Docket No. END6841USCIP2/100526CIP2);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 13/242,066, entitled CURVED END EFFECTOR FOR A STAPLING INSTRUMENT (Attorney Docket No. END6841USCIP3/100526CIP3);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 13/242,086, entitled STAPLE CARTRIDGE INCLUDING COLLAPSIBLE DECK (Attorney Docket No. END7020USNP/110374);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 13/241,912, entitled STAPLE CARTRIDGE INCLUDING COLLAPSIBLE DECK ARRANGEMENT (Attorney Docket
No. END7019USNP/110375);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 13/241,922, entitled SURGICAL STAPLER WITH STATIONARY STAPLE DRIVERS (Attorney Docket No. END7013USNP/110377);
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 13/241,637, entitled SURGICAL INSTRUMENT WITH TRIGGER ASSEMBLY FOR GENERATING MULTIPLE ACTUATION
MOTIONS (Attorney Docket No. END6888USNP3/110378); and
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 13/241,629, entitled SURGICAL INSTRUMENT WITH SELECTIVELY ARTICULATABLE END EFFECTOR (Attorney
Docket No. END6888USNP2/110379).
[0233] The Applicant of the present application also owns the U.S. Patent Applications identified
below which were filed on even date herewith and which are each herein incorporated
by reference in their respective entirety:
U.S. Application Serial No. ____________, entitled TISSUE THICKNESS COMPENSATOR COMPRISING
A PLURALITY OF CAPSULES, (Attorney Docket No. END6864USCIP1/100550CIP1);
U.S. Application Serial No. ____________, entitled TISSUE THICKNESS COMPENSATOR COMPRISING
A PLURALITY OF LAYERS, (Attorney Docket No. END6864USCIP2/100550CIP2);
U.S. Application Serial No. ____________, entitled EXPANDABLE TISSUE THICKNESS COMPENSATOR,
(Attorney Docket No. END6843USCIP2/100528CIP2).
U.S. Application Serial No. ____________, entitled TISSUE THICKNESS COMPENSATOR COMPRISING
A RESERVOIR, (Attorney Docket No. END6843USCIP3/100528CIP3);
U.S. Application Serial No. ____________, entitled RETAINER ASSEMBLY INCLUDING A TISSUE
THICKNESS COMPENSATOR, (Attorney Docket No. END6843USCIP4/100528CIP4);
U.S. Application Serial No. ____________, entitled TISSUE THICKNESS COMPENSATOR COMPRISING
AT LEAST ONE MEDICAMENT, (Attorney Docket No. END6843USCIPS/100528CIP5);
U.S. Application Serial No. ____________, entitled TISSUE THICKNESS COMPENSATOR COMPRISING
CONTROLLED RELEASE AND EXPANSION, (Attorney Docket No. END6843USCIP6/100528CIP6);
U.S. Application Serial No. ____________, entitled TISSUE THICKNESS COMPENSATOR COMPRISING
STRUCTURE TO PRODUCE A RESILIENT LOAD, (Attorney Docket No. END6843USCIP8/100528CIP8);
U.S. Application Serial No. ____________, entitled TISSUE THICKNESS COMPENSATOR COMPRISING
RESILIENT MEMBERS, (Attorney Docket No. END6843USCIP9/100528CIP9);
U.S. Application Serial No. ___________, entitled METHODS FOR FORMING TISSUE THICKNESS
COMPENSATOR ARRANGEMENTS FOR SURGICAL STAPLERS, (Attorney Docket No. END6843USCIP10/100528CP10);
U.S. Application Serial No. ____________, entitled TISSUE THICKNESS COMPENSATORS,
(Attorney Docket No. END6843USCIP11/100528CP11);
U.S. Application Serial No. ____________, entitled LAYERED TISSUE THICKNESS COMPENSATOR,
(Attorney Docket No. END6843USCIP12/100528CP12);
U.S. Application Serial No. ____________, entitled TISSUE THICKNESS COMPENSATORS FOR
CIRCULAR SURGICAL STAPLERS, (Attorney Docket No. END6843USCIP13/100528CP13);
U.S. Application Serial No. ____________, entitled TISSUE THICKNESS COMPENSATOR COMPRISING
CAPSULES DEFINING A LOW PRESSURE ENVIRONMENT, (Attorney Docket No. END7100USNP/110601);
U.S. Application Serial No. ____________, entitled TISSUE THICKNESS COMPENSATOR COMPRISED
OF A PLURALITY OF MATERIALS, (Attorney Docket No. END7101USNP/110602);
U.S. Application Serial No. ____________, entitled MOVABLE MEMBER FOR USE WITH A TISSUE
THICKNESS COMPENSATOR, (Attorney Docket No. END7107USNP/110603);
U.S. Application Serial No. ____________, entitled TISSUE THICKNESS COMPENSATOR COMPRISING
A PLURALITY OF MEDICAMENTS, (Attorney Docket No. END7102USNP/110604);
U.S. Application Serial No. ____________, entitled TISSUE THICKNESS COMPENSATOR AND
METHOD FOR MAKING THE SAME, (Attorney Docket No. END7103USNP/110605);
U.S. Application Serial No. ____________, entitled TISSUE THICKNESS COMPENSATOR COMPRISING
CHANNELS, (Attorney Docket No. END7104USNP/110606);
U.S. Application Serial No. ____________, entitled TISSUE THICKNESS COMPENSATOR COMPRISING
TISSUE INGROWTH FEATURES, (Attorney Docket No. END7105USNP/110607); and
U.S. Application Serial No. ____________, entitled DEVICES AND METHODS FOR ATTACHING
TISSUE THICKNESS COMPENSATING MATERIALS TO SURGICAL STAPLING INSTRUMENTS, (Attorney
Docket No. END7106USNP/110608).
[0234] Certain exemplary embodiments will now be described to provide an overall understanding
of the principles of the structure, function, manufacture, and use of the devices
and methods disclosed herein. One or more examples of these embodiments are illustrated
in the accompanying drawings. Those of ordinary skill in the art will understand that
the devices and methods specifically described herein and illustrated in the accompanying
drawings are nonlimiting exemplary embodiments. The features illustrated or described
in connection with one exemplary embodiment may be combined with the features of other
embodiments. Such modifications and variations are included within the scope of the
present invention.
[0235] Any of the methods disclosed or claimed herein for manufacturing, forming or otherwise
producing an article or product, may be employed to manufacture, form or otherwise
produce all or part of the article or product in question, and where such a method
is employed to manufacture, form or otherwise produce part of the article or product
in question, the remainder of the article or product may be produced in any way, including
by employing any of the other methods disclosed and claimed herein for manufacturing,
forming or otherwise producing the article or product, and the various parts so produced
may be combined in any manner. Similarly, any article or product disclosed or claimed
herein may exist alone, or in combination with, or as an integral part of any other
article or product so disclosed with which it is compatible. Thus, the particular
features, structures, or characteristics illustrated or described in connection with
one article, product or method may be combined, in whole or in part, with the features
structures, or characteristics of one or more other compatible articles, products
or methods without limitation. Such modifications and variations are included within
the scope of the present invention.
[0236] Where it is disclosed herein, either with reference to a particular figure or otherwise,
that a certain embodiment of the invention or a certain article, product or method
may comprise certain structures, characteristics or features, it will be understood
by the reader that this signifies that those structures, characteristics or features
may be embodied in the article, product or method in question in any compatible combination.
In particular, such a disclosure of a number of optional structures, characteristics
or features shall be understood also to disclose all of those structures, characteristics
or features in combination, except in the case of structures, characteristics or features
that are disclosed as alternatives to one another. Where such structures, characteristics
or features are disclosed as alternatives to one another, this shall be understood
to disclose those alternatives as being substitutions for each other.
[0237] The terms "proximal" and "distal" are used herein with reference to a clinician manipulating
the handle portion of the surgical instrument. The term "proximal" referring to the
portion closest to the clinician and the term "distal" referring to the portion located
away from the clinician. It will be further appreciated that, for convenience and
clarity, spatial terms such as "vertical", "horizontal", "up", and "down" may be used
herein with respect to the drawings. However, surgical instruments are used in many
orientations and positions, and these terms are not intended to be limiting and/or
absolute.
[0238] Various exemplary devices and methods are provided for performing laparoscopic and
minimally invasive surgical procedures. However, the reader will readily appreciate
that the various methods and devices disclosed herein can be used in numerous surgical
procedures and applications, including in connection with open surgical procedures.
As the present Detailed Description proceeds, the reader will further appreciate that
the various instruments disclosed herein can be inserted into a body in any way, such
as through a natural orifice, through an incision or puncture hole formed in tissue,
etc. The working portions or end effector portions of the instruments can be inserted
directly into a patient's body or can be inserted through an access device that has
a working channel through which the end effector and elongated shaft of a surgical
instrument can be advanced.
[0239] Turning to the Drawings wherein like numerals denote like components throughout the
several views, FIG. 1 depicts a surgical instrument 10 that is capable of practicing
several unique benefits. The surgical stapling instrument 10 is designed to manipulate
and/or actuate various forms and sizes of end effectors 12 that are operably attached
thereto. In FIGS. 1-1E, for example, the end effector 12 includes an elongated channel
14 that forms a lower jaw 13 of the end effector 12. The elongated channel 14 is configured
to support an "implantable" staple cartridge 30 and also movably support an anvil
20 that functions as an upper jaw 15 of the end effector 12.
[0240] The elongated channel 14 may be fabricated from, for example, 300 & 400 Series, 17-4
& 17-7 stainless steel, titanium, etc. and be formed with spaced side walls 16. The
anvil 20 may be fabricated from, for example, 300 & 400 Series, 17-4 & 17-7 stainless
steel, titanium, etc. and have a staple forming undersurface, generally labeled as
22 that has a plurality of staple forming pockets 23 formed therein. See FIGS. 1B-1E.
In addition, the anvil 20 has a bifurcated ramp assembly 24 that protrudes proximally
therefrom. An anvil pin 26 protrudes from each lateral side of the ramp assembly 24
to be received within a corresponding slot or opening 18 in the side walls 16 of the
elongated channel 14 to facilitate its movable or pivotable attachment thereto.
[0241] Various forms of implantable staple cartridges may be employed with the surgical
instruments disclosed herein. Specific staple cartridge configurations and constructions
will be discussed in further detail below. However, In FIG. 1A, an implantable staple
cartridge 30 is shown. The staple cartridge 30 has a body portion 31 that consists
of a compressible hemostat material such as, for example, oxidized regenerated cellulose
("ORC") or a bio-absorbable foam in which lines of unformed metal staples 32 are supported.
In order to prevent the staple from being affected and the hemostat material from
being activated during the introduction and positioning process, the entire cartridge
may be coated or wrapped in a biodegradable film 38 such as a polydioxanon film sold
under the trademark PDS® or with a Polyglycerol sebacate (PGS) film or other biodegradable
films formed from PGA (Polyglycolic acid, marketed under the trade mark Vicryl), PCL
(Polycaprolactone), PLA or PLLA (Polylactic acid), PHA (polyhydroxyalkanoate), PGCL
(poliglecaprone 25, sold under the trademark Monocryl) or a composite of PGA, PCL,
PLA, PDS that would be impermeable until ruptured. The body 31 of staple cartridge
30 is sized to be removably supported within the elongated channel 14 as shown such
that each staple 32 therein is aligned with corresponding staple forming pockets 23
in the anvil when the anvil 20 is driven into forming contact with the staple cartridge
30.
[0242] In use, once the end effector 12 has been positioned adjacent the target tissue,
the end effector 12 is manipulated to capture or clamp the target tissue between an
upper face 36 of the staple cartridge 30 and the staple forming surface 22 of the
anvil 20. The staples 32 are formed by moving the anvil 20 in a path that is substantially
parallel to the elongated channel 14 to bring the staple forming surface 22 and, more
particularly, the staple forming pockets 23 therein into substantially simultaneous
contact with the upper face 36 of the staple cartridge 30. As the anvil 20 continues
to move into the staple cartridge 30, the legs 34 of the staples 32 contact a corresponding
staple forming pocket 23 in anvil 20 which serves to bend the staple legs 34 over
to form the staples 32 into a "B shape". Further movement of the anvil 20 toward the
elongated channel 14 will further compress and form the staples 32 to a desired final
formed height "FF".
[0243] The above-described staple forming process is generally depicted in FIGS. 1B-1E.
For example, FIG. 1B illustrates the end effector 12 with target tissue "T" between
the anvil 20 and the upper face 36 of the implantable staple cartridge 30. FIG. 1C
illustrates the initial clamping position of the anvil 20 wherein the anvil has 20
been closed onto the target tissue "T" to clamp the target tissue "T" between the
anvil 20 and the upper face 36 of the staple cartridge 30. FIG. 1D illustrates the
initial staple formation wherein the anvil 20 has started to compress the staple cartridge
30 such that the legs 34 of the staples 32 are starting to be formed by the staple
forming pockets 23 in the anvil 20. FIG. 1E illustrates the staple 32 in its final
formed condition through the target tissue "T" with the anvil 20 removed for clarity
purposes. Once the staples 32 have been formed and fastened to the target tissue "T",
the surgeon will move the anvil 20 to the open position to enable the cartridge body
31 and the staples 32 to remain affixed to the target tissue while the end effector
12 is being withdrawn from the patient. The end effector 12 forms all of the staples
simultaneously as the two jaws 13, 15 are clamped together. The remaining "crushed"
body materials 31 act as both a hemostat (the ORC) and a staple line reinforcement
(PGA, PDS or any of the other film compositions mentioned above 38). Also, since the
staples 32 never have to leave the cartridge body 31 during forming, the likelihood
of the staples 32 being malformed during forming is minimized. As used herein the
term "implantable" means that, in addition to the staples, the cartridge body materials
that support the staples will also remain in the patient and may eventually be absorbed
by the patient's body. Such implantable staple cartridges are distinguishable from
prior cartridge arrangements that remain positioned within the end effector in their
entirety after they have been fired.
[0244] In various implementations, the end effector 12 is configured to be coupled to an
elongated shaft assembly 40 that protrudes from a handle assembly 100. The end effector
12 (when closed) and the elongated shaft assembly 40 may have similar cross-sectional
shapes and be sized to operably pass through a trocar tube or working channel in another
form of access instrument. As used herein, the term "operably pass" means that the
end effector and at least a portion of the elongated shaft assembly may be inserted
through or passed through the channel or tube opening and can be manipulated therein
as needed to complete the surgical stapling procedure. When in a closed position,
the jaws 13 and 15 of the end effector 12 may provide the end effector with a roughly
circular cross-sectional shape that facilitates its passage through a circular passage/opening.
However, the end effectors of the present invention, as well as the elongated shaft
assemblies, could conceivably be provided with other cross-sectional shapes that could
otherwise pass through access passages and openings that have non-circular cross-sectional
shapes. Thus, an overall size of a cross-section of a closed end effector will be
related to the size of the passage or opening through which it is intended to pass.
Thus, one end effector for example, may be referred to as a "5mm" end effector which
means it can operably pass through an opening that is at least approximately 5mm in
diameter.
[0245] The elongated shaft assembly 40 may have an outer diameter that is substantially
the same as the outer diameter of the end effector 12 when in a closed position. For
example, a 5mm end effector may be coupled to an elongated shaft assembly 40 that
has 5mm cross-sectional diameter. However, as the present Detailed Description proceeds,
it will become apparent that the present invention may be effectively used in connection
with different sizes of end effectors. For example, a 10mm end effector may be attached
to an elongated shaft that has a 5mm cross-sectional diameter. Conversely, for those
applications wherein a 10mm or larger access opening or passage is provided, the elongated
shaft assembly 40 may have a 10mm (or larger) cross-sectional diameter, but may also
be able to actuate a 5mm or 10mm end effector. Accordingly, the outer shaft 40 may
have an outer diameter that is the same as or is different from the outer diameter
of a closed end effector 12 attached thereto.
[0246] As depicted, the elongated shaft assembly 40 extends distally from the handle assembly
100 in a generally straight line to define a longitudinal axis A-A. For example, the
elongated shaft assembly 40 may be approximately 9-16 inches (229-406mm) long. However,
the elongated shaft assembly 40 may be provided in other lengths or may have joints
therein or be otherwise configured to facilitate articulation of the end effector
12 relative to other portions of the shaft or handle assembly as will be discussed
in further detail below. The elongated shaft assembly 40 includes a spine member 50
that extends from the handle assembly 100 to the end effector 12. The proximal end
of the elongated channel 14 of the end effector 12 has a pair of retention trunnions
17 protruding therefrom that are sized to be received within corresponding trunnion
openings or cradles 52 that are provided in a distal end of the spine member 50 to
enable the end effector 12 to be removably coupled the elongated shaft assembly 40.
The spine member 50 may be fabricated from, for example, 6061 or 7075 aluminum, stainless
steel, titanium, etc.
[0247] The handle assembly 100 comprises a pistol grip-type housing that may be fabricated
in two or more pieces for assembly purposes. For example, the handle assembly 100
as shown comprises a right hand case member 102 and a left hand case member (not illustrated)
that are molded or otherwise fabricated from a polymer or plastic material and are
designed to mate together. Such case members may be attached together by snap features,
pegs and sockets molded or otherwise formed therein and/or by adhesive, screws, etc.
The spine member 50 has a proximal end 54 that has a flange 56 formed thereon. The
flange 56 is configured to be rotatably supported within a groove 106 formed by mating
ribs 108 that protrude inwardly from each of the case members 102, 104. Such arrangement
facilitates the attachment of the spine member 50 to the handle assembly 100 while
enabling the spine member 50 to be rotated relative to the handle assembly 100 about
the longitudinal axis A-A in a 360° path.
[0248] As can be further seen in FIG. 1, the spine member 50 passes through and is supported
by a mounting bushing 60 that is rotatably affixed to the handle assembly 100. The
mounting bushing 60 has a proximal flange 62 and a distal flange 64 that define a
rotational groove 65 that is configured to rotatably receive a nose portion 101 of
the handle assembly 100 therebetween. Such arrangement enables the mounting bushing
60 to rotate about longitudinal axis A-A relative to the handle assembly 100. The
spine member 50 is non-rotatably pinned to the mounting bushing 60 by a spine pin
66. In addition, a rotation knob 70 is attached to the mounting bushing 60. For example,
the rotation knob 70 has a hollow mounting flange portion 72 that is sized to receive
a portion of the mounting bushing 60 therein. The rotation knob 70 may be fabricated
from, for example, glass or carbon filled Nylon, polycarbonate, Ultem®, etc. and is
affixed to the mounting bushing 60 by the spine pin 66 as well. In addition, an inwardly
protruding retention flange 74 is formed on the mounting flange portion 72 and is
configured to extend into a radial groove 68 formed in the mounting bushing 60. Thus,
the surgeon may rotate the spine member 50 (and the end effector 12 attached thereto)
about longitudinal axis A-A in a 360° path by grasping the rotation knob 70 and rotating
it relative to the handle assembly 100.
[0249] The anvil 20 is retained in an open position by an anvil spring 21 and/or another
biasing arrangement. The anvil 20 is selectively movable from the open position to
various closed or clamping and firing positions by a firing system, generally designated
as 109. The firing system 109 includes a "firing member" 110 which comprises a hollow
firing tube 110. The hollow firing tube 110 is axially movable on the spine member
50 and thus forms the outer portion of the elongated shaft assembly 40. The firing
tube 110 may be fabricated from a polymer or other suitable material and have a proximal
end that is attached to a firing yoke 114 of the firing system 109. For example, the
firing yoke 114 may be over-molded to the proximal end of the firing tube 110. However,
other fastener arrangements may be employed.
[0250] As can be seen in FIG. 1, the firing yoke 114 may be rotatably supported within a
support collar 120 that is configured to move axially within the handle assembly 100.
The support collar 120 has a pair of laterally extending fins that are sized to be
slidably received within fin slots formed in the right and left hand case members.
Thus, the support collar 120 may slide axially within the handle housing 100 while
enabling the firing yoke 114 and firing tube 110 to rotate relative thereto about
the longitudinal axis A-A. According to the invention, a longitudinal slot is provided
through the firing tube 110 to enable the spine pin 66 to extend therethrough into
the spine member 50 while facilitating the axial travel of the firing tube 110 on
the spine member 50.
[0251] The firing system 109 further comprises a firing trigger 130 which serves to control
the axial travel of the firing tube 110 on the spine member 50. See FIG. 1. Such axial
movement in the distal direction of the firing tube 110 into firing interaction with
the anvil 20 is referred to herein as "firing motion". As can be seen in FIG. 1, the
firing trigger 130 is movably or pivotally coupled to the handle assembly 100 by a
pivot pin 132. A torsion spring 135 is employed to bias the firing trigger 130 away
from the pistol grip portion 107 of the handle assembly 100 to an un-actuated "open"
or starting position. As can be seen in FIG. 1, the firing trigger 130 has an upper
portion 134 that is movably attached to (pinned) firing links 136 that are movably
attached to (pinned) the support collar 120. Thus, movement of the firing trigger
130 from the starting position (FIG. 1) toward an ending position adjacent the pistol
grip portion 107 of the handle assembly 100 will cause the firing yoke 114 and the
firing tube 110 to move in the distal direction "DD". Movement of the firing trigger
130 away from the pistol grip portion 107 of the handle assembly 100 (under the bias
of the torsion spring 135) will cause the firing yoke 114 and firing tube 110 to move
in the proximal direction "PD" on the spine member 50.
[0252] The present invention may be employed with different sizes and configurations of
implantable staple cartridges. For example, the surgical instrument 10, when used
in connection with a first firing adapter 140, may be used with a 5mm end effector
12 that is approximately 20mm long (or in other lengths) which supports an implantable
staple cartridge 30. Such end effector size may be particularly well-suited, for example,
to complete relatively fine dissection and vascular transactions. However, as will
be discussed in further detail below, the surgical instrument 10 may also be employed,
for example, in connection with other sizes of end effectors and staple cartridges
by replacing the first firing adapter 140 with a second firing adapter. As an additional
alternative, the elongated shaft assembly 40 may configured to be attached to only
one form or size of end effector.
[0253] One method of removably coupling the end effector 12 to the spine member 50 will
now be explained. The coupling process is commenced by inserting the retention trunnions
17 on the elongated channel 14 into the trunnion cradles 52 in the spine member 50.
Thereafter, the surgeon advances the firing trigger 130 toward the pistol grip 107
of the housing assembly 100 to distally advance the firing tube 110 and the first
firing adapter 140 over a proximal end portion 47 of the elongated channel 14 to thereby
retain the trunnions 17 in their respective cradles 52. Such position of the first
firing adapter 140 over the trunnions 17 is referred to herein as the "coupled position".
The present invention may also have an end effector locking assembly for locking the
firing trigger 130 in position after an end effector 12 has been attached to the spine
member 50.
[0254] More specifically, one embodiment of the end effector locking assembly 160 includes
a retention pin 162 that is movably supported in the upper portion 134 of the firing
trigger 130. As discussed above, the firing tube 110 must initially be advanced distally
to the coupled position wherein the first firing adapter 140 retains the retention
trunnions 17 of the end effector 12 in the trunnion cradles 52 in the spine member
50. The surgeon advances the firing adapter 140 distally to the coupled position by
pulling the firing trigger 130 from the starting position toward the pistol grip 107.
As the firing trigger 130 is initially actuated, the retention pin 162 is moved distally
until the firing tube 110 has advanced the first firing adapter 140 to the coupled
position at which point the retention pin 162 is biased into a locking cavity 164
formed in the case member. Optionally, when the retention pin 162 enters into the
locking cavity 164, the pin 162 may make an audible "click" or other sound, as well
as provide a tactile indication to the surgeon that the end effector 12 has been "locked"
onto the spine member 50. In addition, the surgeon cannot inadvertently continue to
actuate the firing trigger 130 to start to form staples 32 in the end effector 12
without intentionally biasing the retention pin 162 out of the locking cavity 164.
Similarly, if the surgeon releases the firing trigger 130 when in the coupled position,
it is retained in that position by the retention pin 162 to prevent the firing trigger
130 from returning to the starting position and thereby releasing the end effector
12 from the spine member 50.
[0255] The present invention may further include a firing system lock button 137 that is
pivotally attached to the handle assembly 100. In one form, the firing system lock
button 137 has a latch 138 formed on a distal end thereof that is oriented to engage
the firing yoke 114 when the firing release button is in a first latching position.
As can be seen in FIG. 1, a latch spring 139 serves to bias the firing system lock
button 137 to the first latching position. In various circumstances, the latch 138
serves to engage the firing yoke 114 at a point where the position of the firing yoke
114 on the spine member 50 corresponds to a point wherein the first firing adapter
140 is about to distally advance up the clamping ramp 28 on the anvil 20. It will
be understood that, as the first firing adapter 140 advances axially up the clamping
ramp 28, the anvil 20 will move in a path such that its staple forming surface portion
22 is substantially parallel to the upper face 36 of the staple cartridge 30.
[0256] After the end effector 12 has been coupled to the spine member 50, the staple forming
process is commenced by first depressing the firing system lock button 137 to enable
the firing yoke 114 to be further moved distally on the spine member 50 and ultimately
compress the anvil 20 into the staple cartridge 30. After depressing the firing system
lock button 137, the surgeon continues to actuate the firing trigger 130 towards the
pistol grip 107 thereby driving the first staple collar 140 up the corresponding staple
forming ramp 29 to force the anvil 20 into forming contact with the staples 32 in
the staple cartridge 30. The firing system lock button 137 prevents the inadvertent
forming of the staples 32 until the surgeon is ready to start that process. In this
embodiment, the surgeon must depress the firing system lock button 137 before the
firing trigger 130 may be further actuated to begin the staple forming process.
[0257] The surgical instrument 10 may be solely used as a tissue stapling device if so desired.
However, the present invention may also include a tissue cutting system, generally
designated as 170. In at least one form, the tissue cutting system 170 comprises a
knife member 172 that may be selectively advanced from an un-actuated position adjacent
the proximal end of the end effector 12 to an actuated position by actuating a knife
advancement trigger 200. The knife member 172 is movably supported within the spine
member 50 and is attached or otherwise protrudes from a knife rod 180. The knife member
172 may be fabricated from, for example, 420 or 440 stainless steel with a hardness
of greater than 38HRC (Rockwell Hardness C-scale) and have a tissue cutting edge 176
formed on the distal end 174 thereof and be configured to slidably extend through
a slot in the anvil 20 and a centrally disposed slot 33 in the staple cartridge 30
to cut through tissue that is clamped in the end effector 12. The knife rod 180 extends
through the spine member 50 and has a proximal end portion which drivingly interfaces
with a knife transmission that is operably attached to the knife advance trigger 200.
The knife advance trigger 200 is attached to pivot pin 132 such that it may be pivoted
or otherwise actuated without actuating the firing trigger 130. According to the invention,
a first knife gear 192 is also attached to the pivot pin 132 such that actuation of
the knife advance trigger 200 also pivots the first knife gear 192. A firing return
spring 202 is attached between the first knife gear 192 and the handle housing 100
to bias the knife advancement trigger 200 to a starting or un-actuated position.
[0258] The knife transmission also include a second knife gear 194 that is rotatably supported
on a second gear spindle and in meshing engagement with the first knife gear 192.
The second knife gear 194 is in meshing engagement with a third knife gear 196 that
is supported on a third gear spindle. Also supported on the third gear spindle 195
is a fourth knife gear 198. The fourth knife gear 198 is adapted to drivingly engage
a series of annular gear teeth or rings on a proximal end of the knife rod 180. Thus,
such arrangement enables the fourth knife gear 198 to axially drive the knife rod
180 in the distal direction "DD" or proximal direction "PD" while enabling the firing
rod 180 to rotate about longitudinal axis A-A with respect to the fourth knife gear
198. Accordingly, the surgeon may axially advance the firing rod 180 and ultimately
the knife member 172 distally by pulling the knife advancement trigger 200 towards
the pistol grip 107 of the handle assembly 100.
[0259] The present invention further include a knife lockout system 210 that prevents the
advancement of the knife member 172 unless the firing trigger 130 has been pulled
to the fully fired position. Such feature will therefore prevent the activation of
the knife advancement system 170 unless the staples have first been fired or formed
into the tissue. As can be seen in FIG. 1, various implementations of the knife lockout
system 210 comprise a knife lockout bar 211 that is pivotally supported within the
pistol grip portion 107 of the handle assembly 100. The knife lockout bar 211 has
an activation end 212 that is adapted to be engaged by the firing trigger 130 when
the firing trigger 130 is in the fully fired position. In addition, the knife lockout
bar 211 has a retaining hook 214 on its other end that is adapted to hookingly engage
a latch rod 216 on the first cut gear 192. A knife lock spring 218 is employed to
bias the knife lockout bar 211 to a "locked" position wherein the retaining hook 214
is retained in engagement with the latch rod 216 to thereby prevent actuation of the
knife advancement trigger 200 unless the firing trigger 130 is in the fully fired
position.
[0260] After the staples have been "fired" (formed) into the target tissue, the surgeon
may depress the firing trigger release button 167 to enable the firing trigger 130
to return to the starting position under the bias of the torsion spring 135 which
enables the anvil 20 to be biased to an open position under the bias of spring 21.
When in the open position, the surgeon may withdraw the end effector 12 leaving the
implantable staple cartridge 30 and staples 32 behind. In applications wherein the
end effector was inserted through a passage, working channel, etc. the surgeon will
return the anvil 20 to the closed position by activating the firing trigger 130 to
enable the end effector 12 to be withdrawn out through the passage or working channel.
If, however, the surgeon desires to cut the target tissue after firing the staples,
the surgeon activates the knife advancement trigger 200 in the above-described manner
to drive the knife bar 172 through the target tissue to the end of the end effector.
Thereafter, the surgeon may release the knife advancement trigger 200 to enable the
firing return spring 202 to cause the firing transmission to return the knife bar
172 to the starting (un-actuated) position. Once the knife bar 172 has been returned
to the starting position, the surgeon may open the end effector jaws 13, 15 to release
the implantable cartridge 30 within the patient and then withdraw the end effector
12 from the patient. Thus, such surgical instruments facilitate the use of small implantable
staple cartridges that may be inserted through relatively smaller working channels
and passages, while providing the surgeon with the option to fire the staples without
cutting tissue or if desired to also cut tissue after the staples have been fired.
[0261] Various unique and novel embodiments of the present invention employ a compressible
staple cartridge that supports staples in a substantially stationary position for
forming contact by the anvil. The anvil is driven into the unformed staples wherein,
for example, the degree of staple formation attained is dependent upon how far the
anvil is driven into the staples. Such an arrangement provides the surgeon with the
ability to adjust the amount of forming or firing pressure applied to the staples
and thereby alter the final formed height of the staples. In other The present invention,
surgical stapling arrangements can employ staple driving elements which can lift the
staples toward the anvil. These are described in greater detail further below.
[0262] Optionally, with regard to the above, the amount of firing motion that is applied
to the movable anvil is dependent upon the degree of actuation of the firing trigger.
For example, if the surgeon desires to attain only partially formed staples, then
the firing trigger is only partially depressed inward towards the pistol grip 107.
To attain more staple formation, the surgeon simply compresses the firing trigger
further which results in the anvil being further driven into forming contact with
the staples. As used herein, the term "forming contact" means that the staple forming
surface or staple forming pockets have contacted the ends of the staple legs and have
started to form or bend the legs over into a formed position. The degree of staple
formation refers to how far the staple legs have been folded over and ultimately relates
to the forming height of the staple as referenced above. Those of ordinary skill in
the art will further understand that, because the anvil 20 moves in a substantially
parallel relationship with respect to the staple cartridge as the firing motions are
applied thereto, the staples are formed substantially simultaneously with substantially
the same formed heights.
[0263] FIGS. 2 and 3 illustrate an alternative end effector 12" that is similar to the end
effector 12' described above, except with the following differences that are configured
to accommodate a knife bar 172'. The knife bar 172' is coupled to or protrudes from
a knife rod 180 and is otherwise operated in the above described manner with respect
to the knife bar 172. However, in this embodiment, the knife bar 172' is long enough
to traverse the entire length of the end effector 12" and therefore, a separate distal
knife member is not employed in the end effector 12". The knife bar 172' has an upper
transverse member 173' and a lower transverse member 175' formed thereon. The upper
transverse member 173' is oriented to slidably transverse a corresponding elongated
slot 250 in anvil 20" and the lower transverse member 175' is oriented to traverse
an elongated slot 252 in the elongated channel 14" of the end effector 12". A disengagement
slot (not shown) is also provide din the anvil 20" such that when the knife bar 172'
has been driven to an ending position with thin end effector 12", the upper transverse
member 173' drops through the corresponding slot to enable the anvil 20" to move to
the open position to disengage the stapled and cut tissue. The anvil 20" may be otherwise
identical to anvil 20 described above and the elongated channel 14" may be otherwise
identical to elongated channel 14 described above.
[0264] In these embodiments, the anvil 20" is biased to a fully open position (FIG. 2) by
a spring or other opening arrangement (not shown). The anvil 20" is moved between
the open and fully clamped positions by the axial travel of the firing adapter 150
in the manner described above. Once the firing adapter 150 has been advanced to the
fully clamped position (FIG. 3), the surgeon may then advance the knife bar 172" distally
in the manner described above. If the surgeon desires to use the end effector as a
grasping device to manipulate tissue, the firing adapter may be moved proximally to
allow the anvil 20" to move away from the elongated channel 14" as represented in
FIG. 4 in broken lines. In this embodiment, as the knife bar 172" moves distally,
the upper transverse member 173' and the lower transverse member 175' draw the anvil
20" and elongated channel 14" together to achieve the desired staple formation as
the knife bar 172" is advanced distally through the end effector 12". See FIG. 5.
Thus, in this embodiment, staple formation occurs simultaneously with tissue cutting,
but the staples themselves may be sequentially formed as the knife bar 172" is driven
distally.
[0265] The unique and novel features of the various surgical staple cartridges and the surgical
instruments of the present invention enable the staples in those cartridges to be
arranged in one or more linear or non-linear lines. A plurality of such staple lines
may be provided on each side of an elongated slot that is centrally disposed within
the staple cartridge for receiving the tissue cutting member therethrough. In one
arrangement, for example, the staples in one line may be substantially parallel with
the staples in adjacent line(s) of staples, but offset therefrom. As an additional
alternative, one or more lines of staples may be non-linear in nature. That is, the
base of at least one staple in a line of staples may extend along an axis that is
substantially transverse to the bases of other staples in the same staple line. For
example, the lines of staples on each side of the elongated slot may have a zigzag
appearance.
[0266] According to the invention, a staple cartridge can comprise a cartridge body and
a plurality of staples stored within the cartridge body. In use, the staple cartridge
can be introduced into a surgical site and positioned on a side of the tissue being
treated. In addition, a staple-forming anvil can be positioned on the opposite side
of the tissue. The anvil can be carried by a first jaw and the staple cartridge can
be carried by a second jaw, wherein the first jaw and/or the second jaw can be moved
toward the other. Once the staple cartridge and the anvil have been positioned relative
to the tissue, the staples can be ejected from the staple cartridge body such that
the staples can pierce the tissue and contact the staple-forming anvil. Once the staples
have been deployed from the staple cartridge body, the staple cartridge body can then
be removed from the surgical site. The staple cartridge, or at least a portion of
a staple cartridge, can be implanted with the staples. For example, as described in
greater detail further below, a staple cartridge can comprise a cartridge body which
can be compressed, crushed, and/or collapsed by the anvil when the anvil is moved
from an open position into a closed position. When the cartridge body is compressed,
crushed, and/or collapsed, the staples positioned within the cartridge body can be
deformed by the anvil. Alternatively, the jaw supporting the staple cartridge can
be moved toward the anvil into a closed position. In either event, the staples can
be deformed while they are at least partially positioned within the cartridge body.
In some cases, the staples may not eject from the staple cartridge while, in other
cases, the staples can be ejected from the staple cartridge along with a portion of
the cartridge body.
[0267] Referring now to FIGS. 6A-6D, a compressible staple cartridge, such as staple cartridge
1000, for example, can comprise a compressible, implantable cartridge body 1010 and,
in addition, a plurality of staples 1020 positioned in the compressible cartridge
body 1010, although only one staple 1020 is depicted in FIGS. 6A-6D. FIG. 6A illustrates
the staple cartridge 1000 supported by a staple cartridge support, or staple cartridge
channel, 1030, wherein the staple cartridge 1000 is illustrated in an uncompressed
condition. In such an uncompressed condition, the anvil 1040 may or may not be in
contact with the tissue T. In use, the anvil 1040 can be moved from an open position
into contact with the tissue T as illustrated in FIG. 6B and position the tissue T
against the cartridge body 1010. Even though the anvil 1040 can position the tissue
T against a tissue-contacting surface 1019 of staple cartridge body 1010, referring
again to FIG. 6B, the staple cartridge body 1010 may be subjected to little, if any,
compressive force or pressure at such point and the staples 1020 may remain in an
unformed, or unfired, condition. As illustrated in FIGS. 6A and 6B, the staple cartridge
body 1010 can comprise one or more layers and the staple legs 1021 of staples 1020
can extend upwardly through these layers. The cartridge body 1010 can comprise a first
layer 1011, a second layer 1012, a third layer 1013, wherein the second layer 1012
can be positioned intermediate the first layer 1011 and the third layer 1013, and
a fourth layer 1014, wherein the third layer 1013 can be positioned intermediate the
second layer 1012 and the fourth layer 1014. The bases 1022 of the staples 1020 can
be positioned within cavities 1015 in the fourth layer 1014 and the staple legs 1021
can extend upwardly from the bases 1022 and through the fourth layer 1014, the third
layer 1013, and the second layer 1012, for example. Optionally, each deformable leg
1021 can comprise a tip, such as sharp tip 1023, for example, which can be positioned
in the second layer 1012, for example, when the staple cartridge 1000 is in an uncompressed
condition. For example, the tips 1023 may not extend into and/or through the first
layer 1011, wherein, the tips 1023 may not protrude through the tissue-contacting
surface 1019 when the staple cartridge 1000 is in an uncompressed condition. The sharp
tips 1023 may be positioned in the third layer 1013, and/or any other suitable layer,
when the staple cartridge is in an uncompressed condition. Alternatively, a cartridge
body of a staple cartridge may have any suitable number of layers such as less than
four layers or more than four layers, for example.
[0268] Optionally, as described in greater detail below, the first layer 1011 can be comprised
of a buttress material and/or plastic material, such as polydioxanone (PDS) and/or
polyglycolic acid (PGA), for example, and the second layer 1012 can be comprised of
a bioabsorbable foam material and/or a compressible haemostatic material, such as
oxidized regenerated cellulose (ORC), for example. Optionally, one or more of the
first layer 1011, the second layer 1012, the third layer 1013, and the fourth layer
1014 may hold the staples 1020 within the staple cartridge body 1010 and, in addition,
maintain the staples 1020 in alignment with one another. The third layer 1013 can
be comprised of a buttress material, or a fairly incompressible or inelastic material,
which can be configured to hold the staple legs 1021 of the staples 1020 in position
relative to one another. Furthermore, the second layer 1012 and the fourth layer 1014,
which are positioned on opposite sides of the third layer 1013, can stabilize, or
reduce the movement of, the staples 1020 even though the second layer 1012 and the
fourth layer 1014 can be comprised of a compressible foam or elastic material. The
staple tips 1023 of the staple legs 1021 can be at least partially embedded in the
first layer 1011. For example, the first layer 1011 and the third layer 1013 can be
configured to co-operatively and firmly hold the staple legs 1021 in position. The
first layer 1011 and the third layer 1013 can each be comprised of a sheet of bioabsorbable
plastic, such as polyglycolic acid (PGA) which is marketed under the trade name Vicryl,
polylactic acid (PLA or PLLA), polydioxanone (PDS), polyhydroxyalkanoate (PHA), poliglecaprone
25 (PGCL) which is marketed under the trade name Monocryl, polycaprolactone (PCL),
and/or a composite of PGA, PLA, PDS, PHA, PGCL and/or PCL, for example, and the second
layer 1012 and the fourth layer 1014 can each be comprised of at least one haemostatic
material or agent.
[0269] Although the first layer 1011 can be compressible, the second layer 1012 can be substantially
more compressible than the first layer 1011. For example, the second layer 1012 can
be about twice as compressible, about three times as compressible, about four times
as compressible, about five times as compressible, and/or about ten times as compressible,
for example, as the first layer 1011. Stated another way, the second layer 1012 may
compress about two times, about three times, about four times, about five times, and/or
about ten times as much as first layer 1011, for a given force. The second layer 1012
can be between about twice as compressible and about ten times as compressible, for
example, as the first layer 1011. The second layer 1012 can comprise a plurality of
air voids defined therein, wherein the amount and/or size of the air voids in the
second layer 1012 can be controlled in order to provide a desired compressibility
of the second layer 1012. Similar to the above, although the third layer 1013 can
be compressible, the fourth layer 1014 can be substantially more compressible than
the third layer 1013. For example, the fourth layer 1014 can be about twice as compressible,
about three times as compressible, about four times as compressible, about five times
as compressible, and/or about ten times as compressible, for example, as the third
layer 1013. Stated another way, the fourth layer 1014 may compress about two times,
about three times, about four times, about five times, and/or about ten times as much
as third layer 1013, for a given force. The fourth layer 1014 can be between about
twice as compressible and about ten times as compressible, for example, as the third
layer 1013. The fourth layer 1014 can comprise a plurality of air voids defined therein,
wherein the amount and/or size of the air voids in the fourth layer 1014 can be controlled
in order to provide a desired compressibility of the fourth layer 1014. In various
circumstances, the compressibility of a cartridge body, or cartridge body layer, can
be expressed in terms of a compression rate, i.e., a distance in which a layer is
compressed for a given amount of force. For example, a layer having a high compression
rate will compress a larger distance for a given amount of compressive force applied
to the layer as compared to a layer having a lower compression rate. This being said,
the second layer 1012 can have a higher compression rate than the first layer 1011
and, similarly, the fourth layer 1014 can have a higher compression rate than the
third layer 1013. The second layer 1012 and the fourth layer 1014 can be comprised
of the same material and can comprise the same compression rate. The second layer
1012 and the fourth layer 1014 can be comprised of materials having different compression
rates. Similarly, the first layer 1011 and the third layer 1013 can be comprised of
the same material and can comprise the same compression rate. The first layer 1011
and the third layer 1013 can be comprised of materials having different compression
rates.
[0270] As the anvil 1040 is moved toward its closed position, the anvil 1040 can contact
tissue T and apply a compressive force to the tissue T and the staple cartridge 1000,
as illustrated in FIG. 6C. In such circumstances, the anvil 1040 can push the top
surface, or tissue-contacting surface 1019, of the cartridge body 1010 downwardly
toward the staple cartridge support 1030. The staple cartridge support 1030 can comprise
a cartridge support surface 1031 which can be configured to support the staple cartridge
1000 as the staple cartridge 1000 is compressed between the cartridge support surface
1031 and the tissue-contacting surface 1041 of anvil 1040. Owing to the pressure applied
by the anvil 1040, the cartridge body 1010 can be compressed and the anvil 1040 can
come into contact with the staples 1020. More particularly, the compression of the
cartridge body 1010 and the downward movement of the tissue-contacting surface 1019
can cause the tips 1023 of the staple legs 1021 to pierce the first layer 1011 of
cartridge body 1010, pierce the tissue T, and enter into forming pockets 1042 in the
anvil 1040. As the cartridge body 1010 is further compressed by the anvil 1040, the
tips 1023 can contact the walls defining the forming pockets 1042 and, as a result,
the legs 1021 can be deformed or curled inwardly, for example, as illustrated in FIG.
6C. As the staple legs 1021 are being deformed, as also illustrated in FIG. 6C, the
bases 1022 of the staples 1020 can be in contact with or supported by the staple cartridge
support 1030. Optionally, as described in greater detail below, the staple cartridge
support 1030 can comprise a plurality of support features, such as staple support
grooves, slots, or troughs 1032, for example, which can be configured to support the
staples 1020, or at least the bases 1022 of the staples 1020, as the staples 1020
are being deformed. As also illustrated in FIG. 6C, the cavities 1015 in the fourth
layer 1014 can collapse as a result of the compressive force applied to the staple
cartridge body 1010. In addition to the cavities 1015, the staple cartridge body 1010
can further comprise one or more voids, such as voids 1016, for example, which may
or may not comprise a portion of a staple positioned therein, that can be configured
to allow the cartridge body 1010 to collapse. The cavities 1015 and/or the voids 1016
can be configured to collapse such that the walls defining the cavities and/or walls
deflect downwardly and contact the cartridge support surface 1031 and/or contact a
layer of the cartridge body 1010 positioned underneath the cavities and/or voids.
[0271] Upon comparing FIG. 6B and FIG. 6C, it is evident that the second layer 1012 and
the fourth layer 1014 have been substantially compressed by the compressive pressure
applied by the anvil 1040. It may also be noted that the first layer 1011 and the
third layer 1013 have been compressed as well. As the anvil 1040 is moved into its
closed position, the anvil 1040 may continue to further compress the cartridge body
1010 by pushing the tissue-contacting surface 1019 downwardly toward the staple cartridge
support 1030. As the cartridge body 1010 is further compressed, the anvil 1040 can
deform the staples 1020 into their completely-formed shape as illustrated in FIG.
6D. Referring to FIG. 6D, the legs 1021 of each staple 1020 can be deformed downwardly
toward the base 1022 of each staple 1020 in order to capture at least a portion of
the tissue T, the first layer 1011, the second layer 1012, the third layer 1013, and
the fourth layer 1014 between the deformable legs 1021 and the base 1022. Upon comparing
FIGS. 6C and 6D, it is further evident that the second layer 1012 and the fourth layer
1014 have been further substantially compressed by the compressive pressure applied
by the anvil 1040. It may also be noted upon comparing FIGS. 6C and 6D that the first
layer 1011 and the third layer 1013 have been further compressed as well. After the
staples 1020 have been completely, or at least sufficiently, formed, the anvil 1040
can be lifted away from the tissue T and the staple cartridge support 1030 can be
moved away, and/or detached from, the staple cartridge 1000. As depicted in FIG. 6D,
and as a result of the above, the cartridge body 1010 can be implanted with the staples
1020. In various circumstances, the implanted cartridge body 1010 can support the
tissue along the staple line. In some circumstances, a haemostatic agent, and/or any
other suitable therapeutic medicament, contained within the implanted cartridge body
1010 can treat the tissue over time. A haemostatic agent, as mentioned above, can
reduce the bleeding of the stapled and/or incised tissue while a bonding agent or
tissue adhesive can provide strength to the tissue over time. The implanted cartridge
body 1010 can be comprised of materials such as ORC (oxidized regenerated cellulose),
extracellular proteins such as collagen, polyglycolic acid (PGA) which is marketed
under the trade name Vicryl, polylactic acid (PLA or PLLA), polydioxanone (PDS), polyhydroxyalkanoate
(PHA), poliglecaprone 25 (PGCL) which is marketed under the trade name Monocryl, polycaprolactone
(PCL), and/or a composite of PGA, PLA, PDS, PHA, PGCL and/or PCL, for example. In
certain circumstances, the cartridge body 1010 can comprise an antibiotic and/or anti-microbial
material, such as colloidal silver and/or triclosan, for example, which can reduce
the possibility of infection in the surgical site.
[0272] The layers of the cartridge body 1010 can be connected to one another. The second
layer 1012 can be adhered to the first layer 1011, the third layer 1013 can be adhered
to the second layer 1012, and the fourth layer 1014 can be adhered to the third layer
1013 utilizing at least one adhesive, such as fibrin and/or protein hydrogel, for
example. Although not illustrated, the layers of the cartridge body 1010 can be connected
together by interlocking mechanical features. For example, the first layer 1011 and
the second layer 1012 can each comprise corresponding interlocking features, such
as a tongue and groove arrangement and/or a dovetail joint arrangement, for example.
Similarly, the second layer 1012 and the third layer 1013 can each comprise corresponding
interlocking features while the third layer 1013 and the fourth layer 1014 can each
comprise corresponding interlocking features. Although not illustrated, the staple
cartridge 1000 can comprise one or more rivets, for example, which can extend through
one or more layers of the cartridge body 1010. For example, each rivet can comprise
a first end, or head, positioned adjacent to the first layer 1011 and a second head
positioned adjacent to the fourth layer 1014 which can be either assembled to or formed
by a second end of the rivet. Owing to the compressible nature of the cartridge body
1010, the rivets can compress the cartridge body 1010 such that the heads of the rivets
can be recessed relative to the tissue-contacting surface 1019 and/or the bottom surface
1018 of the cartridge body 1010, for example. For example, the rivets can be comprised
of a bioabsorbable material, such as polyglycolic acid (PGA) which is marketed under
the trade name Vicryl, polylactic acid (PLA or PLLA), polydioxanone (PDS), polyhydroxyalkanoate
(PHA), poliglecaprone 25 (PGCL) which is marketed under the trade name Monocryl, polycaprolactone
(PCL), and/or a composite of PGA, PLA, PDS, PHA, PGCL and/or PCL, for example. The
layers of the cartridge body 1010 may not be connected to one another other than by
the staples 1020 contained therein. For example, the frictional engagement between
the staple legs 1021 and the cartridge body 1010, for example, can hold the layers
of the cartridge body 1010 together and, once the staples have been formed, the layers
can be captured within the staples 1020. At least a portion of the staple legs 1021
can comprise a roughened surface or rough coating which can increase the friction
forces between the staples 1020 and the cartridge body 1010.
[0273] As described above, a surgical instrument can comprise a first jaw including the
staple cartridge support 1030 and a second jaw including the anvil 1040. Optionally,
as described in greater detail further below, the staple cartridge 1000 can comprise
one or more retention features which can be configured to engage the staple cartridge
support 1030 and, as a result, releasably retain the staple cartridge 1000 to the
staple cartridge support 1030. The staple cartridge 1000 can be adhered to the staple
cartridge support 1030 by at least one adhesive, such as fibrin and/or protein hydrogel,
for example. In use, in at least one circumstance, especially in laparoscopic and/or
endoscopic surgery, the second jaw can be moved into a closed position opposite the
first jaw, for example, such that the first and second jaws can be inserted through
a trocar into a surgical site. For example, the trocar can define an approximately
5mm aperture, or cannula, through which the first and second jaws can be inserted.
The second jaw can be moved into a partially-closed position intermediate the open
position and the closed position which can allow the first and second jaws to be inserted
through the trocar without deforming the staples 1020 contained in the staple cartridge
body 1010. For example, the anvil 1040 may not apply a compressive force to the staple
cartridge body 1010 when the second jaw is in its partially-closed intermediate position
while, the anvil 1040 can compress the staple cartridge body 1010 when the second
jaw is in its partially-closed intermediate position. Even though the anvil 1040 can
compress the staple cartridge body 1010 when it is in such an intermediate position,
the anvil 1040 may not sufficiently compress the staple cartridge body 1010 such that
the anvil 1040 comes into contact with the staples 1020 and/or such that the staples
1020 are deformed by the anvil 1040. Once the first and second jaws have been inserted
through the trocar into the surgical site, the second j aw can be opened once again
and the anvil 1040 and the staple cartridge 1000 can be positioned relative to the
targeted tissue as described above.
[0274] Referring now to FIGS. 7A-7D, an end effector of a surgical stapler can comprise
an implantable staple cartridge 1100 positioned intermediate an anvil 1140 and a staple
cartridge support 1130. Similar to the above, the anvil 1140 can comprise a tissue-contacting
surface 1141, the staple cartridge 1100 can comprise a tissue-contacting surface 1119,
and the staple cartridge support 1130 can comprise a support surface 1131 which can
be configured to support the staple cartridge 1100. Referring to FIG. 7A, the anvil
1140 can be utilized to position the tissue T against the tissue contacting surface
1119 of staple cartridge 1100 without deforming the staple cartridge 1100 and, when
the anvil 1140 is in such a position, the tissue-contacting surface 1141 can be positioned
a distance 1101a away from the staple cartridge support surface 1131 and the tissue-contacting
surface 1119 can be positioned a distance 1102a away from the staple cartridge support
surface 1131. Thereafter, as the anvil 1140 is moved toward the staple cartridge support
1130, referring now to FIG. 7B, the anvil 1140 can push the top surface, or tissue-contacting
surface 1119, of staple cartridge 1100 downwardly and compress the first layer 1111
and the second layer 1112 of cartridge body 1110. As the layers 1111 and 1112 are
compressed, referring again to FIG. 7B, the second layer 1112 can be crushed and the
legs 1121 of staples 1120 can pierce the first layer 1111 and enter into the tissue
T. For example, the staples 1120 can be at least partially positioned within staple
cavities, or voids, 1115 in the second layer 1112 and, when the second layer 1112
is compressed, the staple cavities 1115 can collapse and, as a result, allow the second
layer 1112 to collapse around the staples 1120. The second layer 1112 can comprise
cover portions 1116 which can extend over the staple cavities 1115 and enclose, or
at least partially enclose, the staple cavities 1115. FIG. 7B illustrates the cover
portions 1116 being crushed downwardly into the staple cavities 1115. The second layer
1112 can comprise one or more weakened portions which can facilitate the collapse
of the second layer 1112. Optionally, such weakened portions can comprise score marks,
perforations, and/or thin cross-sections, for example, which can facilitate a controlled
collapse of the cartridge body 1110. The first layer 1111 can comprise one or more
weakened portions which can facilitate the penetration of the staple legs 1121 through
the first layer 1111. Optionally, such weakened portions can comprise score marks,
perforations, and/or thin cross-sections, for example, which can be aligned, or at
least substantially aligned, with the staple legs 1121.
[0275] When the anvil 1140 is in a partially closed, unfired position, referring again to
FIG. 7A, the anvil 1140 can be positioned a distance 1101a away from the cartridge
support surface 1131 such that a gap is defined therebetween. This gap can be filled
by the staple cartridge 1100, having a staple cartridge height 1102a, and the tissue
T. As the anvil 1140 is moved downwardly to compress the staple cartridge 1100, referring
again to FIG. 7B, the distance between the tissue contacting surface 1141 and the
cartridge support surface 1131 can be defined by a distance 1101b which is shorter
than the distance 1101a. In various circumstances, the gap between the tissue-contacting
surface 1141 of anvil 1140 and the cartridge support surface 1131, defined by distance
1101b, may be larger than the original, undeformed staple cartridge height 1102a.
As the anvil 1140 is moved closer to the cartridge support surface 1131, referring
now to FIG. 7C, the second layer 1112 can continue to collapse and the distance between
the staple legs 1121 and the forming pockets 1142 can decrease. Similarly, the distance
between the tissue-contacting surface 1141 and the cartridge support surface 1131
can decrease to a distance 1101c which may be greater than, equal to, or less than
the original, undeformed cartridge height 1102a. Referring now to FIG. 7D, the anvil
1140 can be moved into a final, fired position in which the staples 1120 have been
fully formed, or at least formed to a desired height. In such a position, the tissue-contacting
surface 1141 of anvil 1140 can be a distance 1101 d away from the cartridge support
surface 1131, wherein the distance 1101 d can be shorter than the original, undeformed
cartridge height 1102a. As also illustrated in FIG. 7D, the staple cavities 1115 may
be fully, or at least substantially, collapsed and the staples 1120 may be completely,
or at least substantially, surrounded by the collapsed second layer 1112. In various
circumstances, the anvil 1140 can be thereafter moved away from the staple cartridge
1100. Once the anvil 1140 has been disengaged from the staple cartridge 1100, the
cartridge body 1110 can at least partially re-expand in various locations, i.e., locations
intermediate adjacent staples 1120, for example. The crushed cartridge body 1110 may
not resiliently re-expand. The formed staples 1120 and, in addition, the cartridge
body 1110 positioned intermediate adjacent staples 1120 may apply pressure, or compressive
forces, to the tissue T which may provide various therapeutic benefits.
[0276] As discussed above, referring again to FIG. 7A, each staple 1120 can comprise staple
legs 1121 extending therefrom. Although staples 1120 are depicted as comprising two
staple legs 1121, various staples can be utilized which can comprise one staple leg
or, alternatively, more than two staple legs, such as three staple legs or four staple
legs, for example. As illustrated in FIG. 7A, each staple leg 1121 can be embedded
in the second layer 1112 of the cartridge body 1110 such that the staples 1120 are
secured within the second layer 1112. The staples 1120 can be inserted into the staple
cavities 1115 in cartridge body 1110 such that the tips 1123 of the staple legs 1121
enter into the cavities 1115 before the bases 1122. After the tips 1123 have been
inserted into the cavities 1115, the tips 1123 can be pressed into the cover portions
1116 and incise the second layer 1112. The staples 1120 can be seated to a sufficient
depth within the second layer 1112 such that the staples 1120 do not move, or at least
substantially move, relative to the second layer 1112. The staples 1120 can be seated
to a sufficient depth within the second layer 1112 such that the bases 1122 are positioned
or embedded within the staple cavities 1115. Alternatively, the bases 1122 may not
be positioned or embedded within the second layer 1112. Referring again to FIG. 7A,
the bases 1122 may extend below the bottom surface 1118 of the cartridge body 1110.
The bases 1122 can rest on, or can be directly positioned against, the cartridge support
surface 1130. The cartridge support surface 1130 can comprise support features extending
therefrom and/or defined therein wherein, for example, the bases 1122 of the staples
1120 may be positioned within and supported by one or more support grooves, slots,
or troughs, 1132, for example, in the staple cartridge support 1130, as described
in greater detail further below.
[0277] Referring now to FIGS. 8 and 9, a staple cartridge, such as staple cartridge 1200,
for example, can comprise a compressible, implantable cartridge body 1210 comprising
an outer layer 1211 and an inner layer 1212. Similar to the above, the staple cartridge
1200 can comprise a plurality of staples 1220 positioned within the cartridge body
1210. Optionally, each staple 1220 can comprise a base 1222 and one or more staple
legs 1221 extending therefrom. For example, the staple legs 1221 can be inserted into
the inner layer 1212 and seated to a depth in which the bases 1222 of the staples
1220 abut and/or are positioned adjacent to the bottom surface 1218 of the inner layer
1212, for example. In FIGS. 8 and 9, the inner layer 1212 does not comprise staple
cavities configured to receive a portion of the staples 1220 while, alternatively,
the inner layer 1212 can comprise such staple cavities. Further to the above, the
inner layer 1212 can be comprised of a compressible material, such as bioabsorbable
foam and/or oxidized regenerated cellulose (ORC), for example, which can be configured
to allow the cartridge body 1210 to collapse when a compressive load is applied thereto.
The inner layer 1212 can be comprised of a lyophilized foam comprising polylactic
acid (PLA) and/or polyglycolic acid (PGA), for example. The ORC may be commercially
available under the trade name Surgicel and can comprise a loose woven fabric (like
a surgical sponge), loose fibers (like a cotton ball), and/or a foam. The inner layer
1212 can be comprised of a material including medicaments, such as freeze-dried thrombin
and/or fibrin, for example, contained therein and/or coated thereon which can be water-activated
and/or activated by fluids within the patient's body, for example. For example, the
freeze-dried thrombin and/or fibrin can be held on a Vicryl (PGA) matrix, for example.
In certain circumstances, however, the activatable medicaments can be unintentionally
activated when the staple cartridge 1200 is inserted into a surgical site within the
patient, for example. Referring again to FIGS. 8 and 9, the outer layer 1211 can be
comprised of a water impermeable, or at least substantially water impermeable, material
such that liquids do not come into contact with, or at least substantially contact,
the inner layer 1212 until after the cartridge body 1210 has been compressed and the
staple legs have penetrated the outer layer 1211 and/or after the outer layer 1211
has been incised in some fashion. The outer layer 1211 can be comprised of a buttress
material and/or plastic material, such as polydioxanone (PDS) and/or polyglycolic
acid (PGA), for example. The outer layer 1211 can comprise a wrap which surrounds
the inner layer 1212 and the staples 1220. More particularly, the staples 1220 can
be inserted into the inner layer 1212 and the outer layer 1211 can be wrapped around
the subassembly comprising the inner layer 1212 and the staples 1220 and then sealed.
[0278] As described herein, the staples of a staple cartridge can be fully formed by an
anvil when the anvil is moved into a closed position. Alternatively, referring now
to FIGS. 10-13, the staples of a staple cartridge, such as staple cartridge 4100,
for example, can be deformed by an anvil when the anvil is moved into a closed position
and, in addition, by a staple driver system which moves the staples toward the closed
anvil. The staple cartridge 4100 can comprise a compressible cartridge body 4110 which
can be comprised of a foam material, for example, and a plurality of staples 4120
at least partially positioned within the compressible cartridge body 4110. The staple
driver system can comprise a driver holder 4160, a plurality of staple drivers 4162
positioned within the driver holder 4160, and a staple cartridge pan 4180 which can
be configured to retain the staple drivers 4162 in the driver holder 4160. For example,
the staple drivers 4162 can be positioned within one or more slots 4163 in the driver
holder 4160 wherein the sidewalls of the slots 4163 can assist in guiding the staple
drivers 4162 upwardly toward the anvil. The staples 4120 can be supported within the
slots 4163 by the staple drivers 4162 wherein, the staples 4120 can be entirely positioned
in the slots 4163 when the staples 4120 and the staple drivers 4162 are in their unfired
positions. Alternatively, at least a portion of the staples 4120 can extend upwardly
through the open ends 4161 of slots 4163 when the staples 4120 and staple drivers
4162 are in their unfired positions. For example, referring primarily now to FIG.
11, the bases of the staples 4120 can be positioned within the driver holder 4160
and the tips of the staples 4120 can be embedded within the compressible cartridge
body 4110. Approximately one-third of the height of the staples 4120 can be positioned
within the driver holder 4160 and approximately two-thirds of the height of the staples
4120 can be positioned within the cartridge body 4110. Referring to FIG. 10A, the
staple cartridge 4100 can further comprise a water impermeable wrap or membrane 4111
surrounding the cartridge body 4110 and the driver holder 4160, for example.
[0279] In use, the staple cartridge 4100 can be positioned within a staple cartridge channel,
for example, and the anvil can be moved toward the staple cartridge 4100 into a closed
position. The anvil can contact and compress the compressible cartridge body 4110
when the anvil is moved into its closed position. The anvil may not contact the staples
4120 when the anvil is in its closed position. The anvil may contact the legs of the
staples 4120 and at least partially deform the staples 4120 when the anvil is moved
into its closed position. In either event, the staple cartridge 4100 can further comprise
one or more sleds 4170 which can be advanced longitudinally within the staple cartridge
4100 such that the sleds 4170 can sequentially engage the staple drivers 4162 and
move the staple drivers 4162 and the staples 4120 toward the anvil. The sleds 4170
can slide between the staple cartridge pan 4180 and the staple drivers 4162. Where
the closure of the anvil has started the forming process of the staples 4120, the
upward movement of the staples 4120 toward the anvil can complete the forming process
and deform the staples 4120 to their fully formed, or at least desired, height. Where
the closure of the anvil has not deformed the staples 4120, the upward movement of
the staples 4120 toward the anvil can initiate and complete the forming process and
deform the staples 4120 to their fully formed, or at least desired, height. The sleds
4170 can be advanced from a proximal end of the staple cartridge 4100 to a distal
end of the staple cartridge 4100 such that the staples 4120 positioned in the proximal
end of the staple cartridge 4100 are fully formed before the staples 4120 positioned
in the distal end of the staple cartridge 4100 are fully formed. Referring to FIG.
12, the sleds 4170 can each comprise at least one angled or inclined surface 4711
which can be configured to slide underneath the staple drivers 4162 and lift the staple
drivers 4162 as illustrated in FIG. 13.
[0280] Further to the above, the staples 4120 can be formed in order to capture at least
a portion of the tissue T and at least a portion of the compressible cartridge body
4110 of the staple cartridge 4100 therein. After the staples 4120 have been formed,
the anvil and the staple cartridge channel 4130 of the surgical stapler can be moved
away from the implanted staple cartridge 4100. In various circumstances, the cartridge
pan 4180 can be fixedly engaged with the staple cartridge channel 4130 wherein, as
a result, the cartridge pan 4180 can become detached from the compressible cartridge
body 4110 as the staple cartridge channel 4130 is pulled away from the implanted cartridge
body 4110. Referring again to FIG. 10, the cartridge pan 4180 can comprise opposing
side walls 4181 between which the cartridge body 4110 can be removably positioned.
For example, the compressible cartridge body 4110 can be compressed between the side
walls 4181 such that the cartridge body 4110 can be removably retained therebetween
during use and releasably disengaged from the cartridge pan 4180 as the cartridge
pan 4180 is pulled away. For example, the driver holder 4160 can be connected to the
cartridge pan 4180 such that the driver holder 4160, the drivers 4162, and/or the
sleds 4170 can remain in the cartridge pan 4180 when the cartridge pan 4180 is removed
from the surgical site. The drivers 4162 can be ejected from the driver holder 4160
and left within the surgical site. For example, the drivers 4162 can be comprised
of a bioabsorbable material, such as polyglycolic acid (PGA) which is marketed under
the trade name Vicryl, polylactic acid (PLA or PLLA), polydioxanone (PDS), polyhydroxyalkanoate
(PHA), poliglecaprone 25 (PGCL) which is marketed under the trade name Monocryl, polycaprolactone
(PCL), and/or a composite of PGA, PLA, PDS, PHA, PGCL and/or PCL, for example. The
drivers 4162 can be attached to the staples 4120 such that the drivers 4162 are deployed
with the staples 4120. For example, each driver 4162 can comprise a trough configured
to receive the bases of the staples 4120, for example, wherein, the troughs can be
configured to receive the staple bases in a press-fit and/or snap-fit manner.
[0281] Further to the above, the driver holder 4160 and/or the sleds 4170 can be ejected
from the cartridge pan 4180. For example, the sleds 4170 can slide between the cartridge
pan 4180 and the driver holder 4160 such that, as the sleds 4170 are advanced in order
to drive the staple drivers 4162 and staples 4120 upwardly, the sleds 4170 can move
the driver holder 4160 upwardly out of the cartridge pan 4180 as well. For example,
the driver holder 4160 and/or the sleds 4170 can be comprised of a bioabsorbable material,
such as polyglycolic acid (PGA) which is marketed under the trade name Vicryl, polylactic
acid (PLA or PLLA), polydioxanone (PDS), polyhydroxyalkanoate (PHA), poliglecaprone
25 (PGCL) which is marketed under the trade name Monocryl, polycaprolactone (PCL),
and/or a composite of PGA, PLA, PDS, PHA, PGCL and/or PCL, for example. The sleds
4170 can be integrally formed and/or attached to a drive bar, or cutting member, which
pushes the sleds 4170 through the staple cartridge 4100. In such cases, the sleds
4170 may not be ejected from the cartridge pan 4180 and may remain with the surgical
stapler while, in other cases in which the sleds 4170 are not attached to the drive
bar, the sleds 4170 may be left in the surgical site. In any event, further to the
above, the compressibility of the cartridge body 4110 can allow thicker staple cartridges
to be used within an end effector of a surgical stapler as the cartridge body 4110
can compress, or shrink, when the anvil of the stapler is closed. As a result of the
staples being at least partially deformed upon the closure of the anvil, taller staples,
such as staples having an approximately 0.18" staple height, for example, could be
used, wherein approximately 0.12" of the staple height can be positioned within the
compressible layer 4110 and wherein the compressible layer 4110 can have an uncompressed
height of approximately 0.14", for example.
[0282] As described herein, a staple cartridge can comprise a plurality of staples therein.
Optionally, such staples can be comprised of a metal wire deformed into a substantially
U-shaped configuration having two staple legs. Alternatives are envisioned in which
staples can comprise different configurations such as two or more wires that have
been joined together having three or more staple legs. The wire, or wires, used to
form the staples can comprise a round, or at least substantially round, cross-section.
The staple wires can comprise any other suitable cross-section, such as square and/or
rectangular cross-sections, for example. The staples can be comprised of plastic wires.
The staples can be comprised of plastic-coated metal wires. According to the invention,
a cartridge can comprise any suitable type of fastener in addition to or in lieu of
staples. For example, such a fastener can comprise pivotable arms which are folded
when engaged by an anvil. Two-part fasteners could be utilized. For example, a staple
cartridge can comprise a plurality of first fastener portions and an anvil can comprise
a plurality of second fastener portions which are connected to the first fastener
portions when the anvil is compressed against the staple cartridge. As described above,
a sled or driver can be advanced within a staple cartridge in order to complete the
forming process of the staples. A sled or driver can be advanced within an anvil in
order to move one or more forming members downwardly into engagement with the opposing
staple cartridge and the staples, or fasteners, positioned therein.
[0283] As described herein, a staple cartridge can comprise four rows of staples stored
therein. The four staple rows can be arranged in two inner staple rows and two outer
staple rows. For example, an inner staple row and an outer staple row can be positioned
on a first side of a cutting member, or knife, slot within the staple cartridge and,
similarly, an inner staple row and an outer staple row can be positioned on a second
side of the cutting member, or knife, slot. A staple cartridge may not comprise a
cutting member slot; however, such a staple cartridge may comprise a designated portion
configured to be incised by a cutting member in lieu of a staple cartridge slot. The
inner staple rows can be arranged within the staple cartridge such that they are equally,
or at least substantially equally, spaced from the cutting member slot. Similarly,
the outer staple rows can be arranged within the staple cartridge such that they are
equally, or at least substantially equally, spaced from the cutting member slot. According
to the invention, a staple cartridge can comprise more than or less than four rows
of staples stored within a staple cartridge. A staple cartridge can comprise six rows
of staples. For example, the staple cartridge can comprise three rows of staples on
a first side of a cutting member slot and three rows of staples on a second side of
the cutting member slot. A staple cartridge may comprise an odd number of staple rows.
For example, a staple cartridge may comprise two rows of staples on a first side of
a cutting member slot and three rows of staples on a second side of the cutting member
slot. The staple rows can comprise staples having the same, or at least substantially
the same, unformed staple height. Alternatively, one or more of the staple rows can
comprise staples having a different unformed staple height than the other staples.
For example, the staples on a first side of a cutting member slot may have a first
unformed height and the staples on a second side of a cutting member slot may have
a second unformed height which is different than the first height, for example.
[0284] Optionally, as described above, a staple cartridge can comprise a cartridge body
including a plurality of staple cavities defined therein. The cartridge body can comprise
a deck and a top deck surface wherein each staple cavity can define an opening in
the deck surface. As also described above, a staple can be positioned within each
staple cavity such that the staples are stored within the cartridge body until they
are ejected therefrom. Prior to being ejected from the cartridge body, the staples
can be contained with the cartridge body such that the staples do not protrude above
the deck surface. As the staples are positioned below the deck surface, In such cases,
the possibility of the staples becoming damaged and/or prematurely contacting the
targeted tissue can be reduced. In various circumstances, the staples can be moved
between an unfired position in which they do not protrude from the cartridge body
and a fired position in which they have emerged from the cartridge body and can contact
an anvil positioned opposite the staple cartridge. The anvil, and/or the forming pockets
defined within the anvil, can be positioned a predetermined distance above the deck
surface such that, as the staples are being deployed from the cartridge body, the
staples are deformed to a predetermined formed height. In some circumstances, the
thickness of the tissue captured between the anvil and the staple cartridge may vary
and, as a result, thicker tissue may be captured within certain staples while thinner
tissue may be captured within certain other staples. In either event, the clamping
pressure, or force, applied to the tissue by the staples may vary from staple to staple
or vary between a staple on one end of a staple row and a staple on the other end
of the staple row, for example. In certain circumstances, the gap between the anvil
and the staple cartridge deck can be controlled such that the staples apply a certain
minimum clamping pressure within each staple. In some such circumstances, however,
significant variation of the clamping pressure within different staples may still
exist. Surgical stapling instruments are disclosed in
U.S. Patent No. 7,380,696, which issued on June 3, 2008, the entire disclosure of which is incorporated by reference herein. An illustrative
multi-stroke handle for the surgical stapling and severing instrument is described
in greater detail in the co-pending and co-owned U.S. patent application entitled
SURGICAL STAPLING INSTRUMENT INCORPORATING A MULTISTROKE FIRING POSITION INDICATOR
AND RETRACTION MECHANISM, Ser. No. 10/374,026, the disclosure of which is hereby incorporated
by reference in its entirety. Other applications consistent with the present invention
may incorporate a single firing stroke, such as described in co-pending and commonly
owned U.S. patent application SURGICAL STAPLING INSTRUMENT HAVING SEPARATE DISTINCT
CLOSING AND FIRING SYSTEMS, Ser. No.
10/441,632, the disclosure of which is hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety.
[0285] As described herein, a staple cartridge can comprise means for compensating for the
thickness of the tissue captured within the staples deployed from the staple cartridge.
Referring to FIG. 14, a staple cartridge, such as staple cartridge 10000, for example,
can include a rigid first portion, such as support portion 10010, for example, and
a compressible second portion, such as tissue thickness compensator 10020, for example.
Referring primarily to FIG. 16, the support portion 10010 can comprise a cartridge
body, a top deck surface 10011, and a plurality of staple cavities 10012 wherein,
similar to the above, each staple cavity 10012 can define an opening in the deck surface
10011. A staple 10030, for example, can be removably positioned in each staple cavity
10012. For example, each staple 10030 can comprise a base 10031 and one or more legs
10032 extending from the base 10031. Prior to the staples 10030 being deployed, as
also described in greater detail below, the bases 10031 of the staples 10030 can be
supported by staple drivers positioned within the support portion 10010 and, concurrently,
the legs 10032 of the staples 10030 can be at least partially contained within the
staple cavities 10012. The staples 10030 can be deployed between an unfired position
and a fired position such that the legs 10032 move through the tissue thickness compensator
10020, penetrate through a top surface of the tissue thickness compensator 10020,
penetrate the tissue T, and contact an anvil positioned opposite the staple cartridge
10000. As the legs 10032 are deformed against the anvil, the legs 10032 of each staple
10030 can capture a portion of the tissue thickness compensator 10020 and a portion
of the tissue T within each staple 10030 and apply a compressive force to the tissue.
Further to the above, the legs 10032 of each staple 10030 can be deformed downwardly
toward the base 10031 of the staple to form a staple entrapment area 10039 in which
the tissue T and the tissue thickness compensator 10020 can be captured. In various
circumstances, the staple entrapment area 10039 can be defined between the inner surfaces
of the deformed legs 10032 and the inner surface of the base 10031. The size of the
entrapment area for a staple can depend on several factors such as the length of the
legs, the diameter of the legs, the width of the base, and/or the extent in which
the legs are deformed, for example.
[0286] Previously, a surgeon was often required to select the appropriate staples having
the appropriate staple height for the tissue being stapled. For example, a surgeon
could select tall staples for use with thick tissue and short staples for use with
thin tissue. In some circumstances, however, the tissue being stapled did not have
a consistent thickness and, thus, some staples were unable to achieve the desired
fired configuration. For example, FIG. 48 illustrates a tall staple used in thin tissue.
Referring now to FIG. 49, when a tissue thickness compensator, such as tissue thickness
compensator 10020, for example, is used with thin tissue, for example, the larger
staple may be formed to a desired fired configuration.
[0287] Owing to the compressibility of the tissue thickness compensator, the tissue thickness
compensator can compensate for the thickness of the tissue captured within each staple.
More particularly, referring now to FIGS. 43 and 44, a tissue thickness compensator,
such as tissue thickness compensator 10020, for example, can consume larger and/or
smaller portions of the staple entrapment area 10039 of each staple 10030 depending
on the thickness and/or type of tissue contained within the staple entrapment area
10039. For example, if thinner tissue T is captured within a staple 10030, the tissue
thickness compensator 10020 can consume a larger portion of the staple entrapment
area 10039 as compared to circumstances where thicker tissue T is captured within
the staple 10030. Correspondingly, if thicker tissue T is captured within a staple
10030, the tissue thickness compensator 10020 can consume a smaller portion of the
staple entrapment area 10039 as compared to the circumstances where thinner tissue
T is captured within the staple 10030. In this way, the tissue thickness compensator
can compensate for thinner tissue and/or thicker tissue and assure that a compressive
pressure is applied to the tissue irrespective, or at least substantially irrespective,
of the tissue thickness captured within the staples. In addition to the above, the
tissue thickness compensator 10020 can compensate for different types, or compressibilities,
of tissues captured within different staples 10030. Referring now to FIG. 44, the
tissue thickness compensator 10020 can apply a compressive force to vascular tissue
T which can include vessels V and, as a result, restrict the flow of blood through
the less compressible vessels V while still applying a desired compressive pressure
to the surrounding tissue T. In various circumstances, further to the above, the tissue
thickness compensator 10020 can also compensate for malformed staples. Referring to
FIG. 45, the malformation of various staples 10030 can result in larger staple entrapment
areas 10039 being defined within such staples. Owing to the resiliency of the tissue
thickness compensator 10020, referring now to FIG. 46, the tissue thickness compensator
10020 positioned within malformed staples 10030 may still apply a sufficient compressive
pressure to the tissue T even though the staple entrapment areas 10039 defined within
such malformed staples 10030 may be enlarged. In various circumstances, the tissue
thickness compensator 10020 located intermediate adjacent staples 10030 can be biased
against the tissue T by properly-formed staples 10030 surrounding a malformed staple
10030 and, as a result, apply a compressive pressure to the tissue surrounding and/or
captured within the malformed staple 10030, for example. In various circumstances,
a tissue thickness compensator can compensate for different tissue densities which
can arise due to calcifications, fibrous areas, and/or tissue that has been previously
stapled or treated, for example.
[0288] According to the invention, a fixed, or unchangeable, tissue gap can be defined between
the support portion and the anvil and, as a result, the staples may be deformed to
a predetermined height regardless of the thickness of the tissue captured within the
staples. When a tissue thickness compensator is used in such cases, the tissue thickness
compensator can adapt to the tissue captured between the anvil and the support portion
staple cartridge and, owing to the resiliency of the tissue thickness compensator,
the tissue thickness compensator can apply an additional compressive pressure to the
tissue. Referring now to FIGS. 50-55, a staple 10030 has been formed to a predefined
height H. With regard to FIG. 50, a tissue thickness compensator has not been utilized
and the tissue T consumes the entirety of the staple entrapment area 10039. With regard
to FIG. 57, a portion of a tissue thickness compensator 10020 has been captured within
the staple 10030, compressed the tissue T, and consumed at least a portion of the
staple entrapment area 10039. Referring now to FIG. 52, thin tissue T has been captured
within the staple 10030. In this embodiment, the compressed tissue T has a height
of approximately 2/9H and the compressed tissue thickness compensator 10020 has a
height of approximately 7/9H, for example. Referring now to FIG. 53, tissue T having
an intermediate thickness has been captured within the staple 10030. In this embodiment,
the compressed tissue T has a height of approximately 4/9H and the compressed tissue
thickness compensator 10020 has a height of approximately 5/9H, for example. Referring
now to FIG. 54, tissue T having an intermediate thickness has been captured within
the staple 10030. In this embodiment, the compressed tissue T has a height of approximately
2/3H and the compressed tissue thickness compensator 10020 has a height of approximately
1/3H, for example. Referring now to FIG. 53, thick tissue T has been captured within
the staple 10030. In this embodiment, the compressed tissue T has a height of approximately
8/9H and the compressed tissue thickness compensator 10020 has a height of approximately
1/9H, for example. In various circumstances, the tissue thickness compensator can
comprise a compressed height which comprises approximately 10% of the staple entrapment
height, approximately 20% of the staple entrapment height, approximately 30% of the
staple entrapment height, approximately 40% of the staple entrapment height, approximately
50% of the staple entrapment height, approximately 60% of the staple entrapment height,
approximately 70% of the staple entrapment height, approximately 80% of the staple
entrapment height, and/or approximately 90% of the staple entrapment height, for example.
[0289] The staples 10030 can comprise any suitable unformed height. The staples 10030 can
comprise an unformed height between approximately 2 mm and approximately 4.8 mm, for
example. The staples 10030 can comprise an unformed height of approximately 2.0 mm,
approximately 2.5 mm, approximately 3.0 mm, approximately 3.4 mm, approximately 3.5
mm, approximately 3.8 mm, approximately 4.0 mm, approximately 4.1 mm, and/or approximately
4.8 mm, for example. The height H to which the staples can be deformed can be dictated
by the distance between the deck surface 10011 of the support portion 10010 and the
opposing anvil. The distance between the deck surface 10011 and the tissue-contacting
surface of the anvil can be approximately 0.097", for example. The height H can also
be dictated by the depth of the forming pockets defined within the anvil. The forming
pockets can have a depth measured from the tissue-contacting surface, for example.
Optionally, as described in greater detail below, the staple cartridge 10000 can further
comprise staple drivers which can lift the staples 10030 toward the anvil and, lift,
or "overdrive", the staples above the deck surface 10011. In such cases, the height
H to which the staples 10030 are formed can also be dictated by the distance in which
the staples 10030 are overdriven. For example, the staples 10030 can be overdriven
by approximately .028", for example, and can result in the staples 10030 being formed
to a height of approximately 0.189", for example. The staples 10030 can be formed
to a height of approximately 0.8 mm, approximately 1.0 mm, approximately 1.5 mm, approximately
1.8 mm, approximately 2.0 mm, and/or approximately 2.25 mm, for example. The staples
can be formed to a height between approximately 2.25 mm and approximately 3.0 mm,
for example. Further to the above, the height of the staple entrapment area of a staple
can be determined by the formed height of the staple and the width, or diameter, of
the wire comprising the staple. The height of the staple entrapment area 10039 of
a staple 10030 can comprise the formed height H of the staple less two diameter widths
of the wire. The staple wire can comprise a diameter of approximately 0.0089", for
example. The staple wire can comprise a diameter between approximately 0.0069" and
approximately 0.0119", for example. For example, the formed height H of a staple 10030
can be approximately 0.189" and the staple wire diameter can be approximately 0.0089"
resulting in a staple entrapment height of approximately 0.171", for example.
[0290] Further to the above, the tissue thickness compensator can comprise an uncompressed,
or pre-deployed, height and can be configured to deform to one of a plurality of compressed
heights. The tissue thickness compensator can comprise an uncompressed height of approximately
0.125", for example. The tissue thickness compensator can comprise an uncompressed
height of greater than or equal to approximately 0.080", for example. The tissue thickness
compensator can comprise an uncompressed, or pre-deployed, height which is greater
than the unfired height of the staples. The uncompressed, or pre-deployed, height
of the tissue thickness compensator can be approximately 10% taller, approximately
20% taller, approximately 30% taller, approximately 40% taller, approximately 50%
taller, approximately 60% taller, approximately 70% taller, approximately 80% taller,
approximately 90% taller, and/or approximately 100% taller than the unfired height
of the staples, for example. The uncompressed, or pre-deployed, height of the tissue
thickness compensator can be up to approximately 100% taller than the unfired height
of the staples, for example. The uncompressed, or pre-deployed, height of the tissue
thickness compensator can be over 100% taller than the unfired height of the staples,
for example. The tissue thickness compensator can comprise an uncompressed height
which is equal to the unfired height of the staples. The tissue thickness compensator
can comprise an uncompressed height which is less than the unfired height of the staples.
The uncompressed, or pre-deployed, height of the thickness compensator can be approximately
10% shorter, approximately 20% shorter, approximately 30% shorter, approximately 40%
shorter, approximately 50% shorter, approximately 60% shorter, approximately 70% shorter,
approximately 80% shorter, and/or approximately 90% shorter than the unfired height
of the staples, for example. The compressible second portion can comprise an uncompressed
height which is taller than an uncompressed height of the tissue T being stapled.
The tissue thickness compensator can comprise an uncompressed height which is equal
to an uncompressed height of the tissue T being stapled. The tissue thickness compensator
can comprise an uncompressed height which is shorter than an uncompressed height of
the tissue T being stapled.
[0291] As described above, a tissue thickness compensator can be compressed within a plurality
of formed staples regardless of whether thick tissue or thin tissue is captured within
the staples. For example, the staples within a staple line, or row, can be deformed
such that the staple entrapment area of each staple comprises a height of approximately
2.0 mm, for example, wherein the tissue T and the tissue thickness compensator can
be compressed within this height. In certain circumstances, the tissue T can comprise
a compressed height of approximately 1.75 mm within the staple entrapment area while
the tissue thickness compensator can comprise a compressed height of approximately
0.25 mm within the staple entrapment area, thereby totaling the approximately 2.0
mm staple entrapment area height, for example. In certain circumstances, the tissue
T can comprise a compressed height of approximately 1.50 mm within the staple entrapment
area while the tissue thickness compensator can comprise a compressed height of approximately
0.50 mm within the staple entrapment area, thereby totaling the approximately 2.0
mm staple entrapment area height, for example. In certain circumstances, the tissue
T can comprise a compressed height of approximately 1.25 mm within the staple entrapment
area while the tissue thickness compensator can comprise a compressed height of approximately
0.75 mm within the staple entrapment area, thereby totaling the approximately 2.0
mm staple entrapment area height, for example. In certain circumstances, the tissue
T can comprise a compressed height of approximately 1.0 mm within the staple entrapment
area while the tissue thickness compensator can comprise a compressed height of approximately
1.0 mm within the staple entrapment area, thereby totaling the approximately 2.0 mm
staple entrapment area height, for example. In certain circumstances, the tissue T
can comprise a compressed height of approximately 0.75 mm within the staple entrapment
area while the tissue thickness compensator can comprise a compressed height of approximately
1.25 mm within the staple entrapment area, thereby totaling the approximately 2.0
mm staple entrapment area height, for example. In certain circumstances, the tissue
T can comprise a compressed height of approximately 1.50 mm within the staple entrapment
area while the tissue thickness compensator can comprise a compressed height of approximately
0.50 mm within the staple entrapment area, thereby totaling the approximately 2.0
mm staple entrapment area height, for example. In certain circumstances, the tissue
T can comprise a compressed height of approximately 0.25 mm within the staple entrapment
area while the tissue thickness compensator can comprise a compressed height of approximately
1.75 mm within the staple entrapment area, thereby totaling the approximately 2.0
mm staple entrapment area height, for example.
[0292] Further to the above, the tissue thickness compensator can comprise an uncompressed
height which is less than the fired height of the staples. The tissue thickness compensator
can comprise an uncompressed height which is equal to the fired height of the staples.
The tissue thickness compensator can comprise an uncompressed height which is taller
than the fired height of the staples. For example, the uncompressed height of a tissue
thickness compensator can comprise a thickness which is approximately 110% of the
formed staple height, approximately 120% of the formed staple height, approximately
130% of the formed staple height, approximately 140% of the formed staple height,
approximately 150% of the formed staple height, approximately 160% of the formed staple
height, approximately 170% of the formed staple height, approximately 180% of the
formed staple height, approximately 190% of the formed staple height, and/or approximately
200% of the formed staple height, for example. The tissue thickness compensator can
comprise an uncompressed height which is more than twice the fired height of the staples.
The tissue thickness compensator can comprise a compressed height which is from approximately
85% to approximately 150% of the formed staple height, for example. Optionally, as
described above, the tissue thickness compensator can be compressed between an uncompressed
thickness and a compressed thickness. The compressed thickness of a tissue thickness
compensator can be approximately 10% of its uncompressed thickness, approximately
20% of its uncompressed thickness, approximately 30% of its uncompressed thickness,
approximately 40% of its uncompressed thickness, approximately 50% of its uncompressed
thickness, approximately 60% of its uncompressed thickness, approximately 70% of its
uncompressed thickness, approximately 80% of its uncompressed thickness, and/ or approximately
90% of its uncompressed thickness, for example. The uncompressed thickness of the
tissue thickness compensator can be approximately two times, approximately ten times,
approximately fifty times, and/or approximately one hundred times thicker than its
compressed thickness, for example. The compressed thickness of the tissue thickness
compensator can be between approximately 60% and approximately 99% of its uncompressed
thickness. The uncompressed thickness of the tissue thickness compensator can be at
least 50% thicker than its compressed thickness. The uncompressed thickness of the
tissue thickness compensator can be up to one hundred times thicker than its compressed
thickness. The compressible second portion can be elastic, or at least partially elastic,
and can bias the tissue T against the deformed legs of the staples. For example, the
compressible second portion can resiliently expand between the tissue T and the base
of the staple in order to push the tissue T against the legs of the staple. As discussed
in further detail below, the tissue thickness compensator can be positioned intermediate
the tissue T and the deformed staple legs. In various circumstances, as a result of
the above, the tissue thickness compensator can be configured to consume any gaps
within the staple entrapment area.
[0293] The tissue thickness compensator may comprise materials characterized by one or more
of the following properties: biocompatible, bioabsorbable, bioresorbable, biodurable,
biodegradable, compressible, fluid absorbable, swellable, self-expandable, bioactive,
medicament, pharmaceutically active, anti-adhesion, haemostatic, antibiotic, anti-microbial,
antiviral, nutritional, adhesive, permeable, hydrophilic and/or hydrophobic, for example.
According to the invention, a surgical instrument comprising an anvil and a staple
cartridge may comprise a tissue thickness compensator associated with the anvil and/or
staple cartridge comprising at least one of a haemostatic agent, such as fibrin and
thrombin, an antibiotic, such as doxycpl, and medicament, such as matrix metalloproteinases
(MMPs).
[0294] The tissue thickness compensator may comprise synthetic and/or non-synthetic materials.
The tissue thickness compensator may comprise a polymeric composition comprising one
or more synthetic polymers and/or one or more non-synthetic polymers. The synthetic
polymer may comprise a synthetic absorbable polymer and/or a synthetic non-absorbable
polymer. The polymeric composition may comprise a biocompatible foam, for example.
The biocompatible foam may comprise a porous, open cell foam and/or a porous, closed
cell foam, for example. The biocompatible foam may have a uniform pore morphology
or may have a gradient pore morphology (i.e. small pores gradually increasing in size
to large pores across the thickness of the foam in one direction). The polymeric composition
may comprise one or more of a porous scaffold, a porous matrix, a gel matrix, a hydrogel
matrix, a solution matrix, a filamentous matrix, a tubular matrix, a composite matrix,
a membranous matrix, a biostable polymer, and a biodegradable polymer, and combinations
thereof. For example, the tissue thickness compensator may comprise a foam reinforced
by a filamentous matrix or may comprise a foam having an additional hydrogel layer
that expands in the presence of bodily fluids to further provide the compression on
the tissue. According to the invention, a tissue thickness compensator could also
be comprised of a coating on a material and/or a second or third layer that expands
in the presence of bodily fluids to further provide the compression on the tissue.
Such a layer could be a hydrogel that could be a synthetic and/or naturally derived
material and could be either biodurable and/or biodegradable, for example. The tissue
thickness compensator may comprise a microgel or a nanogel. The hydrogel may comprise
carbohydrate-derived microgels and/or nanogels. A tissue thickness compensator may
be reinforced with fibrous non-woven materials or fibrous mesh type elements, for
example, that can provide additional flexibility, stiffness, and/or strength. According
to the invention, a tissue thickness compensator that has a porous morphology which
exhibits a gradient structure such as, for example, small pores on one surface and
larger pores on the other surface. Such morphology could be more optimal for tissue
in-growth or haemostatic behavior. Further, the gradient could be also compositional
with a varying bio-absorption profile. A short term absorption profile may be preferred
to address hemostasis while a long term absorption profile may address better tissue
healing without leakages.
[0295] Examples of non-synthetic materials include, but are not limited to, lyophilized
polysaccharide, glycoprotein, bovine pericardium, collagen, gelatin, fibrin, fibrinogen,
elastin, proteoglycan, keratin, albumin, hydroxyethyl cellulose, cellulose, oxidized
cellulose, oxidized regenerated cellulose (ORC), hydroxypropyl cellulose, carboxyethyl
cellulose, carboxymethylcellulose, chitan, chitosan, casein, alginate, and combinations
thereof.
[0296] Examples of synthetic absorbable materials include, but are not limited to, poly(lactic
acid) (PLA), poly(L-lactic acid) (PLLA), polycaprolactone (PCL), polyglycolic acid
(PGA), poly(trimethylene carbonate) (TMC), polyethylene terephthalate (PET), polyhydroxyalkanoate
(PHA), a copolymer of glycolide and ε-caprolactone (PGCL), a copolymer of glycolide
and-trimethylene carbonate, poly(glycerol sebacate) (PGS), poly(dioxanone) (PDS),
polyesters, poly(orthoesters), polyoxaesters, polyetheresters, polycarbonates, polyamide
esters, polyanhydrides, polysaccharides, poly(ester-amides), tyrosine-based polyarylates,
polyamines, tyrosine-based polyiminocarbonates, tyrosine-based polycarbonates, poly(D,L-lactide-urethane),
poly(hydroxybutyrate), poly(B-hydroxybutyrate), poly(E-caprolactone), polyethyleneglycol
(PEG), poly[bis(carboxylatophenoxy) phosphazene] poly(amino acids), pseudo-poly(amino
acids), absorbable polyurethanes, poly (phosphazine), polyphosphazenes, polyalkyleneoxides,
polyacrylamides, polyhydroxyethylmethylacrylate, polyvinylpyrrolidone, polyvinyl alcohols,
poly(caprolactone), polyacrylic acid, polyacetate, polypropylene, aliphatic polyesters,
glycerols, copoly(ether-esters), polyalkylene oxalates, polyamides, poly(iminocarbonates),
polyalkylene oxalates, and combinations thereof. The polyester is may be selected
from the group consisting of polylactides, polyglycolides, trimethylene carbonates,
polydioxanones, polycaprolactones, polybutesters, and combinations thereof.
[0297] The synthetic absorbable polymer may comprise one or more of 90/10 poly(glycolide-L-lactide)
copolymer, commercially available from Ethicon, Inc. under the trade designation VICRYL
(polyglactic 910), polyglycolide, commercially available from American Cyanamid Co.
under the trade designation DEXON, polydioxanone, commercially available from Ethicon,
Inc. under the trade designation PDS, poly(glycolide-trimethylene carbonate) random
block copolymer, commercially available from American Cyanamid Co. under the trade
designation MAXON, 75/25 poly(glycolide-ε-caprolactone-poliglecaprolactone 25) copolymer,
commercially available from Ethicon under the trade designation MONOCRYL, for example.
[0298] Examples of synthetic non-absorbable materials include, but are not limited to, polyurethane,
polypropylene (PP), polyethylene (PE), polycarbonate, polyamides, such as nylon, polyvinylchloride
(PVC), polymethylmetacrylate (PMMA), polystyrene (PS), polyester, polyetheretherketone
(PEEK), polytetrafluoroethylene (PTFE), polytrifluorochloroethylene (PTFCE), polyvinylfluoride
(PVF), fluorinated ethylene propylene (FEP), polyacetal, polysulfone, silicons, and
combinations thereof. The synthetic non-absorbable polymers may include, but are not
limited to, foamed elastomers and porous elastomers, such as, for example, silicone,
polyisoprene, and rubber. The synthetic polymers may comprise expanded polytetrafluoroethylene
(ePTFE), commercially available from W. L. Gore & Associates, Inc. under the trade
designation GORE-TEX Soft Tissue Patch and co-polyetherester urethane foam commercially
available from Polyganics under the trade designation NASOPORE.
[0299] The polymeric composition may comprise from approximately 50% to approximately 90%
by weight of the polymeric composition of PLLA and approximately 50% to approximately
10% by weight of the polymeric composition of PCL, for example. The polymeric composition
may comprise approximately 70% by weight of PLLA and approximately 30% by weight of
PCL, for example. The polymeric composition may comprise from approximately 55% to
approximately 85% by weight of the polymeric composition of PGA and 15% to 45% by
weight of the polymeric composition of PCL, for example. The polymeric composition
may comprise approximately 65% by weight of PGA and approximately 35% by weight of
PCL, for example. The polymeric composition may comprise from approximately 90% to
approximately 95% by weight of the polymeric composition of PGA and approximately
5% to approximately 10% by weight of the polymeric composition of PLA, for example.
[0300] The synthetic absorbable polymer may comprise a bioabsorbable, biocompatible elastomeric
copolymer. Suitable bioabsorbable, biocompatible elastomeric copolymers include but
are not limited to copolymers of ε-caprolactone and glycolide (preferably having a
mole ratio of ε-caprolactone to glycolide of from about 30:70 to about 70:30, preferably
35:65 to about 65:35, and more preferably 45:55 to 35:65); elastomeric copolymers
of ε-caprolactone and lactide, including L-lactide, D-lactide blends thereof or lactic
acid copolymers (preferably having a mole ratio of ε-caprolactone to lactide of from
about 35:65 to about 65:35 and more preferably 45:55 to 30:70) elastomeric copolymers
of p-dioxanone (1,4-dioxan-2-one) and lactide including L-lactide, D-lactide and lactic
acid (preferably having a mole ratio of p-dioxanone to lactide of from about 40:60
to about 60:40); elastomeric copolymers of ε-caprolactone and p-dioxanone (preferably
having a mole ratio of ε-caprolactone to p-dioxanone of from about 30:70 to about
70:30); elastomeric copolymers of p-dioxanone and trimethylene carbonate (preferably
having a mole ratio ofp-dioxanone to trimethylene carbonate of from about 30:70 to
about 70:30); elastomeric copolymers of trimethylene carbonate and glycolide (preferably
having a mole ratio of trimethylene carbonate to glycolide of from about 30:70 to
about 70:30); elastomeric copolymer of trimethylene carbonate and lactide including
L-lactide, D-lactide, blends thereof or lactic acid copolymers (preferably having
a mole ratio of trimethylene carbonate to lactide of from about 30:70 to about 70:30)
and blends thereof. The elastomeric copolymer may be a copolymer of glycolide and
ε-caprolactone. Alternatively, the elastomeric copolymer is a copolymer of lactide
and ε-caprolactone.
[0301] The disclosures of
U.S. Patent No. 5,468,253, entitled ELASTOMERIC MEDICAL DEVICE, which issued on November 21, 1995, and
U.S. Patent No. 6,325,810, entitled FOAM BUTTRESS FOR STAPLING APPARATUS, which issued on December 4, 2001,
are hereby incorporated by reference in their respective entireties.
[0302] The tissue thickness compensator may comprise an emulsifier. Examples of emulsifiers
may include, but are not limited to, water-soluble polymers, such as, polyvinyl alcohol
(PVA), polyvinyl pyrrolidone (PVP), polyethylene glycol (PEG), polypropylene glycol
(PPG), PLURONICS, TWEENS, polysaccharides and combinations thereof.
[0303] The tissue thickness compensator may comprise a surfactant.
Examples of surfactants may include, but are not limited to, polyacrylic acid, methalose,
methyl cellulose, ethyl cellulose, propyl cellulose, hydroxy ethyl cellulose, carboxy
methyl cellulose, polyoxyethylene cetyl ether, polyoxyethylene lauryl ether, polyoxyethylene
octyl ether, polyoxyethylene octylphenyl ether, polyoxyethylene oleyl ether, polyoxyethylene
sorbitan monolaurate, polyoxyethylene stearyl ether, polyoxyethylene nonylphenyl ether,
dialkylphenoxy poly(ethyleneoxy) ethanol, and polyoxamers.
[0304] The polymeric composition may comprise a pharmaceutically active agent. The polymeric
composition may release a therapeutically effective amount of the pharmaceutically
active agent. The pharmaceutically active agent may be released as the polymeric composition
is desorbed/absorbed. The pharmaceutically active agent may be released into fluid,
such as, for example, blood, passing over or through the polymeric composition. Examples
of pharmaceutically active agents may include, but are not limited to, haemostatic
agents and drugs, such as, for example, fibrin, thrombin, and oxidized regenerated
cellulose (ORC); anti-inflammatory drugs, such as, for example, diclofenac, aspirin,
naproxen, sulindac, and hydrocortisone; antibiotic and antimicrobial drug or agents,
such as, for example, triclosan, ionic silver, ampicillin, gentamicin, polymyxin B,
chloramphenicol; and anticancer agents, such as, for example, cisplatin, mitomycin,
adriamycin.
[0305] The polymeric composition may comprise a haemostatic material. The tissue thickness
compensator may comprise haemostatic materials comprising poly(lactic acid), poly(glycolic
acid), poly(hydroxybutyrate), poly(caprolactone), poly(dioxanone), polyalkyleneoxides,
copoly(ether-esters), collagen, gelatin, thrombin, fibrin, fibrinogen, fibronectin,
elastin, albumin, hemoglobin, ovalbumin, polysaccharides, hyaluronic acid, chondroitin
sulfate, hydroxyethyl starch, hydroxyethyl cellulose, cellulose, oxidized cellulose,
hydroxypropyl cellulose, carboxyethyl cellulose, carboxymethyl cellulose, chitan,
chitosan, agarose, maltose, maltodextrin, alginate, clotting factors, methacrylate,
polyurethanes, cyanoacrylates, platelet agonists, vasoconstrictors, alum, calcium,
RGD peptides, proteins, protamine sulfate, ε-amino caproic acid, ferric sulfate, ferric
subsulfates, ferric chloride, zinc, zinc chloride, aluminum chloride, aluminum sulfates,
aluminum acetates, permanganates, tannins, bone wax, polyethylene glycols, fucans
and combinations thereof. The tissue thickness compensator may be characterized by
haemostatic properties.
[0306] The polymeric composition of a tissue thickness compensator may be characterized
by percent porosity, pore size, and/or hardness, for example. The polymeric composition
may have a percent porosity from approximately 30% by volume to approximately 99%
by volume, for example. The polymeric composition may have a percent porosity from
approximately 60% by volume to approximately 98% by volume, for example. The polymeric
composition may have a percent porosity from approximately 85% by volume to approximately
97% by volume, for example. The polymeric composition may comprise approximately 70%
by weight of PLLA and approximately 30% by weight of PCL, for example, and can comprise
approximately 90% porosity by volume, for example. For example, as a result, the polymeric
composition would comprise approximately 10% copolymer by volume. The polymeric composition
may comprise approximately 65% by weight of PGA and approximately 35% by weight of
PCL, for example, and can have a percent porosity from approximately 93% by volume
to approximately 95% by volume, for example. The polymeric composition may comprise
greater than 85% porosity by volume. The polymeric composition may have a pore size
from approximately 5 micrometers to approximately 2000 micrometers, for example. The
polymeric composition may have a pore size between approximately 10 micrometers to
approximately 100 micrometers, for example. For example, the polymeric composition
can comprise a copolymer of PGA and PCL, for example. The polymeric composition may
have a pore size between approximately 100 micrometers to approximately 1000 micrometers,
for example. For example, the polymeric composition can comprise a copolymer of PLLA
and PCL, for example.
[0307] According to certain aspects, the hardness of a polymeric composition may be expressed
in terms of the Shore Hardness, which can defined as the resistance to permanent indentation
of a material as determined with a durometer, such as a Shore Durometer. In order
to assess the durometer value for a given material, a pressure is applied to the material
with a durometer indenter foot in accordance with ASTM procedure D2240-00, entitled,
"Standard Test Method for Rubber Property-Durometer Hardness", the entirety of which
is incorporated herein by reference. The durometer indenter foot may be applied to
the material for a sufficient period of time, such as 15 seconds, for example, wherein
a reading is then taken from the appropriate scale. Depending on the type of scale
being used, a reading of 0 can be obtained when the indenter foot completely penetrates
the material, and a reading of 100 can be obtained when no penetration into the material
occurs. This reading is dimensionless. The durometer may be determined in accordance
with any suitable scale, such as Type A and/or Type OO scales, for example, in accordance
with ASTM D2240-00. The polymeric composition of a tissue thickness compensator may
have a Shore A hardness value from approximately 4 A to approximately 16 A, for example,
which is approximately 45 OO to approximately 65 OO on the Shore OO range. For example,
the polymeric composition can comprise a PLLA/PCL copolymer or a PGA/PCL copolymer,
for example. The polymeric composition of a tissue thickness compensator may have
a Shore A Hardness value of less than 15 A. The polymeric composition of a tissue
thickness compensator may have a Shore A Hardness value of less than 10 A. The polymeric
composition of a tissue thickness compensator may have a Shore A Hardness value of
less than 5 A. The polymeric material may have a Shore OO composition value from approximately
35 OO to approximately 75 OO, for example.
[0308] The polymeric composition may have at least two of the above-identified properties.
The polymeric composition may have at least three of the above-identified properties.
The polymeric composition may have a porosity from 85% to 97% by volume, a pore size
from 5 micrometers to 2000 micrometers, and a Shore A hardness value from 4 A to 16
A and Shore OO hardness value from 45 OO to 65 OO, for example. The polymeric composition
may comprise 70% by weight of the polymeric composition of PLLA and 30% by weight
of the polymeric composition of PCL having a porosity of 90% by volume, a pore size
from 100 micrometers to 1000 micrometers, and a Shore A hardness value from 4 A to
16 A and Shore OO hardness value from 45 OO to 65 OO , for example. The polymeric
composition may comprise 65% by weight of the polymeric composition of PGA and 35%
by weight of the polymeric composition of PCL having a porosity from 93% to 95% by
volume, a pore size from 10 micrometers to 100 micrometers, and a Shore A hardness
value from 4 A to 16 A and Shore OO hardness value from 45 OO to 65 OO, for example.
[0309] The tissue thickness compensator may comprise a material that expands. As discussed
above, the tissue thickness compensator may comprise a compressed material that expands
when uncompressed or deployed, for example. The tissue thickness compensator may comprise
a self-expanding material formed
in situ. The tissue thickness compensator may comprise at least one precursor selected to
spontaneously crosslink when contacted with at least one of other precursor(s), water,
and/or bodily fluids. Referring to FIG. 205a first precursor may contact one or more
other precursors to form an expandable and/or swellable tissue thickness compensator.
The tissue thickness compensator may comprise a fluid-swellable composition, such
as a water-swellable composition, for example. The tissue thickness compensator may
comprise a gel comprising water.
[0310] Referring to FIGS. 189A and B, for example, a tissue thickness compensator 70000
may comprise at least one hydrogel precursor 70010 selected to form a hydrogel
in situ and/or
in vivo to expand the tissue thickness compensator 70000. FIG. 189A illustrates a tissue
thickness compensator 70000 comprising an encapsulation comprising a first hydrogel
precursor 70010A and a second hydrogel precursor 70010B prior to expansion. As shown
in FIG. 189A, the first hydrogel precursor 70010A and second hydrogel precursor 70010B
may be physically separated from other in the same encapsulation. A first encapsulation
may comprise the first hydrogel precursor 70010A and a second encapsulation may comprise
the second hydrogel precursor 70010B. FIG. 189B illustrates the expansion of the thickness
tissue compensator 70000 when the hydrogel is formed
in situ and/or
in vivo. As shown in FIG. 189B, the encapsulation may be ruptured, and the first hydrogel
precursor 70010A may contact the second hydrogel precursor 70010B to form the hydrogel
70020. The hydrogel may comprise an expandable material. The hydrogel may expand up
to 72 hours, for example.
[0311] The tissue thickness compensator may comprise a biodegradable foam having an encapsulation
comprising dry hydrogel particles or granules embedded therein. Without wishing to
be bound to any particular theory, the encapsulations in the foam may be formed by
contacting an aqueous solution of a hydrogel precursor and an organic solution of
biocompatible materials to form the foam. As shown in FIG. 206, the aqueous solution
and organic solution may form micelles. The aqueous solution and organic solution
may be dried to encapsulate dry hydrogel particles or granules within the foam. For
example, a hydrogel precursor, such as a hydrophilic polymer, may be dissolved in
water to form a dispersion of micelles. The aqueous solution may contact an organic
solution of dioxane comprising poly(glycolic acid) and polycaprolactone. The aqueous
and organic solutions may be lyophilized to form a biodegradable foam having dry hydrogel
particles or granules dispersed therein. Without wishing to be bound to any particular
theory, it is believed that the micelles form the encapsulation having the dry hydrogel
particles or granules dispersed within the foam structure. The encapsulation may be
ruptured, and the dry hydrogel particles or granules may contact a fluid, such as
a bodily fluid, and expand.
[0312] The tissue thickness compensator may expand when contacted with an activator, such
as a fluid, for example. Referring to FIG. 190, for example, a tissue thickness compensator
70050 may comprise a swellable material, such as a hydrogel, that expands when contacted
with a fluid 70055, such as bodily fluids, saline, water and/or an activator, for
example. Examples of bodily fluids may include, but are not limited to, blood, plasma,
peritoneal fluid, cerebral spinal fluid, urine, lymph fluid, synovial fluid, vitreous
fluid, saliva, gastrointestinal luminal contents, bile, and/or gas (e.g., CO
2). The tissue thickness compensator 70050 may expand when the tissue thickness compensator
70050 absorbs the fluid. In another example, the tissue thickness compensator 70050
may comprise a non-crosslinked hydrogel that expands when contacted with an activator
70055 comprising a cross-linking agent to form a crosslinked hydrogel. The tissue
thickness compensator may expand when contacted with an activator. The tissue thickness
compensator may expand or swell from contact up to 72 hours, such as from 24-72 hours,
up to 24 hours, up to 48 hours, and up to 72 hours, for example, to provide continuously
increasing pressure and/or compression to the tissue. As shown in FIG. 190, the initial
thickness of the tissue thickness compensator 70050 may be less than an expanded thickness
after the fluid 70055 contacts the tissue thickness compensator 70050.
[0313] Referring to FIGS. 187 and 188a staple cartridge 70100 may comprise a tissue thickness
compensator 70105 and a plurality of staples 70110 each comprising staple legs 70112.
As shown in FIG. 187, tissue thickness compensator 70105 may have an initial thickness
or compressed height that is less than the fired height of the staples 70110. The
tissue thickness compensator 70100 may be configured to expand
in situ and/or
in vivo when contacted with a fluid 70102, such as bodily fluids, saline, and/or an activator
for example, to push the tissue T against the legs 70112 of the staple 70110. As shown
in FIG. 188, the tissue thickness compensator 70100 may expand and/or swell when contacted
with a fluid 70102. The tissue thickness compensator 70105 can compensate for the
thickness of the tissue T captured within each staple 70110. As shown in FIG. 188,
tissue thickness compensator 70105 may have an expanded thickness or an uncompressed
height that is less than the fired height of the staples 70110.
[0314] Optionally, as described above, the tissue thickness compensator may comprise an
initial thickness and an expanded thickness. The initial thickness of a tissue thickness
compensator can be approximately 0.001% of its expanded thickness, approximately 0.01%
of its expanded thickness, approximately 0.1% of its expanded thickness, approximately
1% of its expanded thickness, approximately 10% of its expanded thickness, approximately
20% of its expanded thickness, approximately 30% of its expanded thickness, approximately
40% of its expanded thickness, approximately 50% of its expanded thickness, approximately
60% of its expanded thickness, approximately 70% of its expanded thickness, approximately
80% of its expanded thickness, and/ or approximately 90% of its expanded thickness,
for example. The expanded thickness of the tissue thickness compensator can be approximately
two times, approximately five times, approximately ten times, approximately fifty
times, approximately one hundred times, approximately two hundred times, approximately
three hundred times, approximately four hundred times, approximately five hundred
times, approximately six hundred times, approximately seven hundred times, approximately
eight hundred times, approximately nine hundred times, and/or approximately one thousand
times thicker than its initial thickness, for example. The initial thickness of the
tissue thickness compensator can be up to 1% its expanded thickness, up to 5% its
expanded thickness, up to 10% its expanded thickness, and up to 50% its expanded thickness.
The expanded thickness of the tissue thickness compensator can be at least 50% thicker
than its initial thickness, at least 100% thicker than its initial thickness, at least
300% thicker than its initial thickness, and at least 500% thicker than its initial
thickness. As described above, in various circumstances, as a result of the above,
the tissue thickness compensator can be configured to consume any gaps within the
staple entrapment area.
[0315] As discussed above, the tissue thickness compensator may comprise a hydrogel. The
hydrogel may comprise homopolymer hydrogels, copolymer hydrogels, multipolymer hydrogels,
interpenetrating polymer hydrogels, and combinations thereof. The hydrogel may comprise
microgels, nanogels, and combinations thereof. The hydrogel may generally comprise
a hydrophilic polymer network capable of absorbing and/or retaining fluids. The hydrogel
may comprise a non-crosslinked hydrogel, a crosslinked hydrogel, and combinations
thereof. The hydrogel may comprise chemical crosslinks, physical crosslinks, hydrophobic
segments and/or water insoluble segments. The hydrogel may be chemically crosslinked
by polymerization, small-molecule crosslinking, and/or polymer-polymer crosslinking.
The hydrogel may be physically crosslinked by ionic interactions, hydrophobic interactions,
hydrogen bonding interactions, sterocomplexation, and/or supramolecular chemistry.
The hydrogel may be substantially insoluble due to the crosslinks, hydrophobic segments
and/or water insoluble segments, but be expandable and/or swellable due to absorbing
and/or retaining fluids. The precursor may crosslink with endogenous materials and/or
tissues.
[0316] The hydrogel may comprise an environmentally sensitive hydrogel (ESH). The ESH may
comprise materials having fluid-swelling properties that relate to environmental conditions.
The environmental conditions may include, but are not limited to, the physical conditions,
biological conditions, and/or chemical conditions at the surgical site. The hydrogel
may swell or shrink in response to temperature, pH, electric fields, ionic strength,
enzymatic and/or chemical reactions, electrical and/or magnetic stimuli, and other
physiological and environmental variables, for example. The ESH may comprise multifunctional
acrylates, hydroxyethylmethacrylate (HEMA), elastomeric acrylates, and related monomers.
[0317] The tissue thickness compensator comprising a hydrogel may comprise at least one
of the non-synthetic materials and synthetic materials described above. The hydrogel
may comprise a synthetic hydrogel and/or a non-synthetic hydrogel. The tissue thickness
compensator may comprise a plurality of layers. The plurality of the layers may comprise
porous layers and/or non-porous layers. For example, the tissue thickness compensator
may comprise a non-porous layer and a porous layer. In another example, the tissue
thickness compensator may comprise a porous layer intermediate a first non-porous
layer and a second non-porous layer. In another example, the tissue thickness compensator
may comprise a non-porous layer intermediate a first porous layer and a second porous
layer. The non-porous layers and porous layers may be positioned in any order relative
to the surfaces of the staple cartridge and/or anvil.
[0318] Examples of the non-synthetic material may include, but are not limited to, albumin,
alginate, carbohydrate, casein, cellulose, chitin, chitosan, collagen, blood, dextran,
elastin, fibrin, fibrinogen, gelatin, heparin, hyaluronic acid, keratin, protein,
serum, and starch. The cellulose may comprise hydroxyethyl cellulose, oxidized cellulose,
oxidized regenerated cellulose (ORC), hydroxypropyl cellulose, carboxyethyl cellulose,
carboxymethylcellulose, and combinations thereof. The collagen may comprise bovine
pericardium. The carbohydrate may comprise a polysaccharide, such as lyophilized polysaccharide.
The protein may comprise glycoprotein, proteoglycan, and combinations thereof.
[0319] Examples of the synthetic material may include, but are not limited to, poly(lactic
acid), poly(glycolic acid), poly(hydroxybutyrate), poly(phosphazine), polyesters,
polyethylene glycols, polyethylene oxide, polyethylene oxide-co-polypropylene oxide,
co-polyethylene oxide, polyalkyleneoxides, polyacrylamides, polyhydroxyethylmethylacrylate,
poly(vinylpyrrolidone), polyvinyl alcohols, poly(caprolactone), poly(dioxanone), polyacrylic
acid, polyacetate, polypropylene, aliphatic polyesters, glycerols, poly(amino acids),
copoly(ether-esters), polyalkylene oxalates, polyamides, poly(iminocarbonates), polyoxaesters,
polyorthoesters, polyphosphazenes and combinations thereof. The above non-synthetic
materials may be synthetically prepared, e.g., synthetic hyaluronic acid, utilizing
conventional methods.
[0320] The hydrogel may be made from one or more hydrogel precursors. The precursor may
comprise a monomer and/or a macromer. The hydrogel precursor may comprise an electrophile
functional group and/or a nucleophile electrophile functional group. In general, electrophiles
may react with nucleophiles to form a bond. The term "functional group" as used herein
refers to electrophilic or nucleophilic groups capable of reacting with each other
to form a bond. Examples of electrophilic functional groups may include, but are not
limited to, N-hydroxysuccinimides ("NHS"), sulfosuccinimides, carbonyldiimidazole,
sulfonyl chloride, aryl halides, sulfosuccinimidyl esters, N-hydroxysuccinimidyl esters,
succinimidyl esters such as succinimidyl succinates and/or succinimidyl propionates,
isocyanates, thiocyanates, carbodiimides, benzotriazole carbonates, epoxides, aldehydes,
maleimides, imidoesters, combinations thereof, and the like. The electrophilic functional
group may comprise a succinimidyl ester. Examples of nucleophile functional groups
may include, but are not limited to, -NH
2, -SH, -OH, -PH
2, and -CO-NH-NH
2.
[0321] The hydrogel may be formed from a single precursor or multiple precursors. The hydrogel
may be formed from a first precursor and a second precursor. The first hydrogel precursor
and second hydrogel precursor may form a hydrogel
in situ and/or
in vivo upon contact. The hydrogel precursor may generally refer to a polymer, functional
group, macromolecule, small molecule, and/or crosslinker that can take part in a reaction
to form a hydrogel. The precursor may comprise a homogeneous solution, heterogeneous,
or phase separated solution in a suitable solvent, such as water or a buffer, for
example. The buffer may have a pH from about 8 to about 12, such as, about 8.2 to
about 9, for example. Examples of buffers may include, but are not limited to borate
buffers. The precursor(s) may be in an emulsion. According to the invention, a first
precursor may react with a second precursor to form a hydrogel. The first precursor
may spontaneously crosslink when contacted with the second precursor. According to
the invention, a first set of electrophilic functional groups on a first precursor
may react with a second set of nucleophilic functional groups on a second precursor.
When the precursors are mixed in an environment that permits reaction (e.g., as relating
to pH, temperature, and/or solvent), the functional groups may react with each other
to form covalent bonds. The precursors may become crosslinked when at least some of
the precursors react with more than one other precursor.
[0322] The tissue thickness compensator may comprise at least one monomer selected from
the group consisting of 3-sulfopropyl acrylate potassium salt ("KSPA"), sodium acrylate
("NaA"), N-(tris(hydroxylmethyl)methyl)acrylamide ("tris acryl"), and 2-acrylamido-2-methyl-1-propane
sulfonic acid (AMPS). The tissue thickness compensator may comprise a copolymer comprising
two or more monomers selected from the group consisting of KSPA, NaA, tris acryl,
aMPS. The tissue thickness compensator may comprise homopolymers derived from KSPA,
NaA, trisacryl and AMPS. The tissue thickness compensator may comprise hydrophilicity
modifying monomers copolymerizable therewith. The hydrophilicity modifying monomers
may comprise methylmethacrylate, butylacrylate, cyclohexylacrylate, styrene, styrene
sulphonic acid.
[0323] The tissue thickness compensator may comprise a crosslinker. The crosslinker may
comprise a low molecular weight di- or polyvinylic crosslinking agent, such as ethylenglycol
diacrylate or dimethacrylate, di-, tri- or tetraethylen-glycol diacrylate or dimethacrylate,
allyl (meth)acrylate, a C
2-C
8-alkylene diacrylate or dimethacrylate, divinyl ether, divinyl sulfone, di-and trivinylbenzene,
trimethylolpropane triacrylate or trimethacrylate, pentaerythritol tetraacrylate or
tetramethacrylate, bisphenol A diacrylate or dimethacrylate, methylene bisacrylamide
or bismethacrylamide, ethylene bisacrylamide or ethylene bismethacrylamide, triallyl
phthalate or diallyl phthalate. The crosslinker may comprise N,N'-methylenebisacrylamide
("MBAA").
[0324] The tissue thickness compensator may comprise at least one of acrylate and/or methacrylate
functional hydrogels, biocompatible photoinitiator, alkyl-cyanoacrylates, isocyanate
functional macromers, optionally comprising amine functional macromers, succinimidyl
ester functional macromers, optionally comprising amine and/or sulfhydryl functional
macromers, epoxy functional macromers, optionally comprising amine functional macromers,
mixtures of proteins and/or polypeptides and aldehyde crosslinkers, Genipin, and water-soluble
carbodiimides, anionic polysaccharides and polyvalent cations.
[0325] The tissue thickness compensator may comprise unsaturated organic acid monomers,
acrylic substituted alcohols, and/or acrylamides. The tissue thickness compensator
may comprise methacrylic acids, acrylic acids, glycerolacrylate, glycerolmethacryulate,
2-hydroxyethylmethacrylate, 2-hydroxyethylacrylate, 2-(dimethylaminoethyl) methacrylate,
N-vinyl pyrrolidone, methacrylamide, and/or N, N-dimethylacrylamide poly(methacrylic
acid).
[0326] The tissue thickness compensator may comprise a reinforcement material. The reinforcement
material may comprise at least one of the non-synthetic materials and synthetic materials
described above. The reinforcement material may comprise collagen, gelatin, fibrin,
fibrinogen, elastin, keratin, albumin, hydroxyethyl cellulose, cellulose, oxidized
cellulose, hydroxypropyl cellulose, carboxyethyl cellulose, carboxymethylcellulose,
chitan, chitosan, alginate, poly(lactic acid), poly(glycolic acid), poly(hydroxybutyrate),
poly(phosphazine), polyesters, polyethylene glycols, polyalkyleneoxides, polyacrylamides,
polyhydroxyethylmethylacrylate, polyvinylpyrrolidone, polyvinyl alcohols, poly(caprolactone),
poly(dioxanone), polyacrylic acid, polyacetate, polycaprolactone, polypropylene, aliphatic
polyesters, glycerols, poly(amino acids), copoly(ether-esters), polyalkylene oxalates,
polyamides, poly(iminocarbonates), polyalkylene oxalates, polyoxaesters, polyorthoesters,
polyphosphazenes and combinations thereof.
[0327] The tissue thickness compensator may comprise a layer comprising the reinforcement
material. A porous layer and/or a non-porous layer of a tissue thickness compensator
may comprise the reinforcement material. For example, the porous layer may comprise
the reinforcement material and the non-porous layer may not comprise the reinforcement
material. The reinforcement layer may comprise an inner layer intermediate a first
non-porous layer and a second non-porous layer. The reinforcement layer may comprise
an outer layer of the tissue thickness compensator. The reinforcement layer may comprise
an exterior surface of the tissue thickness compensator.
[0328] The reinforcement material may comprise meshes, monofilaments, multifilament braids,
fibers, mats, felts, particles, and/or powders. The reinforcement material may be
incorporated into a layer of the tissue thickness compensator. The reinforcement material
may be incorporated into at least one of a non-porous layer and a porous layer. A
mesh comprising the reinforcement material may be formed using conventional techniques,
such as, for example, knitting, weaving, tatting, and/or knipling.
According to the invention, a plurality of reinforcement materials may be oriented
in a random direction and/or a common direction. The common direction may be one of
parallel to the staple line and perpendicular to the staple line, for example. For
example, the monofilaments and/or multifilament braids may be oriented in a random
direction and/or a common direction. The monofilaments and multifilament braids may
be associated with the non-porous layer and/or the porous layer. The tissue thickness
compensator may comprise a plurality of reinforcement fibers oriented in a random
direction within a non-porous layer. The tissue thickness compensator may comprise
a plurality of reinforcement fibers oriented in a common direction within a non-porous
layer.
[0329] Referring to FIG. 199, an anvil 70300 may comprise a tissue thickness compensator
70305 comprising a first non-porous layer 70307 and a second non-porous layer 70309
sealingly enclosing a reinforcement layer 70310. The reinforcement layer 70310 may
comprise a hydrogel comprising ORC particles or fibers embedded therein, and the non-porous
layers may comprise ORC. As shown in FIG. 199, the tissue thickness compensator 70305
may be configured to conform to the contour of the anvil 70300. The inner layer of
the tissue thickness compensator 70305 may conform to the inner surface of the anvil
70300, which includes the forming pockets 70301.
[0330] The fibers may form a non-woven material, such as, for example, a mat and a felt.
The fibers may have any suitable length, such as, for example from 0.1 mm to 100 mm
and 0.4 mm to 50 mm. The reinforcement material may be ground to a powder. The powder
may have a particle size from 10 micrometers to 1 cm, for example. The powder may
be incorporated into the tissue thickness compensator.
[0331] The tissue thickness compensator may be formed
in situ. The hydrogel may be formed
in situ. The tissue thickness compensator may be formed
in situ by covalent, ionic, and/or hydrophobic bonds. Physical (non-covalent) crosslinks
may result from complexation, hydrogen bonding, desolvation, Van der Waals interactions,
ionic bonding, and combinations thereof. Chemical (covalent) crosslinking may be accomplished
by any of a number of mechanisms, including: free radical polymerization, condensation
polymerization, anionic or cationic polymerization, step growth polymerization, electrophile-nucleophile
reactions, and combinations thereof.
[0332] Optionally,
in situ formation of the tissue thickness compensator may comprise reacting two or more precursors
that are physically separated until contacted
in situ and/or react to an environmental condition to react with each other to form the hydrogel.
In situ polymerizable polymers may be prepared from precursor(s) that can be reacted to form
a polymer at the surgical site. The tissue thickness compensator may be formed by
crosslinking reactions of the precursor(s)
in situ. The precursor may comprise an initiator capable of initiating a polymerization reaction
for the formation of the
in situ tissue thickness compensator. The tissue thickness compensator may comprise a precursor
that can be activated at the time of application to create a crosslinked hydrogel.
In situ formation of the tissue thickness compensator may comprise activating at least one
precursor to form bonds to form the tissue thickness compensator. Optionally, activation
may be achieved by changes in the physical conditions, biological conditions, and/or
chemical conditions at the surgical site, including, but not limited to temperature,
pH, electric fields, ionic strength, enzymatic and/or chemical reactions, electrical
and/or magnetic stimuli, and other physiological and environmental variables. The
precursors may be contacted outside the body and introduced to the surgical site.
[0333] The tissue thickness compensator may comprise one or more encapsulations, or cells,
which can be configured to store at least one component therein. The encapsulation
may be configured to store a hydrogel precursor therein. The encapsulation may be
configured to store two components therein, for example. The encapsulation may be
configured to store a first hydrogel precursor and a second hydrogel precursor therein.
A first encapsulation may be configured to store a first hydrogel precursor therein
and a second encapsulation may be configured to store a second hydrogel precursor
therein. As described above, the encapsulations can be aligned, or at least substantially
aligned, with the staple legs to puncture and/or otherwise rupture the encapsulations
when the staple legs contact the encapsulation. The encapsulations may be compressed,
crushed, collapsed, and/or otherwise ruptured when the staples are deployed. After
the encapsulations have been ruptured, the component(s) stored therein can flow out
of the encapsulation. The component stored therein may contact other components, layers
of the tissue thickness compensator, and/or the tissue. The other components may be
flowing from the same or different encapsulations, provided in the layers of the tissue
thickness compensator, and/or provided to the surgical site by the clinician. As a
result of the above, the component(s) stored within the encapsulations can provide
expansion and/or swelling of the tissue thickness compensator.
[0334] The tissue thickness compensator may comprise a layer comprising the encapsulations.
The encapsulation may comprise a void, a pocket, a dome, a tube, and combinations
thereof associated with the layer. The encapsulations may comprise voids in the layer.
The layer can comprise two layers that can be attached to one another wherein the
encapsulations can be defined between the two layers. The encapsulations may comprise
domes on the surface of the layer. For example, at least a portion of the encapsulations
can be positioned within domes extending upwardly from the layer. The encapsulations
may comprise pockets formed within the layer. A first portion of the encapsulations
may comprise a dome and a second portion of the encapsulations may comprise a pocket.
The encapsulations may comprise a tube embedded within the layer. The tube may comprise
the non-synthetic materials and/or synthetic materials described herein, such as PLA.
The tissue thickness compensator may comprise a bioabsorbable foam, such as ORC, comprising
PLA tubes embedded therein, and the tube may encapsulate a hydrogel, for example.
The encapsulations may comprise discrete cells that are unconnected to each other.
One or more of the encapsulations can be in fluid communication with each other via
one or more passageways, conduits, and/or channels, for example, extending through
the layer.
[0335] The rate of release of a component from the encapsulation may be controlled by the
thickness of the tissue thickness compensator, the composition of tissue thickness
compensator, the size of the component, the hydrophilicity of the component, and/or
the physical and/or chemical interactions among the component, the composition of
the tissue thickness compensator, and/or the surgical instrument, for example. The
layer can comprise one or more thin sections or weakened portions, such as partial
perforations, for example, which can facilitate the incision of the layer and the
rupture of the encapsulations. The partial perforations may not completely extend
through a layer while, in some cases, perforations may completely extend through the
layer.
[0336] Referring to FIGS. 194 and 195a tissue thickness compensator 70150 may comprise an
outer layer 70152A and an inner layer 70152B comprising encapsulations 70154. The
encapsulation may comprise a first encapsulated component and a second encapsulated
component. The encapsulations may independently comprise one of a first encapsulated
component and a second encapsulated component. The first encapsulated component may
be separated from the second encapsulated component. The outer layer 70152A may comprise
a tissue-contacting surface. The inner layer 70152B may comprise an instrument-contacting
surface. The instrument-contacting surface 70152B may be releasably attached to the
anvil 70156. The outer layer 70152A may be attached to the inner layer 70152B to define
a void between the outer layer 70152A and inner layer 70152B. As shown in FIG. 194,
each encapsulation 70154 may comprise a dome on the instrument-contacting surface
of the inner layer 70152B. The dome may comprise partial perforations to facilitate
the incision of the layer by the staple legs and the rupture of the encapsulation.
As shown in the FIG. 195, the anvil 70156 can comprise a plurality of forming pocket
rows 70158 wherein the domes of the encapsulations 70154 may be aligned with the forming
pocket 70158. The tissue-contacting surface may comprise a flat surface lacking domes.
The tissue-contacting surface may comprise one or more encapsulations, such as encapsulations
70154, for example, extending therefrom.
[0337] Optionally, an anvil may comprise a tissue thickness compensator comprising an encapsulated
component comprising at least one microsphere particle. The tissue thickness compensator
may comprise an encapsulation comprising a first encapsulated component and a second
encapsulated component. The tissue thickness compensator may comprise an encapsulation
comprising a first microsphere particle and a second microsphere particle.
[0338] Referring to FIG. 196, a stapling apparatus may comprise an anvil 70180 and a staple
cartridge (illustrated in other figures). The staples 70190 of a staple cartridge
can be deformed by an anvil 70180 when the anvil 70180 is moved into a closed position
and/or by a staple driver system 70192 which moves the staples 70190 toward the closed
anvil 70180. The legs 70194 of the staples may contact the anvil 70180 such that the
staples 70190 are at least partially deformed. The anvil 70180 may comprise a tissue
thickness compensator 70182 comprising an outer layer 70183A, an inner layer 70183B.
The tissue thickness compensator 70182 may comprise a first encapsulated component
and a second encapsulated component. The encapsulations 210185 can be aligned, or
at least substantially aligned, such that, when the staple legs 70194 are pushed through
the tissue T and the outer layer 70183A, the staple legs 70194 can puncture and/or
otherwise rupture the encapsulations 70185. As shown in FIG. 196, the staple 70190C
is in its fully fired position, the staple 70190B is in the process of being fired,
and the staple 70190A is in its unfired position. The legs of staples 70190C and 70190B
have moved through the tissue T, the outer layer 70183A, and the inner layer 70183B
of the tissue thickness compensator 70182, and have contacted an anvil 70180 positioned
opposite the staple cartridge. After the encapsulations 70185 have been ruptured,
the encapsulated components can flow out and contact each other, bodily fluids, and/or
the tissue T, for example. The encapsulated components may react to form a reaction
product such as a hydrogel, for example, to expand between the tissue T and the base
of the staple and to push the tissue T against the legs of the staple. In various
circumstances, as a result of the above, the tissue thickness compensator can be configured
to consume any gaps within the staple entrapment area.
[0339] The tissue thickness compensator may be suitable for use with a surgical instrument.
As described above the tissue thickness compensator may be associated with the staple
cartridge and/or the anvil. The tissue thickness compensator may be configured into
any shape, size and/or dimension suitable to fit the staple cartridge and/or anvil.
As described herein, the tissue thickness compensator may be releasably attached to
the staple cartridge and/or anvil. The tissue thickness compensator may be attached
to the staple cartridge and/or anvil in any mechanical and/or chemical manner capable
of retaining the tissue thickness compensator in contact with the staple cartridge
and/or anvil prior to and during the stapling process. The tissue thickness compensator
may be removed or released from the staple cartridge and/or anvil after the staple
penetrates the tissue thickness compensator. The tissue thickness compensator may
be removed or released from the staple cartridge and/or anvil as the staple cartridge
and/or anvil is moved away from the tissue thickness compensator.
[0340] Referring to FIGS. 191-193, stapling apparatus 70118 may comprise an anvil 70120
and a staple cartridge 70122 comprising a firing member 70124, a plurality of staples
70128, a knife edge 70129, and a tissue thickness compensator 70130. The tissue thickness
compensator 70130 may comprise at least one encapsulated component. The encapsulated
component may be ruptured when the tissue thickness compensator is compressed, stapled,
and/or cut. Referring to FIG. 192, for example, the staples 70128 can be deployed
between an unfired position and a fired position such that the staple legs move through
the tissue thickness compensator 70130, penetrate through a bottom surface and a top
surface of the tissue thickness compensator 70130, penetrate the tissue T, and contact
an anvil 70120 positioned opposite the staple cartridge 70118. The encapsulated components
may react with each other, a hydrophilic powder embedded or dispersed in the tissue
thickness compensator, and/or bodily fluids to expand or swell the tissue thickness
compensator 70130. As the legs are deformed against the anvil, the legs of each staple
can capture a portion of the tissue thickness compensator 70130 and a portion of the
tissue T within each staple 70128 and apply a compressive force to the tissue T. As
shown in FIGS. 192 and 193, the tissue thickness compensator 70130 can compensate
for the thickness of the tissue T captured within each staple 70128.
[0341] Referring to FIG. 197, a surgical instrument 70200 may comprise an anvil 70205 comprising
an upper tissue thickness compensator 70210 and a staple cartridge 70215 comprising
a lower tissue thickness compensator comprising an outer layer 70220 and an inner
layer 70225. The upper tissue thickness compensator 70210 can be positioned on a first
side of the targeted tissue and the lower tissue thickness compensator can be positioned
on a second side of the tissue. The upper tissue thickness compensator 70210 may comprise
ORC, the outer layer of the lower tissue thickness compensator may comprise a hydrogel
having ORC particles embedded therein, and the inner layer of the lower tissue thickness
compensator may comprise ORC, for example.
[0342] Referring to FIGS. 200-202a surgical instrument 70400 may comprise a staple cartridge
70405 and an anvil 70410. The staple cartridge 70405 may comprise a tissue thickness
compensator 70415 including bioabsorbable foam. The bioabsorbable foam can comprise
an encapsulation which comprises an encapsulated component 70420. The bioabsorbable
foam may comprise ORC and the encapsulated component may comprise a medicament, for
example. The tissue thickness compensator 70415 of the anvil 70410 may comprise an
inner layer 70425 and an outer layer 70430. The inner layer 70425 may comprise a bioabsorbable
foam, and the outer layer 70430 may comprise a hydrogel, optionally comprising reinforcement
materials, for example. During an exemplary firing sequence, referring primarily to
FIG. 201, a sled 70435 can first contact staple 70440A and begin to lift the staple
upwardly. As the sled 70435 is advanced further distally, the sled 70435 can begin
to lift staples 70440B-D, and any other subsequent staples, in a sequential order.
The sled 70435 can drive the staples 70440 upwardly such that the legs of the staples
contact the opposing anvil 70410 and are deformed to a desired shape. With regard
to the firing sequence illustrated in FIG. 201, the staples 70440A-C have been moved
into their fully fired positions, the staple 70440D is in the process of being fired,
and the staple 70420E is still in its unfired position. The encapsulated component
70470 may be ruptured by the staple legs during the exemplary firing sequence. The
encapsulated component 70420 may flow from the encapsulation around the staple legs
to contact the tissue T. In various circumstances, additional compression of the tissue
thickness compensator can squeeze additional medicament out of the encapsulation.
The medicament can immediately treat the tissue and can reduce bleeding from the tissue.
[0343] In various circumstances, a surgeon, or other clinician, may deliver a fluid to the
tissue thickness compensator to manufacture a tissue thickness compensator comprising
at least one medicament stored and/or absorbed therein. According to the invention,
a staple cartridge and/or anvil may comprise a port configured to provide access to
the tissue thickness compensator. Referring to FIG. 203B, a staple cartridge 70500
may comprise a port 70505 at a distal end thereof, for example. The port 70505 may
be configured to receive a needle 70510, such as a fenestrated needle shown in FIG.
203A. The clinician may insert a needle 70510 through the port 70505 into the tissue
thickness compensator 70515 to deliver the fluid to the tissue thickness compensator
70515. The fluid may comprise a medicament and hydrogel precursor, for example. As
described above, the fluid may be released from tissue thickness compensator to the
tissue when the tissue thickness compensator is ruptured and/or compressed. For example,
the medicament may be released from the tissue thickness compensator 70515 as the
tissue thickness compensator 70515 biodegrades.
[0344] Referring now to FIG. 14, a staple cartridge, such as staple cartridge 10000, for
example, can comprise a support portion 10010 and a compressible tissue thickness
compensator 10020. Referring now to FIGS. 16-18, the support portion 10010 can comprise
a deck surface 10011 and a plurality of staple cavities 10012 defined within the support
portion 10010. Each staple cavity 10012 can be sized and configured to removably store
a staple, such as a staple 10030, for example, therein. The staple cartridge 10000
can further comprise a plurality of staple drivers 10040 which can each be configured
to support one or more staples 10030 within the staple cavities 10012 when the staples
10030 and the staple drivers 10040 are in their unfired positions. For example, referring
primarily to FIGS. 22 and 23, each staple driver 10040 can comprise one or more cradles,
or troughs, 10041, for example, which can be configured to support the staples and
limit relative movement between the staples 10030 and the staple drivers 10040. Referring
again to FIG. 16, the staple cartridge 10000 can further comprise a staple-firing
sled 10050 which can be moved from a proximal end 10001 to a distal end 10002 of the
staple cartridge in order to sequentially lift the staple drivers 10040 and the staples
10030 from their unfired positions toward an anvil positioned opposite the staple
cartridge 10000. Referring primarily to FIGS. 16 and 18, each staple 10030 can comprise
a base 10031 and one or more legs 10032 extending from the base 10031 wherein each
staple can be at least one of substantially U-shaped and substantially V-shaped, for
example. The staples 10030 can be configured such that the tips of the staple legs
10032 are recessed with respect to the deck surface 10011 of the support portion 10010
when the staples 10030 are in their unfired positions. The staples 10030 can be configured
such that the tips of the staple legs 10032 are flush with respect to the deck surface
10011 of the support portion 10010 when the staples 10030 are in their unfired positions.
The staples 10030 can be configured such that the tips of the staple legs 10032, or
at least some portion of the staple legs 10032, extend above the deck surface 10011
of the support portion 10010 when the staples 10030 are in their unfired positions.
In such cases, the staple legs 10032 can extend into and can be embedded within the
tissue thickness compensator 10020 when the staples 10030 are in their unfired positions.
For example, the staple legs 10032 can extend above the deck surface 10011 by approximately
0.075", for example. The staple legs 10032 can extend above the deck surface 10011
by a distance between approximately 0.025" and approximately 0.125", for example.
Further to the above, the tissue thickness compensator 10020 can comprise an uncompressed
thickness between approximately 0.08" and approximately 0.125", for example.
[0345] In use, further to the above and referring primarily to FIG. 31, an anvil, such as
anvil, 10060, for example, can be moved into a closed position opposite the staple
cartridge 10000. As described in greater detail below, the anvil 10060 can position
tissue against the tissue thickness compensator 10020 and compress the tissue thickness
compensator 10020 against the deck surface 10011 of the support portion 10010, for
example. Once the anvil 10060 has been suitably positioned, the staples 10030 can
be deployed, as also illustrated in FIG. 31. Optionally, as mentioned above, the staple-firing
sled 10050 can be moved from the proximal end 10001 of the staple cartridge 10000
toward the distal end 10002, as illustrated in FIG. 32. As the sled 10050 is advanced,
the sled 10050 can contact the staple drivers 10040 and lift the staple drivers 10040
upwardly within the staple cavities 10012. The sled 10050 and the staple drivers 10040
can each comprise one or more ramps, or inclined surfaces, which can co-operate to
move the staple drivers 10040 upwardly from their unfired positions. For example,
referring to FIGS. 19-23, each staple driver 10040 can comprise at least one inclined
surface 10042 and the sled 10050 can comprise one or more inclined surfaces 10052
which can be configured such that the inclined surfaces 10052 can slide under the
inclined surface 10042 as the sled 10050 is advanced distally within the staple cartridge.
As the staple drivers 10040 are lifted upwardly within their respective staple cavities
10012, the staple drivers 10040 can lift the staples 10030 upwardly such that the
staples 10030 can emerge from their staple cavities 10012 through openings in the
staple deck 10011. During an exemplary firing sequence, referring primarily to FIGS.
25-27, the sled 10050 can first contact staple 10030a and begin to lift the staple
10030a upwardly. As the sled 10050 is advanced further distally, the sled 10050 can
begin to lift staples 10030b, 10030c, 10030d, 10030e, and 10030f, and any other subsequent
staples, in a sequential order. As illustrated in FIG. 27, the sled 10050 can drive
the staples 10030 upwardly such that the legs 10032 of the staples contact the opposing
anvil, are deformed to a desired shape, and ejected therefrom the support portion
10010. In various circumstances, the sled 10030 can move several staples upwardly
at the same time as part of a firing sequence. With regard to the firing sequence
illustrated in FIG. 27, the staples 10030a and 10030b have been moved into their fully
fired positions and ejected from the support portion 10010, the staples 10030c and
10030d are in the process of being fired and are at least partially contained within
the support portion 10010, and the staples 10030e and 10030f are still in their unfired
positions.
[0346] As discussed above, and referring to FIG. 33, the staple legs 10032 of the staples
10030 can extend above the deck surface 10011 of the support portion 10010 when the
staples 10030 are in their unfired positions. With further regard to this firing sequence
illustrated in FIG. 27, the staples 10030e and 10030f are illustrated in their unfired
position and their staple legs 10032 extend above the deck surface 10011 and into
the tissue thickness compensator 10020. The tips of the staple legs 10032, or any
other portion of the staple legs 10032, may not protrude through a top tissue-contacting
surface 10021 of the tissue thickness compensator 10020 when the staples 10030 are
in their unfired positions. As the staples 10030 are moved from their unfired positions
to their fired positions, as illustrated in FIG. 27, the tips of the staple legs can
protrude through the tissue-contacting surface 10032. The tips of the staple legs
10032 can comprise sharp tips which can incise and penetrate the tissue thickness
compensator 10020. The tissue thickness compensator 10020 can comprise a plurality
of apertures which can be configured to receive the staple legs 10032 and allow the
staple legs 10032 to slide relative to the tissue thickness compensator 10020. The
support portion 10010 can further comprise a plurality of guides 10013 extending from
the deck surface 10011. The guides 10013 can be positioned adjacent to the staple
cavity openings in the deck surface 10011 such that the staple legs 10032 can be at
least partially supported by the guides 10013. A guide 10013 can be positioned at
a proximal end and/or a distal end of a staple cavity opening. According to the invention,
a first guide 10013 can be positioned at a first end of each staple cavity opening
and a second guide 10013 can be positioned at a second end of each staple cavity opening
such that each first guide 10013 can support a first staple leg 10032 of a staple
10030 and each second guide 10013 can support a second staple leg 10032 of the staple.
Referring to FIG. 33, each guide 10013 can comprise a groove or slot, such as groove
10016, for example, within which a staple leg 10032 can be slidably received. Optionally,
each guide 10013 can comprise a cleat, protrusion, and/or spike that can extend from
the deck surface 10011 and can extend into the tissue thickness compensator 10020.
As discussed in greater detail below, the cleats, protrusions, and/or spikes can reduce
relative movement between the tissue thickness compensator 10020 and the support portion
10010. The tips of the staple legs 10032 may be positioned within the guides 10013
and may not extend above the top surfaces of the guides 10013 when the staples 10030
are in their unfired position. For example, the guides 10013 can define a guide height
and the staples 10030 may not extend above this guide height when they are in their
unfired position.
[0347] According to the invention, a tissue thickness compensator, such as tissue thickness
compensator 10020, for example, can be comprised of a single sheet of material. A
tissue thickness compensator can comprise a continuous sheet of material which can
cover the entire top deck surface 10011 of the support portion 10010 or, alternatively,
cover less than the entire deck surface 10011. The sheet of material can cover the
staple cavity openings in the support portion 10010 while, alternatively, the sheet
of material can comprise openings which can be aligned, or at least partially aligned,
with the staple cavity openings. According to the invention, a tissue thickness compensator
can be comprised of multiple layers of material. Referring now to FIG. 15, a tissue
thickness compensator can comprise a compressible core and a wrap surrounding the
compressible core. A wrap 10022 can be configured to releasably hold the compressible
core to the support portion 10010. For example, the support portion 10010 can comprise
one or more projections, such as projections 10014 (FIG. 18), for example, extending
therefrom which can be received within one or more apertures and/or slots, such as
apertures 10024, for example, defined in the wrap 10022. The projections 10014 and
the apertures 10024 can be configured such that the projections 10014 can retain the
wrap 10022 to the support portion 10010. The ends of the projections 10014 can be
deformed, such as by a heat-stake process, for example, in order to enlarge the ends
of the projections 10014 and, as a result, limit the relative movement between the
wrap 10022 and the support portion 10010. The wrap 10022 can comprise one or more
perforations 10025 which can facilitate the release of the wrap 10022 from the support
portion 10010, as illustrated in FIG. 15. Referring now to FIG. 24, a tissue thickness
compensator can comprise a wrap 10222 including a plurality of apertures 10223, wherein
the apertures 10223 can be aligned, or at least partially aligned, with the staple
cavity openings in the support portion 10010. The core of the tissue thickness compensator
can also comprise apertures which are aligned, or at least partially aligned, with
the apertures 10223 in the wrap 10222. Alternatively, the core of the tissue thickness
compensator can comprise a continuous body and can extend underneath the apertures
10223 such that the continuous body covers the staple cavity openings in the deck
surface 10011.
[0348] Optionally, as described above, a tissue thickness compensator can comprise a wrap
for releasably holding a compressible core to the support portion 10010. For example,
referring to FIG. 16, a staple cartridge can further comprise retainer clips 10026
which can be configured to inhibit the wrap, and the compressible core, from prematurely
detaching from the support portion 10010. Optionally, each retainer clip 10026 can
comprise apertures 10028 which can be configured to receive the projections 10014
extending from the support portion 10010 such that the retainer clips 10026 can be
retained to the support portion 10010. The retainer clips 10026 can each comprise
at least one pan portion 10027 which can extend underneath the support portion 10010
and can support and retain the staple drivers 10040 within the support portion 10010.
As described above, a tissue thickness compensator can be removably attached to the
support portion 10010 by the staples 10030. More particularly, as also described above,
the legs of the staples 10030 can extend into the tissue thickness compensator 10020
when the staples 10030 are in their unfired position and, as a result, releasably
hold the tissue thickness compensator 10020 to the support portion 10010. The legs
of the staples 10030 can be in contact with the sidewalls of their respective staple
cavities 10012 wherein, owing to friction between the staple legs 10032 and the sidewalls,
the staples 10030 and the tissue thickness compensator 10020 can be retained in position
until the staples 10030 are deployed from the staple cartridge 10000. When the staples
10030 are deployed, the tissue thickness compensator 10020 can be captured within
the staples 10030 and held against the stapled tissue T. When the anvil is thereafter
moved into an open position to release the tissue T, the support portion 10010 can
be moved away from the tissue thickness compensator 10020 which has been fastened
to the tissue. An adhesive can be utilized to removably hold the tissue thickness
compensator 10020 to the support portion 10010. A two-part adhesive can be utilized
wherein, a first part of the adhesive can be placed on the deck surface 10011 and
a second part of the adhesive can be placed on the tissue thickness compensator 10020
such that, when the tissue thickness compensator 10020 is placed against the deck
surface 10011, the first part can contact the second part to active the adhesive and
detachably bond the tissue thickness compensator 10020 to the support portion 10010.
Optionally, any other suitable means could be used to detachably retain the tissue
thickness compensator to the support portion of a staple cartridge.
[0349] Further to the above, the sled 10050 can be advanced from the proximal end 10001
to the distal end 10002 to fully deploy all of the staples 10030 contained within
the staple cartridge 10000. Referring now to FIGS. 56-60, the sled 10050 can be advanced
distally within a longitudinal cavity 10016 within the support portion 10010 by a
firing member, or knife bar, 10052 of a surgical stapler. In use, the staple cartridge
10000 can be inserted into a staple cartridge channel in a jaw of the surgical stapler,
such as staple cartridge channel 10070, for example, and the firing member 10052 can
be advanced into contact with the sled 10050, as illustrated in FIG. 56. As the sled
10050 is advanced distally by the firing member 10052, the sled 10050 can contact
the proximal-most staple driver, or drivers, 10040 and fire, or eject, the staples
10030 from the cartridge body 10010, as described above. As illustrated in FIG. 56,
the firing member 10052 can further comprise a cutting edge 10053 which can be advanced
distally through a knife slot in the support portion 10010 as the staples 10030 are
being fired. According to the invention, a corresponding knife slot can extend through
the anvil positioned opposite the staple cartridge 10000 such that, the cutting edge
10053 can extend between the anvil and the support portion 10010 and incise the tissue
and the tissue thickness compensator positioned therebetween. In various circumstances,
the sled 10050 can be advanced distally by the firing member 10052 until the sled
10050 reaches the distal end 10002 of the staple cartridge 10000, as illustrated in
FIG. 58. At such point, the firing member 10052 can be retracted proximally. The sled
10050 can be retracted proximally with the firing member 10052 but referring now to
FIG. 59, the sled 10050 can be left behind in the distal end 10002 of the staple cartridge
10000 when the firing member 10052 is retracted. Once the firing member 10052 has
been sufficiently retracted, the anvil can be re-opened, the tissue thickness compensator
10020 can be detached from the support portion 10010, and the remaining non-implanted
portion of the expended staple cartridge 10000, including the support portion 10010,
can be removed from the staple cartridge channel 10070.
[0350] After the expended staple cartridge 10000 has been removed from the staple cartridge
channel, further to the above, a new staple cartridge 10000, or any other suitable
staple cartridge, can be inserted into the staple cartridge channel 10070. Further
to the above, the staple cartridge channel 10070, the firing member 10052, and/or
the staple cartridge 10000 can comprise cooperating features which can prevent the
firing member 10052 from being advanced distally a second, or subsequent, time without
a new, or unfired, staple cartridge 10000 positioned in the staple cartridge channel
10070. More particularly, referring again to FIG. 56, as the firing member 10052 is
advanced into contact with the sled 10050 and, when the sled 10050 is in its proximal
unfired position, a support nose 10055 of the firing member10052 can be positioned
on and/or over a support ledge 10056 on the sled 10050 such that the firing member
10052 is held in a sufficient upward position to prevent a lock, or beam, 10054 extending
from the firing member 10052 from dropping into a lock recess defined within the staple
cartridge channel. As the lock 10054 will not drop into the lock recess, in such circumstances,
the lock 10054 may not abut a distal sidewall 10057 of the lock recess as the firing
member 10052 is advanced. As the firing member 10052 pushes the sled 10050 distally,
the firing member 10052 can be supported in its upward firing position owing to the
support nose 10055 resting on the support ledge 10056. When the firing member 10052
is retracted relative to the sled 10050, as discussed above and illustrated in FIG.
59, the firing member 10052 can drop downwardly from its upward position as the support
nose 10055 is no longer resting on the support ledge 10056 of the sled 10050. For
example, the surgical staple can comprise a spring 10058, and/or any other suitable
biasing element, which can be configured to bias the firing member 10052 into its
downward position. Once the firing member 10052 has been completely retracted, as
illustrated in FIG. 60, the firing member 10052 cannot be advanced distally through
the spent staple cartridge 10000 once again. More particularly, the firing member
10052 can't be held in its upper position by the sled 10050 as the sled 10050, at
this point in the operating sequence, has been left behind at the distal end 10002
of the staple cartridge 10000. Thus, as mentioned above, in the event that the firing
member 10052 is advanced once again without replacing the staple cartridge, the lock
beam 10054 will contact the sidewall 10057 of the lock recess which will prevent the
firing member 10052 from being advanced distally into the staple cartridge 10000 once
again. Stated another way, once the spent staple cartridge 10000 has been replaced
with a new staple cartridge, the new staple cartridge will have a proximally-positioned
sled 10050 which can hold the firing member 10052 in its upper position and allow
the firing member 10052 to be advanced distally once again.
[0351] As described above, the sled 10050 can be configured to move the staple drivers 10040
between a first, unfired position and a second, fired position in order to eject staples
10030 from the support portion 10010. The staple drivers 10040 can be contained within
the staple cavities 10012 after the staples 10030 have been ejected from the support
portion 10010. The support portion 10010 can comprise one or more retention features
which can be configured to block the staple drivers 10040 from being ejected from,
or falling out of, the staple cavities 10012. Alternatively, the sled 10050 can be
configured to eject the staple drivers 10040 from the support portion 10010 with the
staples 10030. For example, the staple drivers 10040 can be comprised of a bioabsorbable
and/or biocompatible material, such as Ultem, for example. The staple drivers can
be attached to the staples 10030. For example, a staple driver can be molded over
and/or around the base of each staple 10030 such that the driver is integrally formed
with the staple.
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 11/541,123, entitled SURGICAL STAPLES HAVING COMPRESSIBLE OR CRUSHABLE MEMBERS FOR SECURING
TISSUE THEREIN AND STAPLING INSTRUMENTS FOR DEPLOYING THE SAME, filed on September
29, 2006, is hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety.
[0352] As described above, a surgical stapling instrument can comprise a staple cartridge
channel configured to receive a staple cartridge, an anvil rotatably coupled to the
staple cartridge channel, and a firing member comprising a knife edge which is movable
relative to the anvil and the staple cartridge channel. In use, a staple cartridge
can be positioned within the staple cartridge channel and, after the staple cartridge
has been at least partially expended, the staple cartridge can be removed from the
staple cartridge channel and replaced with a new staple cartridge. For example, the
staple cartridge channel, the anvil, and/or the firing member of the surgical stapling
instrument may be re-used with the replacement staple cartridge. Alternatively, a
staple cartridge may comprise a part of a disposable loading unit assembly which can
include a staple cartridge channel, an anvil, and/or a firing member, for example,
which can be replaced along with the staple cartridge as part of replacing the disposable
loading unit assembly. Certain disposable loading unit assemblies are disclosed in
U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 12/031,817, entitled END EFFECTOR COUPLING ARRANGEMENTS FOR A SURGICAL CUTTING AND STAPLING
INSTRUMENT, which was filed on February 15, 2008, the entire disclosure of which is
incorporated by reference herein.
[0353] The tissue thickness compensator may comprise an extrudable, a castable, and/or moldable
composition comprising at least one of the synthetic and/or non-synthetic materials
described herein. The tissue thickness compensator may comprise a film or sheet comprising
two or more layers. The tissue thickness compensator may be obtained using conventional
methods, such as, for example, mixing, blending, compounding, spraying, wicking, solvent
evaporating, dipping, brushing, vapor deposition, extruding, calendaring, casting,
molding and the like. In extrusion, an opening may be in the form of a die comprising
at least one opening to impart a shape to the emerging extrudate. In calendering,
an opening may comprise a nip between two rolls. Conventional molding methods may
include, but are not limited to, blow molding, injection molding, foam injection,
compression molding, thermoforming, extrusion, foam extrusion, film blowing, calendaring,
spinning, solvent welding, coating methods, such as dip coating and spin coating,
solution casting and film casting, plastisol processing (including knife coating,
roller coating and casting), and combinations thereof. In injection molding, an opening
may comprise a nozzle and/or channels/runners and/or mold cavities and features. In
compression molding, the composition may be positioned in a mold cavity, heated to
a suitable temperature, and shaped by exposure to compression under relatively high
pressure. In casting, the composition may comprise a liquid or slurry that may be
poured or otherwise provided into, onto and/or around a mold or object to replicate
features of the mold or object. After casting, the composition may be dried, cooled,
and/or cured to form a solid.
[0354] According to the invention, a method of manufacturing a tissue thickness compensator
may generally comprise providing a tissue thickness compensator composition, liquifying
the composition to make it flowable, and forming the composition in the molten, semi-molten,
or plastic state into a layer and/or film having the desired thickness. Referring
to FIG. 198A, a tissue thickness compensator may be manufactured by dissolving a hydrogel
precursor in an aqueous solution, dispersing biocompatible particles and/or fibers
therein, providing a mold having biocompatible particles therein, providing the solution
into the mold, contacting an activator and the solution, and curing the solution to
form the tissue thickness compensator comprising an outer layer comprise biocompatible
particles and an inner layer comprising biocompatible particles embedded therein.
A shown in FIG. 198A, a biocompatible layer 70250 may be provided in the bottom of
a mold 70260, and an aqueous solution of a hydrogel precursor 70255 having biocompatible
particles 70257 disposed therein may be provided to the mold 70260, and the aqueous
solution may be cured to form a tissue thickness compensator having a first layer
comprising a biocompatible material, such as ORC, for example, and a second layer
comprising a hydrogel having biocompatible fibers, such as ORC fibers, disposed therein.
The tissue thickness compensator may comprise a foam comprising an outer layer comprise
biocompatible particles and an inner layer comprising biocompatible particles embedded
therein. A tissue thickness compensator may be manufactured by dissolving a sodium
alginater in water, dispersing ORC particles therein, providing a mold having ORC
particles therein, pouring the solution into the mold, spraying or infusing calcium
chloride to contact the solution to initiate crosslinking of the sodium alginater,
freeze drying the hydrogel to form the tissue thickness compensator comprising an
outer layer comprising ORC and an inner layer comprising a hydrogel and ORC particles
embedded therein.
[0355] Referring to FIG. 198Ba method of manufacturing a trilayer tissue thickness compensator
may generally comprise by dissolving a first hydrogel precursor in a first aqueous
solution, dispersing biocompatible particles and/or fibers in the first aqueous solution,
providing a mold 70260 having a first layer 70250 of biocompatible particles therein,
providing the first aqueous solution into the mold, contacting an activator and the
first aqueous solution, curing the first aqueous solution to form a second layer 70255,
dissolving a second hydrogel precursor in a second aqueous solution, providing the
second aqueous solution into the mold, curing the second aqueous solution to form
a third layer 70265. A trilayer tissue thickness compensator may be manufactured by
dissolving a sodium alginater in water to form a first aqueous solution, dispersing
ORC particles in the first aqueous solution, providing a mold having a first layer
of ORC particles therein, pouring the first aqueous solution into the mold, spraying
or infusing calcium chloride to contact the first aqueous solution to initiate crosslinking
of the sodium alginater, freeze drying the first aqueous solution to form a second
layer comprising a hydrogel having ORC particles embedded therein, dissolving a sodium
alginater in water to form a second aqueous solution, pouring the second aqueous solution
into the mold, spraying or infusing calcium chloride to contact the second aqueous
solution to initiate crosslinking of the sodium alginater, freeze drying the second
aqueous solution to form a third layer comprising a hydrogel.
[0356] According to the invention, a method of manufacturing a tissue thickness compensator
comprising at least one medicament stored and/or absorbed therein may generally comprise
providing a tissue thickness compensator and contacting the tissue thickness compensator
and the medicament to retain the medicament in the tissue thickness compensator. A
method of manufacturing a tissue thickness compensator comprising an antibacterial
material may comprise providing a hydrogel, drying the hydrogel, swelling the hydrogel
in an aqueous solution of silver nitrate, contacting the hydrogel and a solution of
sodium chloride to form the tissue thickness compensator having antibacterial properties.
The tissue thickness compensator may comprise silver dispersed therein.
[0357] Referring to FIG. 204a method for manufacturing a tissue thickness compensator may
comprise co-extrusion and/or bonding. The tissue thickness compensator 70550 may comprise
a laminate comprising a first layer 70555 and a second layer 70560 sealingly enclosing
an inner layer 70565 comprising a hydrogel, for example. The hydrogel may comprise
a dry film, a dry foam, a powder, and/or granules, for example. The hydrogel may comprise
super absorbent materials, such as, for example, polyvinylpyrrolidone, carboxy methycellulose,
poly sulful propyl acrylate. The first and/or second layers may be made in-line by
feeding raw materials of the first and second layers, respectively, into an extruder
from a hopper, and thereafter supplying the first and second layers. The raw materials
of the inner layer 70565 may be added to a hopper of an extruder. The raw materials
can be dispersively mixed and compounded at an elevated temperature within the extruder.
As the raw materials exit the die 70570 at an opening, the inner layer 70565 may be
deposited onto a surface of the first layer 70555. The tissue thickness compensator
may comprise a foam, film, powder, and/or granule. The first and second layers 70555
and 70560 may be positioned in the face-to-face relationship. The second layer 70560
may be aligned with the first layer 70555 in a face-to-face relationship by a roller
70575. The first layer 70555 may adhere to the second layer 70560 wherein the first
and second layers 70555, 70560 may physically entrap the inner layer 70565. The layers
may be joined together under light pressure, under conventional calendar bonding processes,
and/or through the use of adhesives, for example, to form the tissue thickness compensator
70550. As shown in FIG. 78, the first and second layers 70555 and 70560 may be joined
together through a rolling process utilizing a grooved roller 70580, for example.
Optionally, as a result of the above, the inner layer 70565 may be contained and/or
sealed by the first and second layers 70555 and 70560 which can collectively form
an outer layer, or barrier. The outer layer may prevent or reduce moisture from contacting
the inner layer 70565 until the outer layer is ruptured.
[0358] Referring to
FIG. 61, an end effector 12 for a surgical instrument 10
(FIG. 1) can be configured to receive a fastener cartridge assembly, such as staple cartridge
20000, for example. As illustrated in
FIG. 61, the staple cartridge 20000 can be configured to fit in a cartridge channel 20072
of a jaw 20070 of the end effector 12. Alternatively, the staple cartridge 20000 can
be integral to the end effector 12 such that the staple cartridge 20000 and the end
effector 12 are formed as a single unit construction. The staple cartridge 20000 can
comprise a first body portion, such as rigid support portion 20010, for example. The
staple cartridge 20000 can also comprise a second body portion, such as a compressible
portion or a tissue thickness compensator 20020, for example. Alternatively, the tissue
thickness compensator 20020 may not comprise an integral part of the staple cartridge
20000 but may be otherwise positioned relative to the end effector 12. For example,
the tissue thickness compensator 20020 can be secured to an anvil 20060 of the end
effector 12 or can be otherwise retained in the end effector 12. Referring to
FIG. 78, the staple cartridge can further comprise retainer clips 20126 which can be configured
to inhibit the tissue thickness compensator 20020 from prematurely detaching from
the support portion 20010. The reader will appreciate that the tissue thickness compensators
described herein can be installed in or otherwise engaged with a variety of end effectors
and that These are within the scope of the present disclosure.
[0359] Similar to the tissue thickness compensators described herein, referring now to
FIG. 78, the tissue thickness compensator 20020 can be released from or disengaged with the
surgical end effector 12. For example, the rigid support portion 20010 of the staple
cartridge 20000 can remain engaged with the fastener cartridge channel 20072 of the
end effector jaw 20070 while the tissue thickness compensator 20020 disengages from
the rigid support portion 20010. The tissue thickness compensator 20020 can release
from the end effector 12 after staples 20030
(FIGS. 78-83) are deployed from staple cavities 20012 in the rigid support portion 2010. Staples
20030 can be fired from staple cavities 20012 such that the staples 20030 engage the
tissue thickness compensator 20020. Also, referring generally to
FIGS. 63, 82 and
83, a staple 20030 can capture a portion of the tissue thickness compensator 20020 along
with stapled tissue T. The tissue thickness compensator 20020 can be deformable and
the portion of the tissue thickness compensator 20020 that is captured within a fired
staple 20030 can be compressed. Similar to the tissue thickness compensators described
herein, the tissue thickness compensator 20020 can compensate for different thicknesses,
compressibilities, and / or densities of tissue T captured within each staple 20030.
Further, as also described herein, the tissue thickness compensator 20020 can compensate
for gaps created by malformed staples 20030.
[0360] The tissue thickness compensator 20020 can be compressible between non-compressed
height(s) and compressed height(s). Referring to FIG. 78, the tissue thickness compensator
20020 can have a top surface 20021 and a bottom surface 20022. The height of the tissue
thickness compensator can be the distance between the top surface 20021 and the bottom
surface 20022. The non-compressed height of the tissue thickness compensator 20020
can be the distance between the top surface 20021 and the bottom surface 20022 when
minimal or no force is applied to the tissue thickness compensator 20020, i.e., when
the tissue thickness compensator 20020 is not compressed. The compressed height of
the tissue thickness compensator 20020 can be the distance between the top surface
20021 and the bottom surface 20022 when a force is applied to the tissue thickness
compensator 20020, such as when a fired staple 20030 captures a portion of the tissue
thickness compensator 20020, for example. The tissue thickness compensator 20020 can
have a distal end 20025 and a proximal end 20026. As illustrated in
FIG. 78, the non-compressed height of the tissue thickness compensator 20020 can be uniform
between the distal end 20025 and the proximal end 20026 of the tissue thickness compensator
20020. Alternatively, the non-compressed height can vary between the distal end 20025
and the proximal end 20026. For example, the top surface 20021 and / or bottom surface
20022 of the tissue thickness compensator 20020 can be angled and / or stepped relative
to the other such that the non-compressed height varies between the proximal end 20026
and the distal end 20025. The non-compressed height of the tissue thickness compensator
20020 can be approximately 0.08 inches, for example. Alternatively, the non-compressed
height of the tissue thickness compensator 20020 can vary between approximately 0.025
inches and approximately 0.10 inches, for example.
[0361] As described in greater detail herein, the tissue thickness compensator 20020 can
be compressed to different compressed heights between the proximal end 20026 and the
distal end 20025 thereof. Alternatively, the tissue thickness compensator 20020 can
be uniformly compressed throughout the length thereof. The compressed height(s) of
the tissue thickness compensator 20020 can depend on the geometry of the end effector
12, characteristics of the tissue thickness compensator 20020, the engaged tissue
T and / or the staples 20030, for example. The compressed height of the tissue thickness
compensator 20020 can relate to the tissue gap in the end effector 12. Optionally,
when the anvil 20060 is clamped towards the staple cartridge 20000, the tissue gap
can be defined between a top deck surface 20011
(FIG. 78) of the staple cartridge 20000 and a tissue contacting surface 20061
(FIG. 61) of the anvil 20060, for example. The tissue gap can be approximately 0.025 inches
or approximately 0.100 inches, for example. The tissue gap can be approximately 0.750
millimeters or approximately 3.500 millimeters, for example. The compressed height
of the tissue thickness compensator 20020 can equal or substantially equal the tissue
gap, for example. When tissue T is positioned within the tissue gap of the end effector
12, the compressed height of the tissue thickness compensator can be less in order
to accommodate the tissue T. For example, where the tissue gap is approximately 0.750
millimeters, the compressed height of the tissue thickness compensator can be approximately
0.500 millimeters. Where the tissue gap is approximately 3.500 millimeters, the compressed
height of the tissue thickness compensator 20020 can be approximately 2.5 mm, for
example. Furthermore, the tissue thickness compensator 20020 can comprise a minimum
compressed height. For example, the minimum compressed height of the tissue thickness
compensator 20020 can be approximately 0.250 millimeters. The tissue gap defined between
the deck surface of the staple cartridge and the tissue contacting surface of the
anvil can equal, or at least substantially equal, the uncompressed height of the tissue
thickness compensator, for example.
[0362] Referring primarily to
FIG. 62, the tissue thickness compensator 20020 can comprise a fibrous, nonwoven material
20080 including fibers 20082. The tissue thickness compensator 20020 can comprise
felt or a felt-like material. Fibers 20082 in the nonwoven material 20080 can be fastened
together by any means known in the art, including, but not limited to, needle-punching,
thermal bonding, hydro-entanglement, ultrasonic pattern bonding, chemical bonding,
and meltblown bonding. Further, layers of nonwoven material 20080 can be mechanically,
thermally, or chemically fastened together to form the tissue thickness compensator
20020. As described in greater detail herein, the fibrous, nonwoven material 20080
can be compressible, which can enable compression of the tissue thickness compensator
20020. The tissue thickness compensator 20020 can comprise a non-compressible portion
as well. For example, the tissue thickness compensator 20020 can comprise a compressible
nonwoven material 20080 and a non-compressible portion.
[0363] Still referring primarily to
FIG. 62, the nonwoven material 20080 can comprise a plurality of fibers 20082. At least some
of the fibers 20082 in the nonwoven material 20080 can be crimped fibers 20086. The
crimped fibers 20086 can be, for example, crimped, twisted, coiled, bent, crippled,
spiraled, curled, and / or bowed within the nonwoven material 20080. As described
in greater detail herein, the crimped fibers 20086 can be formed in any suitable shape
such that deformation of the crimped fibers 20086 generates a spring load or restoring
force. The crimped fibers 20086 can be heat-shaped to form a coiled or substantially
coil-like shape. The crimped fibers 20086 can be formed from non-crimped fibers 20084.
For example, non-crimped fibers 20084 can be wound around a heated mandrel to form
a substantially coil-like shape.
[0364] The tissue thickness compensator 20020 can comprise a homogeneous absorbable polymer
matrix. The homogenous absorbable polymer matrix can comprise a foam, gel, and / or
film, for example. Further, the plurality of fibers 20082 can be dispersed throughout
the homogenous absorbable polymer matrix. At least some of the fibers 20082 in the
homogenous absorbable polymer matrix can be crimped fibers 20086, for example. As
described in greater detail herein, the homogeneous absorbable polymer matrix of the
tissue thickness compensator 2002 can be compressible.
[0365] Referring to
FIGS. 65 and
66, crimped fibers 20086 can be randomly dispersed throughout at least a portion of the
nonwoven material 20080. For example, crimped fibers 20086 can be randomly dispersed
throughout the nonwoven material 20080 such that a portion of the nonwoven material
20080 comprises more crimped fibers 20086 than other portions of the nonwoven material
20080. Further, the crimped fibers 20086 can congregate in fiber clusters 20085a,
20085b, 20085c, 20085d and 20085e, for example, in the nonwoven material 20080. The
shape of the crimped fibers 20086 can cause entanglement of the fibers 20086 during
manufacturing of the nonwoven material 20080; entanglement of the crimped fibers 20086
can, in turn, result in the formation of the fiber clusters 20085a, 20085b, 20085c,
20085d and 20085e. Additionally or alternatively, crimped fibers 20086 can be randomly
oriented throughout the nonwoven material 20080. For example, referring to
FIG. 62, a first crimped fiber 20086a can be oriented in a first direction, a second crimped
fiber 20086b can be oriented in a second direction, and a third crimped fiber 20086c
can be oriented in a third direction.
[0366] The crimped fibers 20086 can be systematically distributed and / or arranged throughout
at least a portion of the nonwoven material 20080. For example, referring now to
FIG. 67, crimped fibers 20186 can be positioned in an arrangement 20185, in which a plurality
of crimped fibers 20186a are arranged in a first direction and another plurality of
crimped fibers 20186b are arranged in a second direction. The crimped fibers 20186
can overlap such that they become entangled or interconnected with each other. The
crimped fibers 20186 can be systematically arranged such that a crimped fiber 20186a
is substantially parallel to another crimped fiber 20186a. Still another crimped fiber
20186b can be substantially transverse to some crimped fibers 20186a. Optionally,
crimped fibers 20186a can be substantially aligned with a first axis Y and crimped
fibers 20186b can be substantially aligned with a second axis X. The first axis Y
can be perpendicular or substantially perpendicular to the second axis X, for example.
[0367] Referring primarily to
FIG. 68crimped fibers 20286 can be arranged in an arrangement 20285. Each crimped fibers
20286 can comprise a longitudinal axis defined between a first end 20287 and a second
end 20289 of the crimped fiber 20286. The crimped fibers 20286 can be systematically
distributed in the nonwoven material 20080 such that a first end 20287 of one crimped
fiber 20286 is positioned adjacent to a second end 20289 of another crimped fiber
20286. Alternatively, referring now to
FIG. 69, a fiber arrangement 20385 can comprise a first crimped fiber 20386a oriented in a
first direction, a second crimped fiber 20386b oriented in a second direction, and
a third crimped fiber 20386c oriented in a third direction, for example. According
to the invention, a single pattern or arrangement of crimped fibers 20286 can be repeated
throughout the nonwoven material 20080. Crimped fibers can be arranged in different
patterns throughout the nonwoven material 20080. As an additional alternative, the
nonwoven material 20080 can comprise at least one pattern of crimped fibers, as well
as a plurality of randomly oriented and / or randomly distributed crimped fibers.
[0368] Referring again to
FIG. 62, the plurality of fibers 20082 in the nonwoven material 20080 can comprise at least
some non-crimped fibers 20084. The non-crimped fibers 20084 and crimped fibers 20086
in the nonwoven material 20080 can be entangled or interconnected. The ratio of crimped
fibers 20086 to non-crimped fibers 20084 can be approximately 25:1, for example. Alternatively,
the ratio of crimped fibers 20086 to non-crimped fibers 20084 can be approximately
1:25, for example. Alternatively, the ratio of crimped fibers 20086 to non-crimped
fibers 20084 can be approximately 1:1, for example. As described in greater detail
herein, the number of crimped fibers 20086 per unit volume of nonwoven material 20080
can affect the restoring force generated by the nonwoven material 20080 when the nonwoven
material 20080 has been deformed. As also described in greater detail herein, the
restoring force generated by the nonwoven material 20080 can also depend on, for example,
the material, shape, size, position and / or orientation of crimped and non-crimped
fibers 20086, 20084 in the nonwoven material 20080.
[0369] The fibers 20082 of the nonwoven material 20080 can comprise a polymeric composition.
The polymeric composition of the fibers 20082 can comprise non-absorbable polymers,
absorbable polymers, or combinations thereof. The absorbable polymers can include
bioabsorbable, biocompatible elastomeric polymers. Furthermore, the polymeric composition
of the fibers 20082 can comprise synthetic polymers, non-synthetic polymers, or combinations
thereof. Examples of synthetic polymers include, but are not limited to, polyglycolic
acid (PGA), poly(lactic acid) (PLA), polycaprolactone (PCL), polydioxanone (PDO),
and copolymers thereof. For example, the fibers 20082 can comprise a 90/10 poly(glycolide-L-lactide)
copolymer, such as, for example, the copolymer commercially available from Ethicon,
Inc. under the trade designation "VICRYL (polyglactic 910)." Examples of non-synthetic
polymers include, but are not limited to, lyophilized polysaccharide, glycoprotein,
elastin, proteoglycan, gelatin, collagen, and oxidized regenerated cellulose (ORC).
Optionally, similar to the polymeric compositions in tissue thickness compensators
described herein, the polymeric composition of the fibers 20082 can include varied
amounts of absorbable polymers, non-absorbable polymers, synthetic polymers, and /
or non-synthetic polymers, for example, by weight percentage.
[0370] The crimped fibers 20086 of the nonwoven material 20080 can comprise a first polymeric
composition and the non-crimped fibers 20084 of the nonwoven material 20080 can comprise
a different polymeric composition. For example, the crimped fibers 20086 can comprise
synthetic polymer(s), such as, for example, 90/10 poly(glycolide-L-lactide), while
the non-crimped fibers 20084 can comprise non-synthetic polymer(s), such as, for example,
oxidized regenerated cellulose. Alternatively, the crimped fibers 20086 and the non-crimped
fibers 20084 can comprise the same polymeric composition.
[0371] As described herein, crimped fibers 20086 and non-crimped fibers 20084 can be fastened
together, for example, by needle-punching, thermal bonding, hydro-entanglement, ultrasonic
pattern bonding, chemical bonding, and meltblown bonding. Crimped fibers 20086 comprising
synthetic polymers such as, for example, "VICRYL (polyglactic 910)", and non-crimped
fibers 20084 comprising oxidized regenerated cellulose can be needle-punched together
to form the nonwoven material 20080. The nonwoven material 20080 can comprise approximately
5% to 50% crimped "VICRYL (polyglactic 910)" fibers 20086 by weight and approximately
5% to 50% non-crimped oxidized regenerated cellulose (ORC) fibers 20084 by weight,
for example. When the nonwoven material 20080 contacts tissue T, the non-crimped ORC
fibers 20084 can rapidly react with plasma in the tissue to form a gelatinous mass,
for example. The formation of the gelatinous ORC mass can be instantaneous or nearly
instantaneous with the tissue contact. Further, after the formation of the gelatinous
ORC mass, the crimped "VICRYL (polyglactic 910)" fibers 20086 can remain dispersed
throughout the nonwoven material 20080. For example, the crimped fibers 20086 can
be suspended in the gelatinous ORC mass. As the gelatinous ORC mass is bioabsorbed,
the crimped "VICRYL (polyglactic 910)" fibers 20086 can exert a springback force on
adjacent tissue, as described in greater detail herein. Further, the tissue can begin
to heal around the "VICRYL (polyglactic 910)" fibers and / or the formed staples 30030,
as also described in greater detail herein.
[0372] Referring primarily to
FIGS. 78-81, the support portion 20010 of the staple cartridge 20000 can comprise a cartridge
body 20017, a top deck surface 20011, and a plurality of staple cavities 20012. Each
staple cavity 20012 can define an opening in the deck surface 20011. A staple 20030
can be removably positioned in a staple cavity 20012. According to the invention,
a single staple 20030 is disposed in each staple cavity 20012. Referring primarily
to
FIGS. 82 and
83 and similar to the staples described herein, each staple 20030 can comprise a base
20031 having a first end 20035 and a second end 20036. A staple leg 20032 can extend
from the first end 20035 of the base 20031 and another staple leg 20032 can extend
from the second end 20036 of the base 20031. Referring again to
FIGS. 78-81, prior to the deployment of the staples 20030, the base 20031 of each staple 20030
can be supported by a staple driver 20040 positioned within the rigid support portion
20010 of the staple cartridge 20000. Also prior to deployment of the staples 20030,
the legs 20032 of each staple 20030 can be at least partially contained within a staple
cavity 20012.
[0373] The staples 20030 can be deployed between an initial position and a fired position.
For example, referring primarily to
FIG. 81, staples 20030 can be in an initial position (staples 20030e, 20030f), a partially
fired or intermediate position (staples 20030c, 20030d), or a fired position (staples
20030a, 20030b). A driver 20040 can motivate the staples between the initial position
and the fired position. For example, the base 20031 of each staple 20030 can be supported
by a driver 20040. The legs 20032 of a staple (staples 20030e, 20030f in
FIG. 80, for example) can be positioned within a staple cavity 20012. As the firing member
or staple-firing sled 20050 translates from the proximal end 20001 to the distal end
20002 of the staple cartridge 20000, an inclined surface 20051 on the sled 20050 can
contact an inclined surface 20042 on a driver 20040 to deploy the staple 20030 positioned
above to the contacted driver 20040. The staples 20030 can be deployed between an
initial position and a fired position such that the legs 20032 move through the nonwoven
material 20080 of the tissue thickness compensator 20020, penetrate the top surface
20021 of the tissue thickness compensator 20020, penetrate tissue T, and contact an
anvil 20060
(FIG. 61) positioned opposite the staple cartridge 20000 in the end effector 12. The staple
legs 20032 can be deformed against the anvil 20060 and the legs 20032 of each staple
20030 can capture a portion of the nonwoven material 20080 and a portion of the tissue
T.
[0374] In the fired configuration
(FIGS. 82 and
83), each staple 20030 can apply a compressive force to the tissue T and to the tissue
thickness compensator 20020 captured within the staple 20030. Referring primarily
to
FIGS. 80 and
81, the legs 20032 of each staple 20030 can be deformed downwardly toward the base 20031
of the staple 20030 to form a staple entrapment area 20039. The staple entrapment
area 20039 can be the area in which the tissue T and the tissue thickness compensator
20020 can be captured by a fired staple 20030. In various circumstances, the staple
entrapment area 20039 can be defined between the inner surfaces of the deformed legs
20032 and the inner surface of the base 20031 of a staple 20030. The size of the entrapment
area 20039 for a staple 20030 can depend on several factors such as the length of
the legs, the diameter of the legs, the width of the base, and/or the extent in which
the legs are deformed, for example.
[0375] Optionally, when a nonwoven material 20080 is captured in a staple entrapment area
20039, the captured portion of the nonwoven material 20080 can be compressed. The
compressed height of the nonwoven material 20080 captured in a staple entrapment area
20039 can vary within the staple cartridge 20000 depending on the tissue T in that
same staple entrapment area 20039. For example, where the tissue T is thinner, the
staple entrapment area 20039 may have more room for the nonwoven material 20080 and,
as a result, the nonwoven material 20080 may not be as compressed as it would be if
the tissue T were thicker. Where the tissue T is thicker, the nonwoven material 20080
can be compressed more to accommodate the thicker tissue T, for example. For example,
referring to
FIG. 82, the nonwoven material 20080 can be compressed to a first height in a first staple
entrapment area 20039a, a second height in a second staple entrapment area 20039b,
a third height in a third staple entrapment area 20039c, a fourth height in a fourth
staple entrapment area 20039d, and a fifth height in a fifth staple entrapment area
20039e, for example. Similarly, as illustrated in
FIG. 83, the nonwoven material 20080 can be compressed to a first height in the first staple
entrapment area 20039a, a second height in the second staple entrapment area 20039b,
a third height in the third staple entrapment area 20039c, and a fourth height in
the fourth staple entrapment area 20039d. Alternatively, the compressed height of
the nonwoven material 20080 can be uniform throughout the staple cartridge 20010.
[0376] Optionally, an applied force can move the nonwoven material 20080 from an initial
uncompressed configuration to a compressed configuration. Further, the nonwoven material
20080 can be resilient, such that, when compressed, the nonwoven material 20080 can
generate a springback or restoring force. When deformed, the nonwoven material 20080
can seek to rebound from the compressed or deformed configuration. As the nonwoven
material 20080 seeks to rebound, it can exert a springback or restoring force on the
tissue also captured in the staple entrapment area 30039, as described in greater
detail herein. When the applied force is subsequently removed, the restoring force
can cause the nonwoven material to rebound from the compressed configuration. The
nonwoven material 20080 can rebound to the initial, uncompressed configuration or
may rebound to a configuration substantially similar to the initial, uncompressed
configuration. The deformation of the nonwoven material 20080 can be elastic. The
deformation of the nonwoven material can be partially elastic and partially plastic.
[0377] When a portion of the nonwoven material 20080 is compressed in a staple entrapment
area 20039, the crimped fibers 20086 in that portion of the nonwoven compensator 20039
can also be compressed or otherwise deformed. The amount a crimped fiber 20086 is
deformed can correspond to the amount that the captured portion of the nonwoven material
20080 is compressed. For example, referring to
FIG. 63, the nonwoven material 20080 can be captured by deployed staples 20030. Where the
nonwoven material 20080 is more compressed by a deployed staple 20030, the average
deformation of crimped fibers 20086 can be greater. Further, where the nonwoven material
20080 is less compressed by a deployed staple, the average deformation of crimped
fibers 20086 can be smaller. Similarly, referring to
FIGS. 82 and
83, in a staple entrapment area 20039d where the nonwoven material 20080 is more compressed,
the crimped fibers 20086 in that staple entrapment area 20039d can be, on average,
more deformed. Further, in a staple entrapment area 20039a where the nonwoven material
20080 is less compressed, the crimped fibers 20086 in that staple entrapment area
20039a can be, on average, less deformed.
[0378] The ability of the nonwoven material 20080 to rebound from the deformed configuration,
i.e., the resiliency of the nonwoven material 20080, can be a function of the resiliency
of the crimped fibers 20086 in the nonwoven material 20080. The crimped fibers 20086
can deform elastically. Deformation of the crimped fibers 20086 can be partially elastic
and partially plastic. Optionally, compression of each crimped fiber 20086 can cause
the compressed crimped fibers 20086 to generate a springback or restoring force. For
example, the compressed crimped fibers 20086 can generate a restoring force as the
fibers 20086 seek to rebound from their compressed configuration. The fibers 20086
can seek to return to their initial, uncompressed configuration or to a configuration
substantially similar thereto. The crimped fibers 20086 can seek to partially return
to their initial configuration. Optionally, only a portion of the crimped fibers 20086
in the nonwoven material 20080 can be resilient. When a crimped fiber 20086 is comprised
of a linear-elastic material, the restoring force of the compressed crimped fiber
20086 can be a function of the amount the crimped fiber 20086 is compressed and the
spring rate of the crimped fiber 20086, for example. The spring rate of the crimped
fiber 20086 can at least depend on the orientation, material, shape and / or size
of the crimped fiber 20086, for example.
[0379] The crimped fibers 20086 in the nonwoven material 20080 can comprise a uniform spring
rate. Alternatively, the spring rate of the crimped fibers 20086 in the nonwoven material
20080 can vary. When a crimped fiber 20086 having a large spring rate is greatly compressed,
the crimped fiber 20086 can generate a large restoring force. When a crimped fiber
20086 having the same large spring rate is less compressed, the crimped fiber 20086
can generate a smaller restoring force. The aggregate of restoring forces generated
by compressed crimped fibers 20086 in the nonwoven material 20080 can generate a combined
restoring force throughout the nonwoven material 20080 of the tissue thickness compensator
20020. The nonwoven material 20080 can exert the combined restoring force on tissue
T captured within a fired staple 20030 with the compressed nonwoven material 20080.
[0380] Furthermore, the number of crimped fibers 20086 per unit volume of nonwoven material
20080 can affect the spring rate of the nonwoven material 20080. For example, the
resiliency in a nonwoven material 20080 can be low when the number of crimped fibers
20086 per unit volume of nonwoven material 20080 is low, for example; the resiliency
of the nonwoven material 20080 can be higher when the number of crimped fibers 20086
per unit volume of nonwoven material 20080 is higher, for example; and the resiliency
of the nonwoven material 20080 can be higher still when the number of crimped fibers
20086 per unit volume of nonwoven material 20080 is even higher, for example. When
the resiliency of the nonwoven material 20080 is low, such as when the number of crimped
fibers 20086 per unit volume of nonwoven material 20080 is low, the combined restoring
force exerted by the tissue thickness compensator 20020 on captured tissue T can also
be low. When the resiliency of the nonwoven material 20080 is higher, such as when
the number of crimped fibers 20086 per unit volume of nonwoven material 20080 is higher,
the aggregate restoring force exerted by the tissue thickness compensator 20020 on
captured tissue T can also be higher.
[0381] Referring primarily to
FIG. 64, a nonwoven material 20080' of a tissue thickness compensator 20020' can comprise
a therapeutic agent 20088, such as a medicament and / or pharmaceutically active agent,
for example. The nonwoven material 20080' can release a therapeutically effective
amount of the therapeutic agent 20088. For example, the therapeutic agent 20088 can
be released as the nonwoven material 20080' is absorbed. The therapeutic agent 20088
can be released into fluid, such as blood, for example, passing over or through the
nonwoven material 20080'. Examples of therapeutic agents 20088 can include, but are
not limited to, haemostatic agents and drugs such as, for example, fibrin, thrombin,
and / or oxidized regenerated cellulose (ORC); anti-inflammatory drugs such as, for
example, diclofenac, aspirin, naproxen, sulindac, and / or hydrocortisone; antibiotic
and antimicrobial drugs or agents such as, for example, triclosan, ionic silver, ampicillin,
gentamicin, polymyxin B, and / or chloramphenicol; and anticancer agents such as,
for example, cisplatin, mitomycin, and / or adriamycin. The therapeutic agent 20088
can comprise a biologic, such as a stem cell, for example. The fibers 20082 of the
nonwoven material 20080' can comprise the therapeutic agent 20088. Alternatively,
the therapeutic agent 20088 can be added to the nonwoven material 20080' or otherwise
integrated into the tissue thickness compensator 20020'.
[0382] Primarily referring to
FIGS. 70-70B, a tissue thickness compensator 20520 for an end effector 12
(FIG. 61) can comprise a plurality of springs or coiled fibers 20586. Similar to the crimped
fibers 20086 described herein, the coiled fibers 20586 can be, for example, crimped,
twisted, coiled, bent, crippled, spiraled, curled, and / or bowed within the tissue
thickness compensator 20520. The coiled fibers 20586 can be wound around a mandrel
to form a coiled or substantially coil-like shape. The coiled fibers 20586 can be
randomly oriented and / or randomly distributed throughout the tissue thickness compensator
20520. Alternatively, the coiled fibers 20586 can be systematically arranged and /
or uniformly distributed throughout the tissue thickness compensator 20520. For example,
referring to
FIG. 70, the coiled fibers 20586 can comprise a longitudinal axis between a first end 20587
and a second end 20589 of the coiled fiber 20586. The longitudinal axes of the coiled
fibers 20520 in the tissue thickness compensator 20520 can be parallel or substantially
parallel. The first end 20587 of each coiled fiber 20520 can be positioned along a
first longitudinal side 20523 of the tissue thickness compensator 20520 and the second
end 20589 of each coiled fiber 20586 can be positioned along a second longitudinal
side 20524 of the tissue thickness compensator 20520. In such an arrangement, the
coiled fibers 20586 can laterally traverse the tissue thickness compensator. Alternatively,
the coiled fibers 20586 can longitudinally or diagonally traverse the tissue thickness
compensator 20520.
[0383] Optionally, similar to the crimped fibers 20086 described herein, the coiled fibers
20586 can comprise a polymeric composition. The crimped fibers 20586 can be at least
partially elastic such that deformation of the crimped fibers 20586 generates a restoring
force. The polymeric composition of the coiled fibers 20586 can comprise polycaprolactone
(PCL), for example, such that the coiled fibers 20586 are not soluble in a chlorophyll
solvent. Referring to
FIG. 70A, the springs or coiled fibers 20520 can be retained in a compensation material 20580.
The compensation material 20580 can hold the coiled fibers 20586 in a loaded position
such that the coiled fibers 20586 exert a spring load on, or within, the compensation
material 20580. The compensation material 20580 can hold the coiled fibers 20586 in
a neutral position where the coiled fibers 20586 are not exerting a spring load on,
or within, the compensation material 20580. The compensation material 20580 can be
bioabsorbable and, in some cases, can comprise a foam, such as, for example, polyglycolic
acid (PGA) foam. Furthermore, the compensation material 20580 can be soluble in a
chlorophyll solvent, for example. The tissue thickness compensator can comprise coiled
fibers 20586 that comprise polycaprolactone (PCL) and compensation material 20580
that comprises polyglycolic acid (PGA) foam, for example, such that the coiled fibers
20520 are not soluble in a chlorophyll solvent while the compensation material 20580
is soluble in the chlorophyll solvent. The compensation material 20580 can be at least
partially elastic, such that compression of the compensation material 20580 generates
a restoring force. Further, referring to
FIG. 70B, the compensation material 20580 of the tissue thickness compensator 20520 can comprise
a therapeutic agent 20588, such as stem cells, for example. The compensation material
20580 can release a therapeutically effective amount of the therapeutic agent 20588
as the compensation material 20580 is absorbed.
[0384] Similar to the tissue thickness compensator 20020 described herein, the tissue thickness
compensator 20520 can be compressible. For example, as staples 20030
(FIGS. 78-81) are deployed from an initial position to a fired position, the staples 20030 can
engage a portion of tissue thickness compensator 20520. According to the invention,
a staple 20030 can capture a portion of the tissue thickness compensator 20520 and
adjacent tissue T. The staple 20030 can apply a compressive force to the captured
portion of the tissue thickness compensator 20520 and tissue T such that the tissue
thickness compensator 20520 is compressed from a non-compressed height to a compressed
height. Compression of the tissue thickness compensator 20520 can result in a corresponding
deformation of the coiled fibers 20586 therein. As described in greater detail herein,
deformation of each coiled fiber 20586 can generate a restoring force that can depend
on the resiliency of the coiled fiber, for example, the amount the coiled fiber 20586
is deformed and / or the spring rate of the coiled fiber 20586. The spring rate of
the coiled fiber 20586 can at least depend on the orientation, material, shape and
/ or size of the coiled fiber 20586, for example. Deformation of the coiled fibers
20586 in the tissue thickness compensator 20520 can generate restoring forces throughout
the tissue thickness compensator 20520. The tissue thickness compensator 20520 can
exert the aggregate restoring force generated by the deformed coiled fibers 20586
and / or the resilient compensation material 20586 on the captured tissue T in the
fired staples 20030.
[0385] Primarily referring to
FIGS. 71 and
72, a tissue thickness compensator 20620 for an end effector 12 can comprise a plurality
of spring coils 20686. Similar to the crimped fibers 20086 and coiled fibers 20586
described herein, spring coils 20686 can be, for example, crimped, twisted, coiled,
bent, crippled, spiraled, curled, and / or bowed within the tissue thickness compensator
20620. Optionally, similar to the fibers and coils described herein, the spring coils
20686 can comprise a polymeric composition. Further, the spring coils 20686 can be
at least partially elastic such that deformation of the spring coils 20686 generates
a restoring force. The spring coils 20686 can comprise a first end 20687, a second
end 20689, and a longitudinal axis therebetween. Referring to
FIG. 71, the first end 20686 of a spring coil 20686 can be positioned at or near a proximal
end 20626 of the tissue thickness compensator and the second end 20689 of the same
spring coil 20686 can be positioned at or near a distal end 20625 of the tissue thickness
compensator 20620 such that the spring coil 20686 longitudinally traverses the tissue
thickness compensator 20620, for example. Alternatively, the coiled fibers 20686 can
laterally or diagonally traverse the tissue thickness compensator 20620.
[0386] The tissue thickness compensator 20620 can comprise an outer film 20680 that at least
partially surrounds at least one spring coil 20686. Referring to
FIG. 71, the outer film 20680 can extend around the perimeter of multiple spring coils 20686
in the tissue thickness compensator 20620. Alternatively, the outer film 20680 can
completely encapsulate the spring coils 20686 or at least one spring coil 20686 in
the tissue thickness compensator 20620. The outer film 20680 can retain the spring
coils 20686 in the end effector 12. The outer film 20680 can hold the spring coils
20686 in a loaded position such that the spring coils 20686 generate a spring load
and exert a springback force on the outer film 20680. Alternatively, the outer film
20680 can hold the spring coils 20686 in a neutral position. The tissue thickness
compensator 20620 can also comprise a filling material 20624. The filling material
20624 can be retained within and / or around the spring coils 20686 by the outer film
20680. The filling material 20624 can comprise a therapeutic agent 20688, similar
to the therapeutic agents described herein. Further, the filling material 20624 can
support the spring coils 20686 within the tissue thickness compensator 20620. The
filling material 20624 can be compressible and at least partially resilient, such
that the filling material 20624 contributes to the springback or restoring force generated
by the tissue thickness compensator 20620, as described in greater detail herein.
[0387] Similar to the tissue thickness compensators described herein, the tissue thickness
compensator 20620 can be compressible. As staples 20030
(FIGS. 78-81) are deployed from an initial position to a fired position, the staples 20030 can
engage a portion of the tissue thickness compensator 20620. Optionally, each staple
20030 can capture a portion of the tissue thickness compensator 20620 along with adjacent
tissue T. The staple 20030 can apply a compressive force to the captured portion of
the tissue thickness compensator 20620 and the captured tissue T such that the tissue
thickness compensator 20620 is compressed between a non-compressed height and a compressed
height. Compression of the tissue thickness compensator 20620 can result in a corresponding
deformation of the spring coils 20686 retained therein
(FIG. 72). As described in greater detail herein, deformation of each spring coils 20686 can
generate a restoring force that depends on the resiliency of the spring coil 20686,
for example, the amount the spring coil 20686 is deformed and / or the spring rate
of the spring coil 20686. The spring rate of a spring coil 20686 can at least depend
on the material, shape and / or dimensions of the spring coil 20686, for example.
Furthermore, depending on the resiliency of the filling material 20624 and the outer
film 20680, compression of the filling material 20624 and / or the outer film 20680
can also generate restoring forces. The aggregate of restoring forces generated at
least by the deformed spring coils 20686, the filling material 20624 and / or the
outer film 20680 in the tissue thickness compensator 20620 can generate restoring
forces throughout the tissue thickness compensator 20620. The tissue thickness compensator
20620 can exert the aggregate restoring force generated by the deformed spring coils
20686 on the captured tissue T in a fired staple 20030.
[0388] Optionally, primarily referring to
FIGS. 73-75, a tissue thickness compensator 20720 for an end effector 12 can comprise a plurality
of spring coils 20786. Similar to the coiled fibers and springs described herein,
spring coils 20786 can be, for example, crimped, twisted, coiled, bent, crippled,
spiraled, curled, and / or bowed within the tissue thickness compensator 20720. The
spring coils 20786 can be at least partially elastic such that deformation of the
spring coils 20786 generates a restoring force. Further, the spring coils 20786 can
comprise a first end 20787, a second end 20789, and a longitudinal axis therebetween.
Referring primarily to
FIG. 75, the first end 20787 of the spring coil 20786 can be positioned at or near a proximal
end 20726 of the tissue thickness compensator 20720 and the second end 20789 of the
spring coil 20786 can be positioned at or near a distal end 20725 of the tissue thickness
compensator 20720 such that the spring coil 20786 longitudinally traverses the tissue
thickness compensator 20720. The spring coil 20786 can longitudinally extend in two
parallel rows in the tissue thickness compensator 20720. The tissue thickness compensator
20720 can be positioned in an end effector 12 such that a sled 20050
(FIG. 61) or cutting element 20052 can translate along a slot 20015 between the parallel rows
of spring coils 20786. Alternatively, the spring coils 20786 can laterally or diagonally
traverse the tissue thickness compensator 20720.
[0389] Referring again to
FIG. 75, the spring coils 20786 can be retained or embedded in a compensation material 20780.
The compensation material 20780 can be bioabsorbable and, in some cases, can comprise
foam, such as, for example, polyglycolic acid (PGA) foam. The compensation material
20780 can be resilient such that deformation of the compensation material 20780 generates
a springback force. The compensation material 20780 can be soluble in a chlorophyll
solvent, for example. For example, the tissue thickness compensator can comprise spring
coils 20786 that comprise polycaprolactone (PCL) and compensation material 20780 that
comprises polyglycolic acid (PGA) foam such that the spring coils 20786 are not soluble
in a chlorophyll solvent while the compensation material 20780 is soluble in a chlorophyll
solvent, for example. The compensation material 20780 can be at least partially resilient
such that deformation of the compensation material 20780 generates a spring load or
restoring force.
[0390] The tissue thickness compensator 20720 can comprise interwoven threads 20790, which
can extend between parallel rows of spring coils 20786. For example, referring to
FIG. 75, a first interwoven thread 20790 can diagonally traverse the two parallel rows of
spring coils 20786 and a second interwoven thread 20790 can also diagonally traverse
the two parallel rows of spring coils 20786. The first and second interwoven threads
20790 can crisscross. The interwoven threads 20790 can crisscross multiple times along
the length of the tissue thickness compensator 20720. The interwoven threads 20790
can hold the spring coils 20786 in a loaded configuration such that the spring coils
20786 are held in a substantially flat position in the tissue thickness compensator
20720. The interwoven threads 20790 that traverse the tissue thickness compensator
20720 can be directly attached to the spring coils 20786. Alternatively, the interwoven
threads 20790 can be coupled to the spring coils 20786 via a support 20792 that extends
through each spring coil 20786 along the longitudinal axis thereof.
[0391] As described in greater detail herein, a staple cartridge 20000 can comprise a slot
20015 configured to receive a translating sled 20050 comprising a cutting element
20052
(FIG. 61). As the sled 20050 translates along the slot 20015, the sled 20050 can eject staples
20030 from fastener cavities 20012 in the staple cartridge 20000 and the cutting element
20052 can simultaneously or nearly simultaneously sever tissue T. Referring again
to
FIG. 75, as the cutting element 20052 translates, it can also sever the interwoven threads
20790 that crisscross between the parallel rows of spring coils 20786 in the tissue
thickness compensator 20720. As the interwoven threads 20790 are severed, each spring
coil 20786 can be released from its loaded configuration such that each spring coil
20786 reverts from the loaded, substantially flat position to an expanded position
in the tissue thickness compensator 20720. Optionally, when a spring coil 20786 is
expanded, the compensation material 20780 surrounding the spring coil 20786 can also
expand.
[0392] Optionally, as staples 20030
(FIGS. 78-81) are deployed from an initial position to a fired position, the staples 20030 can
engage a portion of the tissue thickness compensator 20720 and the tissue thickness
compensator 20720 can expand, or attempt to expand, within the staples 20030 and can
apply a compressive force to the tissue T. Optionally, at least one staple 20030 can
capture a portion of the tissue thickness compensator 20720, along with adjacent tissue
T. The staple 20030 can apply a compressive force to the captured portion of the tissue
thickness compensator 20720 and the captured tissue T, such that the tissue thickness
compensator 20720 is compressed between a non-compressed height and a compressed height.
Compression of the tissue thickness compensator 20720 can result in a corresponding
deformation of the spring coils 20786 and compensation material 20780 retained therein.
As described in greater detail herein, deformation of each spring coils 20786 can
generate a restoring force that can depend on the resiliency of the spring coil, for
example, the amount the spring coil 20786 is deformed and / or the spring rate of
the spring coil 20786. The spring rate of a spring coil 20786 can at least depend
on the orientation, material, shape and / or size of the spring coil 20786, for example.
The aggregate of restoring forces generated by at least the deformed spring coils
20786 and / or the compensation material 30380 in the tissue thickness compensator
20720 can generate restoring forces throughout the tissue thickness compensator 20720.
The tissue thickness compensator 20720 can exert the aggregate restoring force generated
by the deformed spring coils 20786 in the tissue thickness compensator 20720 on the
captured tissue T and fired staples 20030.
[0393] Optionally, primarily referring to
FIGS. 76 and 77, a tissue thickness compensator 20820 for a surgical end effector 12 can comprise
a spring coil 20886. Similar to the fibers and coils described herein, spring coil
20886 can be, for example, crimped, twisted, coiled, bent, crippled, spiraled, curled,
and / or bowed within the tissue thickness compensator 20820. The spring coil 20886
can comprise a polymeric composition and can be at least partially elastic, such that
deformation of the spring coil 20886 generates a springback force. Further, the spring
coil 20886 can comprise a first end 20887 and a second end 20889. Referring to
FIG. 76, the first end 20887 can be positioned at or near a proximal end 20826 of the tissue
thickness compensator 20820 and the second end 20889 can be positioned at or near
a distal end 20825 of the tissue thickness compensator 20820. The spring coil 20886
can wind or meander from the proximal end 20825 to the distal end 20826 of the tissue
thickness compensator 20820.
[0394] Referring again to
FIG. 76, the spring coil 20886 can be retained or embedded in a compensation material 20880.
The compensation material 20880 can be bioabsorbable and, in some cases, can comprise
a foam, such as, for example, polyglycolic acid (PGA) foam. The compensation material
20880 can be soluble in a chlorophyll solvent, for example. The tissue thickness compensator
can comprise spring coils 20886 comprising polycaprolactone (PCL) and compensation
material 20880 comprising polyglycolic acid (PGA) foam, for example, such that the
spring coil 20886 is not soluble in a chlorophyll solvent while the compensation material
20880 is soluble in a chlorophyll solvent. The compensation material 20880 can be
at least partially resilient such that deformation of the compensation material 20880
generates a spring load or restoring force.
[0395] Similar to tissue thickness compensators described herein, for example, the tissue
thickness compensator 20820 can be compressible. Compression of the tissue thickness
compensator 20820 can result in a deformation of at least a portion of the spring
coil 20886 retained or embedded in the compensation material 20880 of the tissue thickness
compensator 20820. As described in greater detail herein, deformation of the spring
coil 20886 can generate restoring forces that can depend on the resiliency of the
spring coil 20886, the amount the spring coil 20886 is deformed, and / or the spring
rate of the spring coil 20886, for example. The aggregate of restoring forces generated
by the deformed spring coil 20886 and / or deformed compensation material 20880 can
generate restoring forces throughout the tissue thickness compensator 20820. The tissue
thickness compensator 20820 can exert the aggregate restoring force on the captured
tissue T in the fired staples 20030.
[0396] Referring now to
FIG. 84, a surgical end effector 12 can comprise a tissue thickness compensator 30020 having
at least one tubular element 30080. The tissue thickness compensator 30020 can be
retained in the surgical end effector 12. As described in greater detail herein, a
fastener in the end effector 12 can be deployed such that the fastener moves to a
fired position and deforms at least a portion of the tubular element 30080 in the
tissue thickness compensator 30020. The reader will appreciate that tissue thickness
compensators comprising at least one tubular element as described herein can be installed
in or otherwise engaged with a variety of surgical end effectors and that These are
within the scope of the present disclosure.
[0397] Optionally, still referring to
FIG. 84, the tissue thickness compensator 30020 can be positioned relative to the anvil 30060
of the end effector 12. Alternatively, the tissue thickness compensator 30020 can
be positioned relative to a fastener cartridge assembly, such as staple cartridge
30000, of the end effector 12. The staple cartridge 30000 can be configured to fit
in a cartridge channel 30072 of a jaw 30070 of the end effector 12. For example, the
tissue thickness compensator 30020 can be releasably secured to the staple cartridge
30000. The tubular element 30080 of the tissue thickness compensator 30020 can be
positioned adjacent to a top deck surface 30011 of a rigid support portion 30010 of
the staple cartridge 30000. The tubular element 30080 can be secured to the top deck
surface 30011 by an adhesive or by a wrap, similar to at least one of the wraps described
herein (e.g.,
FIG. 16). The tissue thickness compensator 30020 can be integral to an assembly comprises the
staple cartridge 30000 such that the staple cartridge 30000 and the tissue thickness
compensator 30020 are formed as a single unit construction. For example, the staple
cartridge 30000 can comprise a first body portion, such as the rigid support portion
30010, and a second body portion, such as the tissue thickness compensator 30020,
for example.
[0398] Referring to
FIGS. 84-86, the tubular element 30080 in the tissue thickness compensator 30020 can comprise
an elongate portion 30082 having at least one lumen 30084 that extends at least partially
therethrough. Referring primarily to
FIG. 86, the elongate portion 30082 of the tubular element 30080 can comprise woven or braided
strands 30090, as described in greater detail herein. Alternatively, the elongate
portion 30082 can comprise a solid structure, such as a polymer extrusion, rather
than woven strands 30090. The elongate portion 30082 of the tubular element 30080
can comprise a thickness. The thickness of the elongate portion 30082 can be substantially
uniform throughout the length and around the diameter thereof; in other cases, the
thickness can vary. The elongate portion 30082 can be elongated such that the length
of the elongate portion 30082 is greater than the diameter of the elongate portion
30082, for example. The elongate portion can comprise a length of approximately 1.20
inches to approximately 2.60 inches and a diameter of approximately 0.10 inches to
approximately 0.15 inches, for example. The length of the tubular element 20080 can
be approximately 1.40 inches, for example, and the diameter of the tubular element
20080 can be approximately 0.125 inches, for example. Furthermore, the elongate portion
30082 can define a substantially circular or elliptical cross-sectional shape, for
example. Alternatively, the cross-sectional shape can comprise a polygonal shape,
such as, for example, a triangle, a hexagon and / or an octagon. Referring again to
FIG. 84, the tubular element 30080 can comprise a first distal end 30083 and a second proximal
end 30085. The cross-sectional shape of the elongate portion 30082 can narrow at the
first and / or second end 30083, 30085 wherein at least one end 30083, 30085 of the
tubular element 30080 can be closed and / or sealed. Alternatively, a lumen 30084
can continue through the distal ends 30083, 30085 of the tubular element 30080 such
that the ends 30083, 30085 are open.
[0399] The tubular element 30080 can comprise a single central lumen 30084 that extends
at least partially through the elongate portion 30084. The lumen 30084 can extend
through the entire length of the elongate portion 30084. As an additional alternative,
the tubular element 30080 can comprise multiple lumens 30084 extending therethrough.
Lumens 30084 extending through the tubular element 30080 can be circular, semi-circular,
wedge-shaped, and / or combinations thereof. According to the invention, a tubular
element 30080 can also comprise support webs that can form a modified "T" or "X" shape,
for example, within the lumen 30084. The dimensions, lumen(s), and / or support web(s)
within the tubular element 30080 can define the cross-sectional shape of the tubular
element 30080. The cross-sectional shape of the tubular element 30080 can be consistent
throughout the length thereof or, alternatively, the cross-sectional shape of the
tubular element 30080 can vary along the length thereof As described in greater detail
herein, the cross-sectional shape of the tubular element 30080 can affect the compressibility
and resiliency of the tubular element 30080.
[0400] The tubular element 30080 can comprise a vertical diameter and a horizontal diameter;
the dimensions thereof can be selected depending on the arrangement of the tubular
element 30080 in the end effector 12, the dimensions of the end effector 12, including
the tissue gap of the end effector 12, and the expected geometry of the staple entrapment
areas 30039. For example, the vertical diameter of the tubular element 30080 can relate
to the expected height of a formed staple. In such cases, the vertical diameter of
the tubular element 30080 can be selected such that the vertical diameter can be reduced
approximately 5% to approximately 20% when the tubular element 30080 is captured within
a formed staple 30030. For example, a tubular element 30080 having a vertical diameter
of approximately 0.100 inches may be used for staples having an expected formed height
of approximately 0.080 inches to approximately 0.095 inches. As a result, the vertical
diameter of the tubular element 30080 can be reduced approximately 5% to approximately
20% when captured within the formed staple 30030 even when no tissue T is captured
therein. When tissue T is captured within the formed staple 30030, the compression
of the tubular element 30080 may be even greater. The vertical diameter can be uniform
throughout the length of the tubular element 30080 or, alternatively, the vertical
diameter can vary along the length thereof.
[0401] The horizontal diameter of the tubular element 30080 can be greater than, equal to,
or less than the vertical diameter of the tubular element 30080 when the tubular element
30080 is in an undeformed or rebounded configuration. For example, referring to
FIG. 85, the horizontal diameter can be approximately three times larger than the vertical
diameter, for example. The horizontal diameter can be approximately 0.400 inches and
the vertical diameter can be approximately 0.125 inches, for example. Alternatively,
referring now to
FIG. 87, the horizontal diameter of a tubular element 31080 can be equal to or substantially
equal to the vertical diameter of the tubular element 31080 when the tubular element
31080 is in an undeformed or rebounded configuration. The horizontal diameter can
be approximately 0.125 inches and the vertical diameter can also be approximately
0.125 inches, for example. The tubular element 30080 can comprise a vertical diameter
of approximately 0.125 inches, a horizontal diameter of approximately 0.400 inches,
and a length of approximately 1.400 inches. As described in greater detail herein,
when a force A is applied to the tubular element 30080 and / or 31080, the tubular
element can deform such that the cross-sectional geometry, including the horizontal
and vertical diameters, can change.
[0402] Referring again to
FIGS. 84-86, the tubular element 30080 in the tissue thickness compensator 30020 can be deformable.
The entire tubular element 30080 can be deformable. For example, the tubular element
30080 can be deformable from the proximal end 30083 to the distal end 30085 of the
elongate portion 30082 and around the entire circumference thereof. Alternatively,
only a portion of the tubular element 30080 can be deformable. For example, only an
intermediate length of the elongate portion 30082 and / or only a portion of the circumference
of the tubular element 30080 can be deformable.
[0403] When a compressive force is applied to a contact point on the elongate portion 30082
of the tubular element 30080, the contact point can shift, which can alter the cross-sectional
dimensions of the tubular element 30080. For example, referring again to
FIG. 85, the tubular element 30080 can comprise a top apex 30086 and a bottom apex 30088 on
the elongate portion 30082. In the initial, undeformed configuration, the tubular
element 30080 can comprise undeformed cross-sectional dimensions, including an undeformed
vertical diameter between the top apex 30086 and the bottom apex 30088. When a compressive
force A is applied to the top apex 30086, the tubular element 30080 can move to a
deformed configuration. In the deformed configuration, the cross-sectional dimensions
of the tube 30080 can be altered. For example, the tube 30086 can comprise a deformed
vertical diameter between the top apex 30086 and the bottom apex 30088, which can
be less than the undeformed vertical diameter. Referring to
FIG. 87, the horizontal diameter of the deformed tube 30080 can be lengthened, for example,
when the tubular element 30080 moves from an undeformed configuration to a deformed
configuration. The deformed cross-sectional dimensions of the deformed tube 30080
can at least depend on the position, angular orientation, and / or magnitude of the
applied force A. As described in greater detail herein, deformation of a tubular element
30080 can generate a springback or restoring force that can depend on the resiliency
of the tubular element 30080.
[0404] Referring still to
FIG. 85, the tubular element 30080 can generate a springback or restoring force when compressed.
In such cases, as described herein, the tubular element 30080 can move from an initial
undeformed configuration to a deformed configuration when a force A is applied to
a contact point on the elongate portion 30082 of the tubular element 30080. When the
applied force A is removed, the deformed tube 30080 can rebound from the deformed
configuration. The deformed tube 30080 may rebound to the initial, undeformed configuration
or may rebound to a configuration substantially similar to the initial, undeformed
configuration. The ability of the tubular element 30080 to rebound from a deformed
configuration relates to the resiliency of the tubular element 30080.
[0405] Referring again to
FIG. 85, a tubular element 30080 can exert a springback or restoring force. The restoring
force can be generated by the tubular element 30080 when an applied force A is exerted
on the tubular element 30080, for example, by a staple 30030
(FIGS. 88 and 89), as described in greater detail herein. An applied force A can alter the cross-sectional
dimensions of the tubular element 30080. Furthermore, in linear-elastic materials,
the restoring force of each deformed portion of the tubular element 30080 can be a
function of the deformed dimensions of the tubular element 30080 and the spring rate
of that portion of the tubular element 30080. The spring rate of a tubular element
30080 can at least depend on the orientation, material, cross-sectional geometry and
/ or dimensions of the tubular element 30080, for example. The tubular element 30080
in a tissue thickness compensator 30020 can comprise a uniform spring rate. Alternatively,
the spring rate can vary along the length and / or around the diameter of the tubular
element 30080. When a portion of a tubular element 30080 having a first spring rate
is greatly compressed, the tubular element 30080 can generate a large restoring force.
When a portion of the tubular element 30080 having the same first spring rate is less
compressed, the tubular element 30080 can generate a smaller restoring force.
[0406] Referring again to
FIG. 84, the tubular element 30080 in the tissue thickness compensator 30020 can comprise
a polymeric composition. The elongate portion 30082 of the tubular element 30080 can
comprise the polymeric composition. Further, the polymeric composition can comprise
an at least partially elastic material such that deformation of the tubular element
30080 generates a restoring force. The polymeric composition can comprise non-absorbable
polymers, absorbable polymers, or combinations thereof, for example. Examples of synthetic
polymers include, but are not limited to, polyglycolic acid (PGA), poly(lactic acid)
(PLA), polycaprolactone (PCL), polydioxanone (PDO), and copolymers thereof. The absorbable
polymers can include bioabsorbable, biocompatible elastomeric polymers, for example.
Furthermore, the polymeric composition of the tubular element 30080 can comprise synthetic
polymers, non-synthetic polymers, or combinations thereof, for example. Optionally,
similar to the polymeric compositions described elsewhere herein, the polymeric composition
of the tubular element 30080 can include varied amounts of absorbable polymers, non-absorbable
polymers, synthetic polymers, and / or non-synthetic polymers, for example, by weight
percentage.
[0407] Referring to
FIGS. 84 and
85, the tubular element 30080 can comprise a therapeutic agent 30098 such as a pharmaceutically
active agent or medicament, for example. The therapeutic agent 30098 can be retained
in the lumen 30084 of the tubular element 30080. The elongate portion 30082 can encapsulate
or partially encapsulate the therapeutic agent 30098. Additionally or alternatively,
the polymeric composition of the elongate portion 30082 can comprise the therapeutic
agent 30098. The tubular element 30080 can release a therapeutically effective amount
of the therapeutic agent 30098. The therapeutic agent 30098 can be released as the
tubular element 30080 is absorbed. For example, the therapeutic agent 30098 can be
released into fluid (such as blood) passing over or through the tubular element 30080.
As an additional alternative, the therapeutic agent 30098 can be released when a staple
30030
(FIG. 88 and
89) pierces the tubular element 30080 and/or when the cutting element 30052 on the staple-firing
sled 30050
(FIG. 84) cuts a portion of the tubular element 30080, for example. Examples of therapeutic
agents 30098 can include, but are not limited to, haemostatic agents and drugs such
as, for example, fibrin, thrombin, and / or oxidized regenerated cellulose (ORC),
anti-inflammatory drugs such as, for example, diclofenac, aspirin, naproxen, sulindac,
and / or hydrocortisone, antibiotic and antimicrobial drugs or agents such as, for
example, triclosan, ionic silver, ampicillin, gentamicin, polymyxin B, and / or chloramphenicol,
anticancer agents such as, for example, cisplatin, mitomycin, and / or adriamycin,
and / or biologics such as, for example, stem cells.
[0408] Referring again to
FIGS. 84, 88 and
89, fasteners such as staples 30030, for example, can be deployed from a staple cartridge
30000 such that the staples 30030 engage a tissue thickness compensator 30020 and
apply a force A to a tubular element 32080 therein. As described herein, application
of a force A to the tubular element 30080 can cause deformation of the tubular element
30080. Similar to the end effectors 12 described herein, the rigid support portion
30010 of the staple cartridge 30000 can comprise a cartridge body 30017, a deck surface
30011, and a plurality of staple cavities 30012 therein. Each staple cavity 30012
can define an opening in the deck surface 30011 and a staple 30030 can be removably
positioned in a staple cavity 30012
(FIG. 104). Referring primarily to
FIGS. 88 and
89, each staple 30030 can comprise a base 30031 and two staple legs 30032 extending from
the base 30031. Prior to the deployment of the staples 30030, the base 30031 of each
staple 30030 can be supported by a staple driver 30040
(FIG. 104) positioned within the rigid support portion 30010 of the staple cartridge 30000.
Also prior to the deployment of the staples 30030, the legs 30032 of each staple 30030
can be at least partially contained within the staple cavity 30012
(FIG. 104).
[0409] Optionally, as described in greater detail herein, the staples 30030 can be deployed
between an initial position and a fired position. For example, a staple-firing sled
30050 can engage a driver 30040
(FIG. 104). to move at least one staple 30030 between the initial position and the fired position.
Referring primarily to
FIG. 88, the staple 30030 can be moved to a fired position, wherein the legs 30032 of the
staple 30030 engage a tubular element 32080 of a tissue thickness compensator 32020,
penetrate tissue T, and contact an anvil 30060
(FIG. 104) positioned opposite the staple cartridge 30000 in the surgical end effector 12. Staple
forming pockets 30062 in the anvil 30060 can bend the staple legs 30032 such that
the fired staple 30030 captures a portion of the tubular element 32080 and a portion
of the tissue T in a staple entrapment area 30039. As described in greater detail
herein, at least one staple leg 30032 can pierce the tubular element 32080 of the
tissue thickness compensator 32020 when the staple 30030 moves between the initial
position and the fired position. Alternatively, the staple legs 30032 can move around
the perimeter of the tubular element 32080 such that the staple legs 30032 avoid piercing
the tubular element 32080. Similar to the fasteners described herein, the legs 30032
of each staple 30030 can be deformed downwardly toward the base 30031 of the staple
30030 to form a staple entrapment area 30039 therebetween. The staple entrapment area
30039 can be the area in which tissue T and a portion of the tissue thickness compensator
32020 can be captured by a fired staple 30030. In the fired position, each staple
30030 can apply a compressive force to the tissue T and to the tissue thickness compensator
32020 captured within the staple entrapment area 30039 of the staple 30030.
[0410] Referring still to
FIG. 88, when the tubular element 32080 is captured in a staple entrapment area 30039, the
captured portion of the tubular element 32080 can be deformed, as described herein.
Furthermore, the tubular element 32080 can be deformed to different deformed configurations
in different staple entrapment areas 30039 depending on, for example, the thickness,
compressibility, and / or density of the tissue T captured in that same staple entrapment
area 30039. The tubular element 32080 in the tissue thickness compensator 32080 can
extend longitudinally through successive staple entrapment areas 30039. In such an
arrangement, the tubular element 32080 can be deformed to different deformed configurations
in each staple entrapment area 30039 along a row of fired staples 30030. Referring
now to
FIG. 89, tubular elements 33080 in a tissue thickness compensator 33020 can be laterally arranged
in the staple entrapment areas 30039 along a row of fired staples 30030. The tubular
elements 33080 can be retained by a flexible shell 33210. In such arrangements, the
tubular elements 33080 and flexible shell 33210 can be deformed to different deformed
configurations in each staple entrapment area 30039. For example, where the tissue
T is thinner, the tubular elements 33080 can be compressed less and where the tissue
T is thicker, the tubular elements 33080 can be compressed more to accommodate the
thicker tissue T. Alternatively, the deformed dimensions of the tubular elements 33080
can be uniform throughout the entire length and / or width of the tissue thickness
compensator 33020.
[0411] Referring to
FIGS. 90-92a tubular element 34080 in a tissue thickness compensator 34020 can comprise a plurality
of strands 34090. Referring primarily to
FIG. 90, the strands 34090 can be woven or braided into a tubular lattice 34092 forming the
tubular element 34080. The tubular lattice 34092 formed by the strands 34090 can be
substantially hollow. The strands 34090 of the tubular element 34080 can be solid
strands, tubular strands, and / or another other suitable shape. For example, referring
to
FIG. 91, a single strand 34090 of the tubular lattice 34092 can be a tube. Referring to
FIG. 93, a strand 34090 can comprise at least one lumen 34094 extending therethrough. The
number, geometry and / or dimensions(s) of the lumens 34094 can determine the cross-sectional
shape of the strand 34090. For example, a strand 34090 can comprise circular lumen(s),
semi-circular lumen(s), wedge-shaped lumen(s), and / or combinations thereof. According
to the invention, a strand 34090 can also comprise support webs 34096 that can form
a modified "T" or "X" shape, for example. At least the diameter of the strand 34090,
the lumen(s) extending therethrough, and the support web(s) can characterize the cross-sectional
shape of a strand 34090. The cross-sectional shape of each strand 34090, as discussed
in greater detail herein, can affect the springback or restoring force generated by
the strand 34090 and the corresponding springback or restoring force generated by
the tubular element 34080.
[0412] Referring to
FIG. 94, a tubular lattice 34092 of strands 34090 can be deformable. The tubular lattice 34092
can produce or contribute to the deformability and / or the resiliency of the tubular
element 34080. For example, the strands 34090 of the tubular lattice 34092 can be
woven together such that the strands 34090 are configured to slide and / or bend relative
to each other. When a force is applied to the elongate portion 34082 of the tubular
element 34080, the strands 34090 therein may slide and / or bend such that the tubular
lattice 34092 moves to a deformed configuration. For example, referring still to
FIG. 94, a staple 30030 can compress the tubular lattice 34092 and the tissue T captured in
a staple entrapment area 34039 which can cause the strands 34090 of the tubular lattice
34092 to slide and / or bend relative to each other. A top apex 34086 of the tubular
lattice 34092 can move towards a bottom apex 34088 of the tubular lattice 34092 when
the tubular lattice 34092 is compressed to the deformed configuration in order to
accommodate the captured tissue T in a staple entrapment area 30039. In various circumstances,
the tubular lattice 34092 captured in a fired stapled 30030 will seek to regain its
undeformed configuration and can apply a restoring force to the captured tissue T.
Further, the portions of the tubular lattice 34092 positioned between staple entrapment
areas 30039, i.e., not captured within a fired staple 30030, can also be deformed
due to the deformation of adjacent portions of the tubular lattice 34092 that are
within the staple entrapment areas 30039. Where the tubular lattice 34092 is deformed,
the tubular lattice 34092 can seek to rebound or partially rebound from the deformed
configuration. Optionally, portions of the tubular lattice 34092 can rebound to their
initial configurations and other portions of the tubular lattice 34092 can only partially
rebound and / or remain fully compressed.
[0413] Similar to the description of the tubular elements herein, each strand 34090 can
also be deformable. Further, deformation of a strand 34090 can generate a restoring
force that depends on the resiliency of each strand 34090. Referring primarily to
FIGS. 91 and
92, each strand 34090 of a tubular lattice 34092 can be tubular. Alternatively, each
strand 34090 of a tubular lattice 34092 can be solid. As an additional alternative,
the tubular lattice 30092 can comprise at least one tubular strand 34090, at least
one solid strand 34090, at least one "X"- or "T"-shaped strand 34090, and / or a combination
thereof.
[0414] The strands 34090 in the tubular element 34080 can comprise a polymeric composition.
The polymeric composition of a strand 34090 can comprise non-absorbable polymers,
absorbable polymers, or combinations thereof. Examples of synthetic polymers include,
but are not limited to, polyglycolic acid (PGA), poly(lactic acid) (PLA), polycaprolactone
(PCL), polydioxanone (PDO), and copolymers thereof. The absorbable polymers can include
bioabsorbable, biocompatible elastomeric polymers, for example. Furthermore, the polymeric
composition of the strand 34090 can comprise synthetic polymers, non-synthetic polymers,
and / or combinations thereof. Optionally, similar to the polymeric compositions described
elsewhere herein, the polymeric composition of the strand 34090 can include varied
amounts of absorbable polymers, non-absorbable polymers, synthetic polymers, and /
or non-synthetic polymers, for example, by weight percentage.
[0415] The strands 34090 in the tubular element 34080 can further comprise a therapeutic
agent 34098
(FIG. 91) such as a pharmaceutically active agent or medicament, for example. The strand 34090
can release a therapeutically effective amount of the therapeutic agent 34098. The
therapeutic agent 34098 can be released as the tubular strand 34090 is absorbed. For
example, the therapeutic agent 30098 can be released into fluid, such as blood for
example, passing over or through the strand 34090. As an additional alternative, the
therapeutic agent 34098 can be released when a staple 30030 pierces the strand 34090
and/or when the cutting element 30052 on the staple-firing sled 30050
(FIG. 84) cuts a portion of the tubular lattice 34092, for example. Examples of therapeutic
agents 34098 can include, but are not limited to, haemostatic agents and drugs such
as, for example, fibrin, thrombin, and / or oxidized regenerated cellulose (ORC),
anti-inflammatory drugs such as, for example, diclofenac, aspirin, naproxen, sulindac,
and / or hydrocortisone, antibiotic and antimicrobial drugs or agents such as, for
example, triclosan, ionic silver, ampicillin, gentamicin, polymyxin B, and / or chloramphenicol,
anticancer agents such as, for example, cisplatin, mitomycin, and / or adriamycin;
and / or biologics such as, for example, stem cells.
[0416] Referring to
FIGS. 95 and
96, a tubular element 35080 can comprise multiple layers 35100 of strands 35090. The
tubular element 35080 can comprise multiple layers 35100 of tubular lattices 35092.
Referring to
FIG. 95, the tubular element 35080 can comprise a first layer 35100a and a second layer 35100b
of strands 35090, for example. Referring now to
FIG. 96, a tubular element 35180 of a tissue thickness compensator 35120 can comprise a third
layer 35100c of strands 35090, for example. Furthermore, different layers 35100 in
the tubular element 35180 can comprise different materials. Each layer 35100a, 35100b,
35100c can be bioabsorbable, wherein, each layer 35100a, 35100b, 35100c can comprise
a different polymeric composition. For example, the first layer 35100a can comprise
a first polymeric composition; the second layer 35100b can comprise a second polymeric
composition; and the third layer 35100c can comprise a third polymeric composition.
In such cases, layers 35100a, 35100b, 35100c of the tubular element 35180 can be bioabsorbed
at different rates. For example, the first layer 35100a can absorb quickly, the second
layer 35100b can absorb slower than the first layer 35100a, and the third layer 35100c
can absorb slower than the first layer 35100a and / or the second layer 35100b. Alternatively,
the first layer 35100a can absorb slowly, the second layer 35100b can absorb faster
than the first layer 35100a, and the third layer 35100c can absorb faster than the
first layer 35100a and / or the second layer 35100b.
[0417] Similar to strands 34090 described herein, the strands 35090 in the tubular element
35180 can comprise a medicament 35098. Referring again to
FIG. 95, to control elusion or release of the medicament(s) 35098, the first layer 35100a
of strands 35090 comprising a medicament 35098a can be bioabsorbed at a first rate
and the second layer 35100b of strands 35090 comprising a medicament 30098b can be
bioabsorbed at a second rate. For example, the first layer 35100a can absorb quickly
to allow for a rapid initial release of the medicament 35098a and the second layer
35100b can absorb slower to allow controlled release of the medicament 30098b. The
medicament 35098a in the strands 35090 of the first layer 30100a can be different
than the medicament 35098b in the strands 35090 of the second layer 35100b. For example,
the strands 35090 in the first layer 35100a can comprise oxidized regenerated cellulose
(ORC) and the strands 35090 in the second layer 35100b can comprise a solution comprising
hyaluronic acid. In such cases, initial absorption of the first layer 35100a can release
oxidized regenerated cellulose to help control bleeding while subsequent absorption
of the second layer 35100b can release a solution comprising hyaluronic acid to can
help prevent the adhesion of tissue. Alternatively, the layers 35100a, 35100b can
comprise the same medicament 35098a, 35098b. For example, referring again to
FIG. 96, strands 35090 in layers 35100a, 35100b and 35100c can comprise an anticancer agent,
such as, for example, cisplatin. Furthermore, the first layer 35100a can absorb quickly
to allow for a rapid initial release of cisplatin, the second layer 35100b can absorb
slower to allow for a controlled release of cisplatin, and the third layer 35100c
can absorb slowest to allow for a more extended, controlled release of cisplatin.
[0418] Referring to
FIGS. 97 and
98, a tissue thickness compensator 36020 can comprise an overmold material 36024. The
overmold material 36024 can be formed outside a tubular element 36080, inside a tubular
element 36080, or both inside and outside a tubular element 36080. Referring to
FIG. 97, the overmold material 36024 can be coextruded both inside and outside the tubular
element 36080 and, the tubular element 36080 can comprise a tubular lattice 36092
of strands 36090. Similar to the polymeric composition described herein, the overmold
material 36024 can comprise polyglycolic acid (PGA), poly(lactic acid) (PLA), and
/ or any other suitable, bioabsorbable and biocompatible elastomeric polymers, for
example. Further, the overmold material 36024 can be non-porous such that the overmold
material 36024 forms a fluid-impervious layer in the tubular element 36080. The overmold
material 36024 can define a lumen 36084 therethrough.
[0419] Further to the discussion above, the tubular element 36080 and / or the strands 36090
in a tubular lattice 36092 can comprise a therapeutic agent 36098. Referring still
to
FIGS. 97 and
98, a non-porous overmold material 36024 can contain the medicament 36098 within an inner
lumen 36084a. Alternatively or additionally, the non-porous, overmold material 36024
can contain the medicament 36098 within an intermediate lumen 36084b, such as, for
example, the intermediate lumen 36084b that contains the tubular lattice 36092 of
medicament-comprising strands 36090. Similar to the above, the tubular element 36080
can be positioned relative to staple cavities 30012 and a cutting element 30052 in
staple cartridge 30000
(FIG. 84). The deployment of the staples 30030 and / or the translation of the cutting element
30052 can be configured to pierce or rupture the non-porous, overmold material 36024
such that the medicament 36098 contained in at least one lumen 36084 of the tubular
element 30080 can be released from the lumen 30084. Referring to
FIG. 99, a tubular element 37080 can comprise a non-porous film 37110. The non-porous film
37110 can at least partially surround a tubular lattice 37092 or a first layer 37100a
and a second layer 37100b of tubular lattices 30092 to provide a fluid-impervious
cover similar to the overmold material 36024 described herein.
[0420] As described herein, a tubular element can comprise at least one of a bioabsorbable
material, a therapeutic agent, a plurality of strands, a tubular lattice, layers of
tubular lattices, an overmold material, a non-porous film, or combinations thereof.
For example, referring to
FIG. FIG. 100, a tubular element 38080 can comprise an overmold material 38024 and a plurality of
strands 38090 positioned through a central lumen 38084 of the tubular element 38080.
The strands 38090 can comprise a therapeutic agent 38098. Alternatively, for example,
referring to
FIG. 101, a tubular element 39080 can comprise an overmold material 39024 and a therapeutic
agent 39098 positioned in a central lumen 39084 of the tubular element 39080, for
example. Optionally, at least one of the tubular element 39080 and overmold material
39024 can comprise a fluidic therapeutic agent 39098.
[0421] Referring again primarily
FIG. 84, the tubular element 30080 can be positioned relative to the rigid support portion
30010 of the staple cartridge 30000. The tubular element 30080 can be longitudinally
positioned adjacent to the rigid support portion 30010. The tubular element 30080
can be substantially parallel to or aligned with a longitudinal slot or cavity 30015
in the rigid support portion 30010. The tubular element 30080 can be aligned with
the longitudinal slot 30015 such that a portion of the tubular element 30080 overlaps
a portion of the longitudinal slot 30015. In such cases, a cutting element 30052 on
the staple-firing sled 30050 can sever a portion of the tubular element 30080 as the
cutting edge 30052 translates along the longitudinal slot 30015. Alternatively, the
tubular element 30080 can be longitudinally positioned on a first or second side of
the longitudinal slot 30015. As an additional alternative, the tubular element 30080
can be positioned relative to the rigid support portion 30010 of the staple cartridge
30000 such that the tubular element 30080 laterally or diagonally traverses at least
a portion of the rigid support portion 30010.
[0422] Referring to
FIG. 102 for example, a tissue thickness compensator 40020 can comprise multiple tubular elements
40080. The tubular elements 40080 can comprise different lengths, cross-sectional
shapes, and / or materials, for example. Further, the tubular elements 40080 can be
positioned relative to the rigid support portion 40010 of the staple cartridge 30000
such that the tubular axes of the tubular elements 40080 are parallel to each other.
The tubular axes of tubular elements 40080 can be longitudinally aligned such that
a first tubular element 40080 is positioned within another tubular element 40080.
Alternatively, parallel tubular elements 40080 can longitudinally traverse the staple
cartridge 30000, for example. As an additional alternative, parallel tubular elements
40080 can laterally or diagonally traverse the staple cartridge 30000. Alternatively,
non-parallel tubular elements 40080 can be angularly-oriented relative to each other
such that their tubular axes intersect and / or are not parallel to each other.
[0423] Referring to
FIGS. 102-105, a tissue thickness compensator 40020 can have two tubular elements 40080; a first
tubular element 40080a can be longitudinally positioned on a first side of the longitudinal
slot 30015 in the rigid support portion 30010 and a second tubular element 40080b
can be longitudinally positioned on a second side of the longitudinal slot 30015.
Each tubular element 40080 can comprise a tubular lattice 40092 of strands 40090.
The staple cartridge 30000 can comprise a total of six rows of staple cavities 30012,
wherein three rows of staple cavities 30012 are positioned on each side of the longitudinal
slot 30015, for example. In such cases, the cutting edge 30052 on the translating
staple-firing sled 30050 may not be required to sever a portion of the tubular element
40080.
[0424] Similarly, referring now to
FIGS. 106-107, a tissue thickness compensator 41020 can comprise two tubular elements 41080a, 41080b
longitudinally arranged in the staple cartridge 30000. Similar to the above, staples
30030 from three rows of staple cavities 30012 can engage one tubular element 41080a
and staples 30030 from three different rows of staple cavities 30012 can engage another
tubular element 41080b. Referring still to
FIGS. 106-107, deployed staples 30030 can engage the tubular element 40080 at different locations
across the cross-section of the tubular element 40080. As discussed herein, the springback
resiliency and corresponding restoring force exerted by the tubular element 41080
can depend on the cross-sectional shape of the tubular element 41080, among other
things. A staple 30030 positioned in a staple entrapment area 30039 located at or
near an arced portion of the tubular element 41080 can experience a greater restoring
force than a staple 30030 in a staple entrapment area 30039 positioned near a non-arced
portion. Similarly, a staple 30030 positioned in staple entrapment area 30039 in the
non-arced portion of the tubular element 41080 can experience a lesser restoring force
than the restoring force experienced by a staple 30030 positioned at or nearer to
the arced portion of the tubular element 30080. In other words, the arced portions
of a tubular element 41080 can have a greater spring rate than the non-arced portion
of the tubular element 41080 owing to the possibility that a larger quantity of elastic
material may be captured by the staples 30030 along such portions. Optionally, as
a result, referring primarily to
FIG. 107, the restoring force generated by the tissue thickness compensator 41020 can be greater
near staples 30030a and 30030c and less near staple 30030b in tubular element 30080a.
Correspondingly, the restoring force generated by the tissue thickness compensator
41020 can be greater near staples 30030d and 30030f than near staple 30030e in tubular
element 30080b.
[0425] Referring again to
FIGS. 102-105, the cross-sectional geometries of strands 40090 comprising the tubular lattice 40092
can be selected in order to provide a desired springback resiliency and corresponding
restoring force exerted by the tubular lattice 40092. For example, referring again
to
FIG. 103, strands 40090a positioned in arced portions of the tubular element 40080 can comprise
X-shaped cross-sections, whereas strands 40090b positioned in non-arced portions of
the tubular element 40080 can comprise tubular cross-sections. Strands 40090a and
40090b comprising different cross-sectional geometries can be woven together to form
the tubular lattice 40092. Alternatively, the strands 40090a and 40090b can be attached
to one another with an adhesive, for example. Referring to
FIGS. 104 and
105, the different cross-sectional geometries of strands 40090 in the tubular element
40080 can optimize the restoring force experienced in staple entrapment areas 30039
across the staple cartridge 30000. Specific cross-sectional geometries can be selected
such that the springback constant in staple entrapment areas 30039 across the staple
cartridge is substantially balanced or equal.
[0426] Referring to
FIG. 108, the tubular elements 41080a, 41080b of a tissue thickness compensator 41120 can be
fastened together by an adjoining portion 41126. Though the translating cutting element
30052 can be configured to pass between tubular elements 41080a and 41080b, the cutting
element 30052 can be required to sever at least a portion of the adjoining portion
41126. The adjoining portion 41126 can comprise a soft material, such as, for example,
a foam or gel, which is easily severed by the translating cutting element 30052. The
adjoining portion 41026 can releasably secure the tissue thickness compensator 41120
to the surgical end effector 12. The adjoining portion 41126 can be fixed to the top
deck surface 30011 of the rigid support portion 30010 such that the adjoining portion
41126 remains retained in the surgical end effector 12 after the tubular elements
41080a, 41080b are released therefrom.
[0427] Referring to
FIGS. 109-110, a tissue thickness compensator 42020 can comprise multiple tubular elements 42080
such that the number of tubular elements 42080 is the same as the number of rows of
staple cavities 30012 in the staple cartridge 30000, for example. The staple cartridge
30000 can comprise six rows of staple cavities 30012 and the tissue thickness compensator
42020 can comprise six tubular elements 42080. Each tubular element 42080 can be substantially
aligned with a row of staple cavities 30012. When staples 30030 are ejected from a
row of staple cavities 30012, each staple 30030 from that row can pierce the same
tubular element 42080
(FIG. 110). The deformation of one tube 42080 can have little or no impact on the deformation
of an adjacent tube 42080. Accordingly, the tubular elements 42080 can exert a substantially
discrete and customized springback force in staple entrapment areas 30039 across the
width of the staple cartridge 30030. Where staples 30030 fired from multiple rows
of staple cavities 30012 engage the same tubular element 35080
(FIG. 107), the deformation of the tubular element 35080 can be less customized. For example,
the deformation of a tubular element 35080 in a staple entrapment area 30039 in a
first row can impact the deformation of that tubular element 35080 in staple entrapment
area 30039 in another row. The translating cutting edge 30052 can avoid severing the
tubular elements 42080. Alternatively, referring to
FIG. 111, a tissue thickness compensator 43020 can comprise more than six tubular elements
43080, such as, for example, seven tubular elements 44080. Further, the tubular elements
43080 can be symmetrically or non-symmetrically arranged in the end effector 12. When
an odd number of tubular elements 43080 are longitudinally and symmetrically arranged
in the end effector 12, the translating cutting element 30052 can be configured to
sever the middle tubular element that overlies the longitudinal channel 30015.
[0428] Referring to
FIG. 112, a tissue thickness compensator 44020 can comprise a central tubular element 44080b
that is at least partially aligned with the longitudinal slot 30015 in the rigid support
portion 33010 of the staple cartridge 30000. The tissue thickness compensator 44020
can further comprise at least one peripheral tubular element 44080a, 44080c located
on a side of the longitudinal slot 30015. For example, the tissue thickness compensator
44020 can comprise three tubular elements 44080: a first peripheral tubular element
44080a can be longitudinally positioned on a first side of the longitudinal slot 30015
of the staple cartridge 30000, a central tubular element 44080b can be substantially
positioned over and / or aligned with the longitudinal slot 30015, and a second peripheral
tubular element 44080c can be longitudinally positioned on a second side of the longitudinal
slot 30015. The central tubular element 44080b can comprise a horizontal diameter
that is substantially elongated relative to the vertical diameter. The central tubular
element 44080b, and / or any other tubular element, can overlap multiples rows of
staple cavities 30012. Referring still to
FIG. 112, the central tubular element 44080b can overlap four staple rows of staple cavities
30012 and each peripheral tubular element 44080a, 44080c can overlap a single row
of staple cavities 30012, for example. Alternatively, the central tubular element
44080b can overlap less than four rows of staple cavities 30012, such as, for example,
two rows of staple cavities 30012, for example. Further, peripheral tubular elements
44080a, 44080c can overlap more than one row of staple cavities 30012, such as, for
example, two rows of staple cavities 30012. Referring now to
FIG. 113, a central tubular element 44180b of a tissue thickness compensator 44120 can comprise
a therapeutic agent 44198 in a lumen 44184 of the central tubular element 44180b.
Optionally, central tubular element 44180b and / or at least one peripheral tubular
element 44080a, 44080c can comprise the therapeutic agent 44198 and / or any other
suitable therapeutic agent.
[0429] Referring to
FIG. 114, the tissue thickness compensator 44220 can comprise a shell 44224, which can be similar
to overmold material 32024 described herein. The shell 44224 retains multiple tubular
elements 44080 in position in the end effector 12. The shell 44224 can be coextruded
with the tubular elements 44080. The tubular elements 44080 can comprise a tubular
lattice 44092 of strands 44090. Similar to the polymeric compositions described elsewhere
herein, the shell 44224 can comprise polyglycolic acid (PGA), poly(lactic acid) (PLA),
and / or any other suitable bioabsorbable, biocompatible elastomeric polymers, for
example. Further, the shell 44224 can be non-porous such that the shell 44224 forms
a fluid-impervious layer in the tissue thickness compensator 44220, for example. Further
to the discussion herein, the tubular element 44080 and / or the strands 44090 in
the tubular lattice 44092 can comprise a therapeutic agent 44098. The non-porous shell
44224 can contain the therapeutic agent 44098 within the tissue thickness compensator.
As described herein, the tubular element 44080 can be positioned relative to staple
cavities 30012 and a cutting element 30052 in staple cartridge 30000. Deployment of
the staples 30030 and / or translation of the cutting element 30052 can be configured
to pierce or rupture the non-porous, shell 44224 such that the therapeutic agent 44198
contained therein can be released from the tissue thickness compensator 44020.
[0430] Referring to
FIG. 115, a tissue thickness compensator 44320 can comprise a central tubular element 44380b
comprising a tubular lattice 44392. The tubular lattice 44392 can have a non-woven
portion or a gap 44381 that is substantially aligned with the longitudinal slot 30015
of the rigid support portion 30010. In such cases, a woven portion of the tubular
lattice 44092 of the tubular element 44380b does not overlap the longitudinal slot
30015. Accordingly, the cutting element 30052 on the translating staple-fire sled
30052 can translate along the longitudinal slot 30015 without severing an overlapping
a woven portion of the tubular lattice 44392. Though staples 30030c and 30030d positioned
adjacent to the gap 44381 in tubular element 44380b may receive less support from
the tubular lattice 44392 structure, additional features can provide support for those
staples 30030 and / or additional restoring force in the staple entrapment areas 30039
thereof. For example, as described in greater detail herein, additional tubular elements,
support webbing, springs and / or buttressing material can be positioned at least
one of inside and outside tubular element 44380b near gap 44381, for example.
[0431] Referring now to
FIGS. 116-119a tissue thickness compensator 45020 can comprise multiple tubular elements 45080 that
laterally traverse the staple cartridge 30000. The tubular elements 45080 can be positioned
perpendicular to the rows of staple cavities 30012 and / or the longitudinal axis
of the rigid support portion 30010 of the staple cartridge 30000. Referring to
FIG. 116, the tubular elements 45080 can traverse the longitudinal slot 30015 in the staple
cartridge 30000 such that the cutting element 30052 on the staple-firing sled 30050
is configured to sever the tubular elements 45080 as the staple-firing sled 30050
translates along the longitudinal slot 30015. Alternatively, referring now to
FIG. 117, the tissue thickness compensator 46020 can comprise two sets of laterally traversing
tubular elements 46080. The first set of laterally traversing tubular elements 46080a
can be positioned on a first side of the longitudinal slot 30015 and the second set
of laterally traversing tubular elements 46080b can be positioned on a second side
of the longitudinal slot 30015. In such an arrangement, the cutting element 30052
can be configured to pass between the two sets of tubular elements 46080 without severing
a portion of the tubular elements 46080. Alternatively, the cutting element 30052
can sever at least one tubular element 46080 that traverses the longitudinal slot
30015 while at least one other tubular element 46080 does not traverse the longitudinal
slot 30015 and is not severed by the cutting element 30052.
[0432] As the tubular elements 45080 laterally traverse the staple cartridge 30000, referring
to
FIGS. 118 and
119, a staple 30030 can engage at least one tubular element 45080 in each staple entrapment
area 30039. In such an arrangement, each tubular element 45080 can provide a discrete
restoring force along the length of the staple cartridge 30000. For example, referring
primarily to
FIG. 119, the tubular elements 45080 positioned near the proximal end of the tissue thickness
compensator 45020 where the tissue is thicker can be greatly compressed compared to
the tubular elements 45080 positioned near to the distal end of the tissue thickness
compensator 45020 where the tissue is thinner. As a result, the tubular elements 45080
positioned closer to the proximal end of the tissue thickness compensator 45020 can
provide a greater restoring force than the restoring force that could be generated
by the tubular elements 46080 positioned closer to the distal end of the tissue thickness
compensator 45020. Further, referring still to
FIG. 119, the deformation of one tube 45080 can have little or no impact on the deformation
of an adjacent tube 45080. Accordingly, the tubular elements 45080 can exert a substantially
discrete and customized springback force in staple entrapment areas 30039 along the
length of the staple cartridge 30030. Where multiple staples 30030 fired from a single
row of staple cavities 30012 engage the same tubular element 35080, the deformation
of the tubular element 35080 can be less customized. For example, the deformation
of a tubular element 35080 in one staple entrapment area 30039 can impact the deformation
of that tubular element 35080 in another staple entrapment area 30039.
[0433] As an additional alternative, referring to
FIGS. 120-125, tubular elements 47080 of the tissue thickness compensator 47020 can diagonally traverse
the staple cartridge 30000. The tubular elements 47080 can traverse the longitudinal
slot 30015 of the staple cartridge 30000 such that the cutting element 30052 on the
staple-firing sled 30050 is configured to sever the diagonally traversing tubular
elements 47080 as the staple-firing sled 30052 translates along the longitudinal slot
30015. Alternatively, the tissue thickness compensator 47020 can comprise two sets
of diagonally traversing tubular elements 47080. A first set of diagonally traversing
tubular elements 47080 can be positioned on a first side of the longitudinal slot
30015 and a second set of diagonally traversing tubular elements 47080 can be positioned
on a second side of the longitudinal slot 30015. In such an arrangement, the cutting
element 30052 can pass between the two sets of tubular elements 47080 and may not
sever any tubular element 47080.
[0434] Referring still to
FIGS. 120-123, the diagonally traversing tubular elements 47080 can be positioned in the staple
cartridge 30000 such that a gap is defined between the tubular elements 47080. A gap
between adjacent tubular elements 47080 can provide space for horizontal expansion
of the tubular elements 47080 when a compressive force is applied thereto, such as,
for example, by tissue T captured within the staple entrapment area 30039 of the formed
staple 30030. The tubular elements 47080 can be connected across a gap by a film or
sheet of material 47024. The sheet of material can be positioned on at least one of
the deck surface 30011 of the rigid support portion 30010 and / or the tissue contacting
side of the tubular elements 47080.
[0435] Referring to
FIGS. 124 and
125, at least one diagonally traversing tubular element 47080 can be positioned relative
to the staple cavities 30012 in the staple cartridge 30000 such that the tubular element
47080 is positioned between the legs 30032 of the staples 30030 deployed from multiple
rows of staple cavities 30012. As the staples 30030 are moved from the initial position
to the fired position, as described in greater detail herein, the staple legs 30032
can remain positioned around the tubular element 47080. Further, the staples can be
deformed such that the staple legs 30032 wrap around the perimeter of the tubular
element 47080, for example. In such an arrangement, the staples 30030 can be configured
to move to the fired or formed position without piercing the tubular element 47080.
Movement of the staple legs 30032 around the tubular element 47080 could prevent the
inadvertent release of a therapeutic agent 47098 retained therein. The selected angular
orientation of each tubular element 47080 relative to the longitudinal slot 30015
of the staple cartridge 30000 can depend on the position of the staple cavities 30012
in the staple cartridge 30000. For example, the tubular elements 47080 can be positioned
at an approximately forty-five (45) degree angle relative to the longitudinal slot
30015 of the staple cartridge 30000. Alternatively, the tubular elements 47080 can
be positioned at a fifteen (15) to seventy-five (75) degree angle relative to the
longitudinal slot 30015 of the staple cartridge 30000, for example.
[0436] Similar to descriptions throughout the present disclosure, multiple tubular elements
in a tissue thickness compensator can be connected by a binding agent, wrap, webbing,
overmold, compensation material, and/or any other suitable connecting adhesive or
structure, for example. Referring to
FIGS. 126-128, a flexible shell 48024 may surround or encapsulate tubular elements 48080 in a tissue
thickness compensator 48020. The flexible shell 48024 can restrain the tubular elements
48080 in the end effector 12 and can hold each tubular element 48080 in position,
such as, for example, in longitudinal alignment with a row of staple cavities 30012.
The tissue thickness compensator 48020 can comprise six tubular elements 48080, for
example. The flexible shell 48024 can be sufficiently deformable and resilient to
restrain the tubular elements 48020 encased therein while permitting deformation and
rebound of the tubular elements 48080. Further, the flexible shell 48024 can tautly
surround the tubular elements 48080 and can remain tautly engaged with the tubular
elements 48080 as they deform and / or rebound.
[0437] Referring to
FIG. 127, prior to the deployment of staples 30030, the anvil 30060 can be pivoted or rotated
downwardly to compress the tissue thickness compensator 48020 and tissue T between
the anvil 30060 and the staple cartridge 30000. Compression of the tissue thickness
compensator 48020 can include a corresponding compression of the flexible shell 48024
and the tubular elements 48020 therein. As the tubular elements 48020 deform, the
flexible shell 48024 can similarly deform. The tubular elements 48020 can be uniformly
compressed across the width of the staple cartridge 30000 and the flexible shell 48024
can experience a similarly uniform compression across the tubular elements 48080.
Referring to
FIG. 128, when the anvil 30060 is opened after the staples 30030 have been deployed from the
staple cartridge 30000, the tubular elements 48080 can rebound or partially rebound
from the compressed configurations
(FIG. 127). According to the invention, a tubular element 48080 can rebound such that the tubular
element 48080 returns to its initial, undeformed configuration. A tubular element
48080 can partially rebound such that the tubular element 48080 partially returns
to its initial undeformed configuration. For example, the deformation of the tubular
element 48080 can be partially elastic and partially plastic. As the tubular elements
48080 rebound, the flexible shell 48024 can remain tautly engaged with each tubular
element 48080. The tubular elements 48080 and flexible shell 48024 can rebound to
such a degree that the tubular elements 48080 and tissue T fill the staple entrapment
areas 30039 while the tubular elements 48080 exert an appropriate restoring force
on the tissue T therein. Referring to
FIG. 129, in other cases, a tissue thickness compensator 48120 comprising six tubular elements
48180 retained in a flexible shell 48124 can be positioned on the anvil 30060 of the
end effector 12, for example.
[0438] Referring to
FIGS. 130-133, a tissue thickness compensator 49020 can comprise a tubular element 49080 longitudinally
positioned along the longitudinal axis of the anvil 30060. The tissue thickness compensator
49020 can be secured to the anvil 30060 of the end effector 12 by a compressible compensation
material 49024. Further, the compressible compensation material 49024 can surround
or encapsulate the tubular element 49080. Similar to the descriptions herein, the
tubular element 49080 can comprise at least one therapeutic agent 49098 which may
be released by the absorption of various components of the tissue thickness compensator
49020, the piercing of the tubular element 49080 by staples 30030 fired from the staple
cartridge 30000, and / or by the cutting element 30052.
[0439] Referring to
FIG. 131, a staple cartridge 30000 can comprise staples 30030 positioned in staple cavities
30012, wherein, prior to deployment of the staples 30030, the anvil 30060 and the
tissue thickness compensator 49020 attached thereto can pivot toward the staple cartridge
30000 and compress tissue T captured therebetween. The tubular element 49080 of the
tissue thickness compensator 49020 can be uniformly deformed along the length of the
staple cartridge 30000 by the pivoting anvil 30060
(FIG. 131). Referring to
FIGS. 132 and
133, the staple-firing sled 30050 can translate along the longitudinal slot 30015 in the
staple cartridge 30000 and engage each driver 30040 positioned beneath a staple 30030
in a staple cavity 30010, wherein each engaged driver 30040 can fire or eject the
staple 30030 from the staple cavity 30012. When the anvil 30060 releases pressure
on the tissue T and the tissue thickness compensator 49020, the tissue thickness compensator
49020, including the tubular element 49080 and the compressible compensation material
49024, can rebound or partially rebound from the compressed configurations
(FIG. 131) to a rebounded configuration
(FIGS. 132 and
133). The tubular element 49080 and compressible compensation material 49024 can rebound
to such a degree that the tissue thickness compensator 49020 and tissue T fill the
staple entrapment areas 30039 while the tissue thickness compensator 49020 exert an
a restoring force on the captured tissue T.
[0440] Referring to
FIGS. 124-126, two tissue thickness compensators 50020a, 50020b can be positioned in the end effector
12 of a surgical instrument. For example, a first tissue thickness compensator 50020a
can be attached to the staple cartridge 30000 in the lower jaw 30070 and a second
tissue thickness compensator 50020b can be attached to the anvil 30060. The first
tissue thickness compensator 50020a can comprise a plurality of tubular elements 50080
longitudinally arranged and retained in a first compensation material 50024a. At least
one tubular element 50080 can comprise a therapeutic agent 50098, similar to the therapeutic
agents described herein. The first compensation material 50024a can be deformable
or substantially rigid. Further, the first compensation material 50024a can hold the
tubular elements 50080 in position relative to the staple channel 30000. For example,
the first compensation material 50024a can hold each tubular element 50080 in longitudinal
alignment with a row of staple cavities 30012. The second tissue thickness compensator
50020b can comprise the first compensation material 50024a, a second compensation
material 50024b and / or a third compensation material 50024c. The second and third
compensation material 50024b, 50024c can be deformable or substantially rigid.
[0441] The anvil 30060 can pivot and apply a compressive force to the tissue thickness compensators
50020a, 50020b and the tissue T between the anvil 30060 and the staple cartridge 30000.
In some cases, neither the first tissue thickness compensators 50020a nor the second
tissue thickness compensators 50020b can be compressible. Alternatively, at least
one component of the first tissue thickness compensators 50020a and / or the second
tissue thickness compensators 50020b can be compressible. When the staples 30030 are
fired from the staple cartridge 30000, referring now to
FIGS. 135 and
136, each staple 30030 can pierce a tubular element 50080 retained in the first tissue
thickness compensator 50020a. As shown in
FIG. 135, the therapeutic agent 50098 retained in the tubular element 50080 can be released
when a staple 30030 pierces the tubular element 50080. When released, the therapeutic
agent 50098 can coat the staple legs 30032 and tissue T surrounding the fired staple
30030. The staples 30030 can also pierce the second tissue thickness compensator 50020b
when the staples 30030 are fired from the staple cartridge 30000.
[0442] Referring to
FIGS. 137-140, a tissue thickness compensator 51020 can comprise at least one tubular element 51080
that laterally traverses the tissue thickness compensator 51020. For example, referring
to
FIG. 137, the tissue thickness compensator 51020 can be positioned relative to the staple cartridge
30000 such that a first end 51083 of the laterally traversing tubular element 51080
can be positioned near a first longitudinal side of the staple cartridge 30000 and
a second end 51085 of the laterally traversing tubular element 51080 can be positioned
near a second longitudinal side of the staple cartridge 30000. The tubular element
51080 can comprise a capsule-like shape, for example. As illustrated in
FIG. 138, the tubular element 51080 can be perforated between the first end 51083 and the second
end 51085 and, in some cases, the tubular element 51080 can be perforated at or near
the center 51087 of the tubular element 51080. The tubular element 51080 can comprise
a polymeric composition, such as a bioabsorbable, biocompatible elastomeric polymer,
for example. Further, referring again to
FIG. 137, the tissue thickness compensator 51020 can comprise a plurality of laterally traversing
tubular elements 51080. Thirteen tubular elements 51080 can be laterally arranged
in the tissue thickness compensator 51020, for example.
[0443] Referring again to
FIG. 137, the tissue thickness compensator 51020 can further comprise a compensation material
51024 that at least partially surrounds the tubular elements 51080. The compensation
material 51024 can comprise a bioabsorbable polymer, such as, for example, lyophilized
polysaccharide, glycoprotein, elastin, proteoglycan, gelatin, collagen, and / or oxidized
regenerated cellulose (ORC). The compensation material 51024 can hold the tubular
elements 51080 in position in the tissue thickness compensator 51020. Further, the
compensation material 51024 can be secured to the top deck surface 30011 of the rigid
support portion 30010 of the staple cartridge 30000 such that the compensation material
51020 is securely positioned in the end effector 12. The compensation material 51024
can comprise at least one medicament 51098.
[0444] Still referring to
FIG. 137, laterally positioned tubular elements 51080 can be positioned relative to the translating
cutting element 30052 such that the cutting element 30052 is configured to sever the
tubular elements 51080. The cutting element 30052 can sever the tubular elements 51080
at or near the perforation therein. When the tubular elements 51080 are severed in
two halves, the severed portions of the tubular elements 51080 can be configured to
swell or expand, as illustrated in
FIG. 139. For example, the tubular element 51080 can comprise a hydrophilic substance 51099
that can be released and / or exposed when the tubular element 51080 is severed. Furthermore,
when the hydrophilic substance 51099 contacts bodily fluids in tissue T, the hydrophilic
substance 51099 can attract the fluid, which can cause the tubular element 51080 to
swell or expand. As the tubular element 51080 expands, the compensation material 51024
surrounding the tubular element 51080 can shift or adjust to accommodate the swollen
tubular element 51080. For example, when the compensation material 51024 comprises
gelatin, the gelatin can shift to accommodate the swollen tubular elements 51080.
Referring now to
FIG. 140, expansion of the tubular elements 51080 and shifting of the compensation material
51024 can cause a corresponding expansion of the tissue thickness compensator 51020.
[0445] Similar to other tissue thickness compensators discussed throughout the present disclosure,
the tissue thickness compensator 51020 can be deformed or compressed by an applied
force. Further, the tissue thickness compensator 51020 can be sufficiently resilient
such that it produces a springback force when deformed by the applied force and can
subsequently rebound or partially rebound when the applied force is removed. Optionally,
when the tissue thickness compensator 51020 is captured in a staple entrapment area
30039, the staple 30030 can deform the tissue thickness compensator 51020. For example,
the staple 30030 can deform the tubular elements 51080 and / or the compensation material
51024 of the tissue thickness compensator 51020 that are captured within the fired
staple 30030. Optionally, non-captured portions of the tissue thickness compensator
51020 can also be deformed due to the deformation in the staple entrapment areas 30039.
When deformed, the tissue thickness compensator 51020 can seek to rebound from the
deformed configuration. Optionally, such a rebound may occur prior to the hydrophilic
expansion of the tubular element 51080, simultaneously with the hydrophilic expansion
of the tubular element 51080, and / or after the hydrophilic expansion of the tubular
element 51080. As the tissue thickness compensator 51020 seeks to rebound, it can
exert a restoring force on the tissue also captured in the staple entrapment area
30039, as described in greater detail herein.
[0446] Optionally, at least one of the tubular elements 51080 and / or the compensation
material 51024 in the tissue thickness compensator 51020 can comprise a therapeutic
agent 51098. When the tubular element 51080 that contains a therapeutic agent 51098
is severed, the therapeutic agent 51098 contained within the tubular elements 51080
can be released. Furthermore, when the compensation material 51024 comprises the therapeutic
agent 51098, the therapeutic agent 51098 can be released as the bioabsorbable compensation
material 51024 is absorbed. The tissue thickness compensator 51020 can provide for
a rapid initial release of the therapeutic agent 51098 followed by a controlled release
of the therapeutic agent 51098. For example, the tissue thickness compensator 51020
can provide a rapid initial release of the therapeutic agent 51098 from the tubular
elements 51080 to the tissue T along the cut line when the tubular elements 51080
comprising the therapeutic agent 51098 are severed. Further, as the bioabsorbable
compensation material 51024 comprising the therapeutic agent 51098 is absorbed, the
tissue thickness compensator 51020 can provide an extended, controlled release of
the therapeutic agent 51098. At least some of the therapeutic agent 51098 can remain
in the tubular element 51080 for a short period of time before the therapeutic agent
51098 flows into the compensation material 51024. Alternatively, at least some of
the therapeutic agent 51098 can remain in the tubular element 51080 until the tubular
element 51080 is absorbed. The therapeutic agent 51098 released from the tubular element
51080 and the compensation material 51024 can be the same. Alternatively, the tubular
element 51080 and the compensation material 51024 can comprise different therapeutic
agents or different combinations of therapeutic agents, for example.
[0447] Referring still to
FIG. 140, the end effector 12 can cut tissue T and fire staples 30030 into the severed tissue
T nearly simultaneously or in quick succession. In such cases, a staple 30030 can
be deployed into the tissue T immediately after the cutting element 30052 has severed
the tubular element 51080 adjacent to the tissue T. In other words, the staples 30030
can engage the tissue thickness compensator 51020 immediately following or simultaneously
with the swelling of the tubular element 51080 and the expansion of the tissue thickness
compensator 51020. The tissue thickness compensator 51020 can continue to grow or
expand after the staples 30030 have been fired into the tissue T. The staples 30030
can be configured to puncture the tubular elements 51080 when the staples 30030 are
deployed. In such cases, therapeutic agents 51098 still retained in the severed tubular
elements 51080 can be released from the tubular elements 51080 and, in some cases,
can cover the legs 30031 of the fired staples 30030.
[0448] Referring to
FIG. 141, the tissue thickness compensator 51020 can be manufactured by a molding technique,
for example. According to the invention, a frame, or a mold, 51120 can comprise a
first longitudinal side 51122 and a second longitudinal side 51124. Each longitudinal
side 51124 can comprise one or more notches 51130, which can each be configured to
receive the first or second end 50183, 50185 of a tubular element 51080. The first
end 50183 of the tubular element 51080 can be positioned in a first notch 51130a on
the first longitudinal side 51122 and the second end 50183 of the tubular element
51080 can be positioned in a second notch 51130b on the second longitudinal side 51124
such that the tubular element 51080 laterally traverses the frame 51120. The notch
51180 can comprise a semi-circular groove, which can securely fit the first or second
end 50183, 50185 of the tubular element 51080 therein. The first notch 51130a can
be positioned directly across from the second notch 51130b and the tubular element
51080 can be positioned perpendicular, or at least substantially perpendicular, to
the longitudinal axis of the frame 51120. Alternatively, the first notch 51130a can
be offset from the second notch 51130b such that the tubular element 51080 is angularly
positioned relative to the longitudinal axis of the frame 51120. As an additional
alternative, at least one tubular element 51080 can be longitudinally positioned within
the frame 51120 such that the tubular element extends between the lateral sides 51126,
51128 of the frame 51120. Further, at least one tubular element can be angularly positioned
in the frame between two notches on the lateral sides 51126, 51128 of the frame and
/ or between a notch on a lateral side 51126 and a notch on a longitudinal side 51124,
for example. The frame 51120 can comprise a support ledge 51136, which can support
the tubular elements 51080 positioned within the frame 51120.
[0449] The frame 51120 can comprise notches 51130 to accommodate twelve tubular elements
51080, for example. The frame notches 51130 can be filled with tubular elements 51080
while, alternatively, less than all of the notches 51130 may be filled. Optionally,
at least one tubular element 51080 can be positioned in the frame 51120. At least
half the notches 51130 can receive tubular elements 51080. Once the tubular elements
51080 are positioned in the frame 51120, compensation material 51024 can be added
to the frame 51120. The compensation material 51024 can be fluidic when added to the
frame 51120. For example, the compensation material 51024 can be poured into the frame
51120 and can flow around the tubular elements 51080 positioned therein. Referring
to
FIG. 142, the fluidic compensation material 51024 can flow around the tubular element 51080
supported by notches 51130 in the frame 51120. After the compensation material 51024
cures, or at least sufficiently cures, referring now to
FIG. 143, the tissue thickness compensator 51020 comprising the compensation material 51024
and tubular elements 51080 can be removed from the frame 51120. The tissue thickness
compensator 51020 can be trimmed. For example, excess compensation material 51024
can be removed from the tissue thickness compensator 51020 such that the longitudinal
sides of the compensation material are substantially planar. Furthermore, referring
to
FIG. 144, the first and second ends 50183, 50185 of the tubular elements 51080 can be pressed
together, or closed, to seal the tubular element 51080. The ends can be closed before
the tubular elements 51080 are placed in the frame 51120. Alternatively, the trimming
process may transect the ends 51083, 51085 and a heat stacking process can be used
to seal and / or close the ends 51083, 51085 of the tubular elements 51080.
[0450] Referring again to
FIG. 141, a stiffening pin 51127 can be positioned within each tubular element 51080. For example,
the stiffening pin 51127 can extend through a longitudinal lumen of the tubular element
51080. The stiffening pin 51127 can extend beyond each tubular element 51080 such
that the stiffening pin 51127 can be positioned in notches 51130 in the frame 51120.
In embodiments having stiffening pins 51127, the stiffening pins 51127 can support
the tubular elements 51080 when the compensation material 51204 is poured into the
frame 51120 and as the fluidic compensation material 51024 flows around the tubular
elements 51080, for example. Once the compensation material 51024 cures, solidifies,
and / or lyophilizes or sufficiently cures, solidifies, and / or lyophilizes the tissue
thickness compensator 51020 can be removed from the frame 51120 and the stiffening
pins 51127 can be removed from the longitudinal lumens of the tubular elements 51080.
The tubular elements 51080 can then be filled with medicaments, for example. After
the tubular elements 51080 are filled with medicaments, the tissue thickness compensator
51020, including the ends 51083, 51085 of the tubular elements 51080, for example,
can be trimmed. The tissue thickness compensator 51020 can be die cut, for example,
and / or sealed by heat and / or pressure, for example.
[0451] As discussed herein, the tissue thickness compensator 52020 can comprise multiple
tubular elements 51080. Referring now to
FIG. 145, the tubular elements 51080 can comprise different material properties, dimensions
and geometries. For example, a first tubular element 51080a can comprise a first thickness
and a first material and a second tubular element 51080b can comprise a second thickness
and a second material. Optionally, at least two tubular elements 51080 in the tissue
thickness compensator 52020 can comprise the same material. Alternatively, each tubular
element 51080 in the tissue thickness compensator 5202 can comprise different materials.
Similarly, at least two tubular elements 51080 in the tissue thickness compensator
52020 can comprise the same geometry. Alternatively, each tubular element 51080 in
the tissue thickness compensator 52020 can comprise different geometries.
[0452] Referring now to
FIGS. 208-211, a tissue thickness compensator 51220 can comprise at least one tubular element 51280
that laterally traverses the tissue thickness compensator 51220. Referring to
FIG. 208, the tissue thickness compensator 51220 can be positioned relative to the anvil 30060
of the end effector 12. The tissue thickness compensator 51220 can be secured to a
securing surface 30061 of the anvil 30060 of the end effector 12, for example. Referring
primarily to
FIG. 209, the tubular element 51280 can comprise a capsule-like shape, for example. The tubular
element 51280 can comprise a polymeric composition, such as a bioabsorbable, biocompatible
elastomeric polymer, for example.
[0453] Referring again to
FIG. 208, the tissue thickness compensator 51220 can further comprise a compensation material
51224 that at least partially surrounds the tubular elements 51280. The compensation
material 51224 can comprise a bioabsorbable polymer, such as, for example, lyophilized
polysaccharide, glycoprotein, elastin, proteoglycan, gelatin, collagen, and / or oxidized
regenerated cellulose (ORC), for example. Similar to the above, the compensation material
51024 can hold the tubular elements 51280 in position in the tissue thickness compensator
51220. Further, the compensation material 51224 can be secured to the securing surface
30061 of the anvil 30060 such that the compensation material 51220 is securely positioned
in the end effector 12. The compensation material 51224 can comprise at least one
medicant.
[0454] Still referring to
FIG. 208, the laterally positioned tubular elements 51280 can be positioned relative to the
cutting element 30252 on a translating sled 30250 such that the translatable cutting
element 30252 is configured to sever the tubular elements 51280. The cutting element
30252 can sever the tubular elements 51280 at or near the center of each tubular element
51280, for example. When the tubular elements 51280 are severed in two halves, the
severed portions of the tubular elements 51280 can be configured to swell or expand,
as illustrated in
FIG. 208. Referring primarily to
FIG. 210a tubular element 51280 can comprise a hydrophilic substance 51099 that can be released
and / or exposed when the tubular element 51280 is severed. Furthermore, referring
now to
FIG. 211, when the hydrophilic substance 51099 contacts bodily fluids in the tissue T, the
hydrophilic substance 51099 can attract the fluid, which can cause the tubular element
51280 to swell or expand. As the tubular element 51280 expands, the compensation material
51224 surrounding the tubular element 51280 can shift or adjust to accommodate the
swollen tubular element 51280. For example, when the compensation material 51224 comprises
gelatin, the gelatin can shift to accommodate the swollen tubular element 51280. Referring
again to
FIG. 208, expansion of the tubular elements 51280 and shifting of the compensation material
51224 can cause a corresponding expansion of the tissue thickness compensator 51220.
[0455] Similar to other tissue thickness compensators discussed throughout the present disclosure,
the tissue thickness compensator 51220 can be deformed or compressed by an applied
force. Further, the tissue thickness compensator 51220 can be sufficiently resilient
such that it produces a springback force when deformed by the applied force and can
subsequently rebound or partially rebound when the applied force is removed. Optionally,
when the tissue thickness compensator 51220 is captured in a staple entrapment area
30039 (FIG. 88), the staple 30030 can deform the tissue thickness compensator 51220.
For example, the staple 30030 can deform the tubular elements 51280 and / or the compensation
material 51224 of the tissue thickness compensator 51220 captured within the fired
staple 30030. Optionally, non-captured portions of the tissue thickness compensator
51220 can also be deformed due to the deformation in the staple entrapment areas 30039.
When deformed, the tissue thickness compensator 51220 can seek to rebound from the
deformed configuration. Optionally, such a rebound may occur prior to the hydrophilic
expansion of the tubular element 51280, simultaneously with the hydrophilic expansion
of the tubular element 51280, and / or after the hydrophilic expansion of the tubular
element 51280. As the tissue thickness compensator 51220 seeks to rebound, it can
exert a restoring force on the tissue also captured in the staple entrapment area
30039, as described in greater detail herein.
[0456] Referring to
FIGS. 146-149, a tissue thickness compensator 52020 can comprise one or more tubular elements 52080
that laterally traverse the tissue thickness compensator 52020, similar to at least
one tissue thickness compensator described herein. The tissue thickness compensator
52020 can comprise multiple laterally traversing tubular elements 52080. The tissue
thickness compensator 52020 can further comprise one or more sheets of material 52024
that hold or retain at least one tubular element 52080 in the tissue thickness compensator
52020. The one or more sheets of material 52024 can be positioned above and / or below
the tubular elements 52080 and can securely retain each tubular element 52080 in the
tissue thickness compensator 52020. Referring primarily to
FIG. 146, the tissue thickness compensator can comprise a first sheet of material 52024a and
a second sheet of material 52024b. The tubular elements 52080 can be positioned between
the first and second sheets of material 52024a, 52024b. Further, referring still to
FIG. 146, the sheet of material 52024b can be secured to the top deck surface 30011 of the
rigid support portion of the staple cartridge 30000 such that the tissue thickness
compensator 52020 is securely positioned in the end effector 12. Alternatively, one
or more of the sheets of material 52024 can be secured to the anvil 30060 or otherwise
retained in the end effector 12.
[0457] Referring primarily to
FIG. 147, the tissue thickness compensator 52020 can be porous and / or permeable. For example,
the sheet of material 52024 can comprise a plurality of apertures 52026. The apertures
52026 can be substantially circular. The apertures 52036 can be visible in the sheet
of material 52024. Alternatively, the apertures 52036 can be microscopic. Referring
still to
FIG. 147, the tubular elements 52080 can comprise a plurality of apertures 52026, as well.
Referring to
FIG. 148, a tissue thickness compensator 52120 can comprise a sheet of material 52124 that
comprises a plurality of non-circular apertures 52126. For example, the apertures
52126 can comprise a diamond and / or slotted shape. Alternatively, referring to
FIG. 149, a tissue thickness compensator 52220 can comprise a tubular element 52280 that comprises
a permeable tubular lattice 52292. The sheet of material 52224 can comprise a bioabsorbable,
biocompatible elastomeric polymer and can comprise a medicament, for example.
[0458] At least one tubular element 52080 can be configured to swell or expand, as illustrated
in
FIGS. 150A-150D. For example, referring to
FIG. 150A, the tubular elements 52080 can be positioned intermediate the first and second sheet
of material 52024a, 52024b in the tissue thickness compensator 52020. When the tissue
thickness compensator 52020 contacts tissue T, as illustrated in
FIG. 150B, the tissue thickness compensator 52020 can expand. For example, the tubular elements
52080 can comprise a hydrophilic substance 52099 that expands when exposed to fluid
in and / or on the tissue T. Further, the sheet of material 52024 and tubular elements
52080 can be permeable, as described herein, such that fluid from the tissue T can
permeate the tissue thickness compensator 52020 thereby allowing the fluid to contact
the hydrophilic substance 52099 within the tubular elements 52080. As the tubular
elements 52080 expand, the sheet of material 52024 surrounding the tubular elements
52080 can shift or adjust to accommodate the swollen tubular elements 52080. Similar
to various tissue thickness compensators discussed throughout the present disclosure,
the expanded tissue thickness compensator 52020 can be deformed or compressed by an
applied force, such as, for example, a compressive force applied by fired staples,
as illustrated in
FIG. 150C. Further, the tissue thickness compensator 52020 can be sufficiently resilient such
that it produces a springback force when deformed by the applied force and can subsequently
rebound when the applied force is removed. Referring now to
FIGS. 150D and 150E, the tissue thickness compensator 52020 can rebound to different configurations in
different staple entrapment areas 30039 to appropriately accommodate the captured
tissue T.
[0459] Referring to
FIGS. 151-156, a tissue thickness compensator 53020 can comprise a plurality of vertically positioned
tubular elements 53080. Optionally, each tubular element 53080 can comprise a tubular
axis that is substantially perpendicular to the top deck surface 30011 of the rigid
support portion 30010 of the staple cartridge 30000. Further, the first end of each
tubular element 53080 can be positioned adjacent to the top deck surface 30011, for
example. The tubular elements 53080 can be deformable and may comprise an elastomeric
polymer, for example. Optionally, as illustrated in
FIG. 152, the tubular elements 53080 can be compressed when captured in a staple entrapment
area 30039 with stapled tissue T. A tubular element 53080 can comprise an elastic
material such that deformation of the tubular element 53080 generates a restoring
force as the tubular element 53080 seeks to rebound from the deformed configuration.
Deformation of the tubular element 53080 can be at least partially elastic and at
least partially plastic. The tubular element 53080 can be configured to act as a spring
under an applied force and can be configured not to buckle. Referring to
FIG. 153, the tubular elements 53080 can be substantially cylindrical. Referring to
FIG. 154, a tubular element 53180 can comprise a buckling region 53112. The tubular element
53180 can be configured to buckle or deform at the buckling region 53112 when a compressive
force is applied thereto. The tubular element 53180 can deform elastically and / or
plastically and then be designed to buckle suddenly at the buckling region 53112 under
a preselected buckling force.
[0460] Referring primarily to
FIG. 155, a first tubular element 53080 can be positioned at a first end of a staple cavity
30012 and another tubular element 53080 can be positioned at a second end of the staple
cavity 30012. As illustrated in
FIG. 153, the tubular element 53080 can comprise a lumen 53084 extending therethrough. Referring
again to
FIG. 152, when the staple 30030 is moved from the initial position to the fired position, each
staple leg 30032 can be configured to pass through a lumen 53084 of each tubular element
53080. Alternatively, referring primarily to
FIG. 156, vertically positioned tubular elements 54080 can be arranged in a tissue thickness
compensator 54020 such that the tubular elements 54080 abut or contact each other.
In other words, the tubular elements 54080 can be clustered or gathered together.
The tubular elements 54080 can be systematically arranged in the tissue thickness
compensator 54020; however, in other cases, the tubular elements 54080 can be randomly
arranged.
[0461] Referring again to
FIGS. 151, 155, and
156, the tissue thickness compensator 53020 can also comprise a sheet of material 53024
that holds or retains the tubular elements 53080 in the tissue thickness compensator
53020. The sheet of material 53024 can be positioned above and / or below the tubular
elements 53080 and can securely retain each tubular element 53080 in the tissue thickness
compensator 53020. The tissue thickness compensator 53020 can comprise a first and
a second sheet of material 53024. The tubular elements 53080 can be positioned between
the first and second sheets of material 53024. Further, the sheet of material 53024
can be secured to the top deck surface 30011 of the rigid support portion of the staple
cartridge 30000 such that the tissue thickness compensator 53020 is securely positioned
in the end effector 12. Alternatively, a sheet of material 53024 can be secured to
the anvil 30060 or otherwise retained in the end effector 12. The sheet of material
53024 can be sufficiently deformable such that the sheet of material 53024 deforms
as springs 55080 within the tissue thickness compensator are deformed.
[0462] Referring to
FIGS. 157 and
158, a tissue thickness compensator 55020 can comprise at least one spring 55080 that
is sufficiently resilient such that it is capable of producing a springback force
when deformed. Referring primarily to
FIG. 157, the tissue thickness compensator 55020 can comprise a plurality of springs 55080,
such as, for example, three rows of springs 55080. The springs 55080 can be systematically
and / or randomly arranged in the tissue thickness compensator 55020. The springs
55080 can comprise an elastomeric polymer, for example. The shape of the springs 55080
can allow for deformation thereof. The springs 55080 can be deformed from an initial
configuration to a deformed configuration. For example, when a portion of the tissue
thickness compensator 55020 is captured in a staple entrapment area 30039, the springs
55080 in and / or around the staple entrapment area 30039 can be deformed. The springs
55080 can buckle or collapse under a compressive force applied for a fired staple
30030 and the springs 55080 may generate a restoring force that is a function of the
spring rate of the deformed spring 55080 and / or the amount the spring 55080 is deformed,
for example. The spring 55080 can act as a sponge under a compressive force applied
by a fired staple 30030. Further, the spring 55080 can comprise a compensation material,
as described in greater detail throughout the present disclosure.
[0463] The tissue thickness compensator 55020 can further comprise one or more sheets of
material 55024 that hold or retain at least one spring 55080 in the tissue thickness
compensator 55020. The sheets of material 55024 can be positioned above and / or below
the springs 55080 and can securely retain the springs 55080 in the tissue thickness
compensator 55020. The tissue thickness compensator 55020 can comprise a first sheet
of material 55024a and a second sheet of material 55024b. The tubular elements 52080
can be positioned between the first and second sheets of material 55024a, 55024b.
Referring primarily to
FIG. 158, the tissue thickness compensator 55020 can further comprise a third sheet of material
55024c positioned adjacent to either the first or second sheet of material 55024a,
55024b. Optionally, at least one sheet of material 55024 can be secured to the top
deck surface 30011 of the rigid support portion of the staple cartridge 30000, such
that the tissue thickness compensator 55020 is securely positioned in the end effector
12. Alternatively, at least one sheet of material 55024 can be secured to the anvil
30060 or otherwise retained in the end effector 12.
[0464] Referring now to
FIG. 158, when a staple 30030 is fired from the staple cartridge 30000
(FIG. 156), the staple 30030 can engage the tissue thickness compensator 55020. The fired staple
30030 can capture tissue T and a portion of the tissue thickness compensator 55020
in the staple entrapment area 30039. The springs 55080 can be deformable such that
the tissue thickness compensator 55020 compresses when captured by a fired staple
30030. The springs 55080 can be positioned between fired staples 30030 in the tissue
thickness compensator 55020. Alternatively, at least one spring 55080 can be captured
within the staple entrapment area 30039.
[0465] Referring to
FIG. 159, a tissue thickness compensator 60020 can comprise at least two compensation layers
60022. The tissue thickness compensator 60020 can comprise a plurality of compensation
layers 60022 which can be stacked on top of each other, positioned side-by-side, or
a combination thereof. As described in greater detail herein, the compensation layers
60022 of the tissue thickness compensator 60020 can comprise different geometric and
/ or material properties, for example. Furthermore, as described in greater detail
herein, pockets and / or channels can exist between adjacently stacked compensation
layers 60022. For example, a tissue thickness compensator 62020 can comprise six compensation
layers 62022a, 62022b, 62022c, 62022d, 62022e, 62022f, which can be adjacently stacked
on top of each other
(FIG. 174).
[0466] Referring to
FIGS. 160, 161, and
163-168, a tissue thickness compensator can comprise a first compensation layer 60122a and
a second compensation layer 60122b. The first compensation layer 60122a can be adjacently
stacked on top of the second compensation layer 60122b. Adjacently stacked compensation
layers 60122 can be separated by a separation gap or pocket 60132. Referring primarily
to
FIG. 160, a tissue thickness compensator 60120 can also comprise at least one cantilever beam
or support 60124 positioned between the first and second compensation layers 60122a,
60122b. The support 60124 can be configured to position the first compensation layer
60122a relative to the second compensation layer 60122b such that compensation layers
60122 are separated by the separation gap 60132. As described in greater detail herein,
deformation of the support 60124 and / or the compensation layers 60122a, 60122b,
for example, can reduce the separation gap 60132.
[0467] The support beam of a tissue thickness compensator can comprise various geometries
and dimensions. For example, the support beam can be a simple I-beam, a centered,
single-bend support beam 60124
(FIG. 160), an off-centered, single-bend support beam 60224
(FIG. 161), an elliptical support beam 60324
(FIG. 163), a multi-bend support beam 60424
(FIG. 164), and / or a symmetrical, dual-cantilevered support beam 60524
(FIG. 165). Furthermore, referring now to
FIGS. 160, 166, and
167, a support beam 60624 can be thinner than at least one compensation layer 60122
(FIG. 166), a support beam 60724 can be thicker than at least one compensation layer 60122
(FIG. 167), and / or a support beam 60124 can be substantially the same thickness as at least
one compensation layer 60122
(FIG. 160), for example. The material, geometry and / or dimensions of the support beam 60124,
for example, can affect the deformability and springback resiliency of the tissue
thickness compensator 60120.
[0468] Referring still to
FIG. 160, the compensation layers 60122 and support beam 60124 of the tissue thickness compensator
60120 can comprise different materials, such as, for example, structural material,
biological material, and / or electrical material, for example. For example, at least
one compensation layer 60122 can comprise a polymeric composition. The polymeric composition
can comprise an at least partially elastic material such that deformation of the compensation
layer 60122 and / or the support beam 60124 can generate a springback force. The polymeric
composition of the compensation layer 60122 can comprise non-absorbable polymers,
absorbable polymers, or combinations thereof. The absorbable polymers can include
bioabsorbable, biocompatible elastomeric polymers, for example. Furthermore, the polymeric
composition of the compensation layer 60122 can comprise synthetic polymers, non-synthetic
polymers, or combinations thereof. Examples of synthetic polymers include, but are
not limited to, polyglycolic acid (PGA), poly(lactic acid) (PLA), polycaprolactone
(PCL), polydioxanone (PDO), and copolymers thereof. Examples of non-synthetic polymers
include, but are not limited to, polysaccharides, glycoprotein, elastin, proteoglycan,
gelatin, collagen, and oxidized regenerated cellulose (ORC). Optionally, similar to
the polymeric compositions described elsewhere herein, the polymeric composition of
the compensation layers 60122 can include varied amounts of absorbable polymers, non-absorbable
polymers, synthetic polymers, and non-synthetic polymers, for example, by weight percentage.
Optionally, each compensation layer 60022 in the tissue thickness compensator 60120
can comprise a different polymeric composition or, alternatively, at least two compensation
layers 60122 can comprise the same polymeric composition.
[0469] Referring again to
FIG. 159at least one compensation layer 60022 can comprise a therapeutic agent 60098 such
as a medicament or pharmaceutically active agent, for example. The compensation layer
60022 can release a therapeutically effective amount of the therapeutic agent 60098.
The therapeutic agent 60098 can be released as the compensation layer 60022 is absorbed.
Examples of therapeutic agents 60098 can include, but are not limited to, haemostatic
agents and drugs, such as, for example, fibrin, thrombin, and / or oxidized regenerated
cellulose (ORC), anti-inflammatory drugs such as, for example, diclofenac, aspirin,
naproxen, sulindac, and / or hydrocortisone antibiotic and antimicrobial drugs or
agents such as, for example, triclosan, ionic silver, ampicillin, gentamicin, polymyxin
B, and / or chloramphenicol, and / or anticancer agents such as, for example, cisplatin,
mitomycin, and / or adriamycin. The therapeutic agent 60098 can comprise a biologic,
such as a stem cell, for example. Optionally, each compensation layer 60022 in a tissue
thickness compensator 60020 can comprise a different therapeutic agent 60098 or, alternatively,
at least two compensation layers 60022 can comprise the same therapeutic agent 60098.
A compensation layer 60022 comprising a therapeutic agent 60098, such as a biologic,
for example, can be encased between two structural compensation layers 60022 comprising
a polymeric composition, such as, for example, polyglycolic acid (PGA) foam, for example.
According to the invention, a compensation layer 60022 can also comprise an electrically
conductive material, such as, for example, copper.
[0470] Referring again to
FIG. 174, the compensation layers 62022 in the tissue thickness compensator 62020 can have
different geometries. When layers 62022 are adjacently positioned in the tissue thickness
compensator 62020, the compensation layers 62022 can form at least one three-dimensional
conduit 62032 between the layers 62022. For example, when a second compensation layer
62022b comprising a channel is positioned above a substantially flat third compensation
layer 62022c, the channel and flat surface of the third compensation layer 62022c
can define a three-dimensional conduit 62032a therebetween. Similarly, for example,
when a fifth compensation layer 62022e comprising a channel is positioned below a
fourth compensation layer 62022d comprising a corresponding channel, the channels
can form a three-dimensional conduit 62032b defined by the channels in the adjacently
stacked compensation layers 62022d, 62022e. The conduits 62032 can direct therapeutic
agents and / or bodily fluids as the fluids flow through the tissue thickness compensator
62020.
[0471] Referring to
FIG. 170, a tissue thickness compensator 61020 can comprise compensation layers 61022, such
as layers 60122a and 21022b, configured to receive staples 30030 deployed from the
staple cartridge 20000
(FIG. 169). As a staple 30030 is moved from an initial position to a fired position, the geometry
of at least one compensation layer 61022 can guide the staple legs 30032 to the fired
position. Optionally, at least one compensation layer 61022 can comprise apertures
61030 extending therethrough, wherein the apertures 61030 can be arranged to receive
the staple legs 30032 of deployed staples 30030 when the staples 30030 are fired from
the staple cartridge 20000
(FIG. 169), as described in greater detail herein. Alternatively, referring again to
FIG. 174, staple legs 30032 can pierce through at least one compensation layer, such as compensation
layer 62022f, for example, and can be received through apertures 62030 in at least
one compensation layer, such as, for example, compensation layer 62022a.
[0472] Referring primarily to
FIG. 170, the tissue thickness compensator 60120 can comprise at least one support tab 61026
on one of the compensation layers 61022a, 61022b. The support tab 61026 can protrude
into the separation gap 61032 defined between adjacent compensation layers, such as
the gap 61032 between the first compensation layer 61020a and second compensation
layer 61020b. The support tab 61026 can protrude from a longitudinal side of a first
compensation layer 61022a. Further, the support tab 61026 can extend along the length
of the longitudinal side or only along a portion thereof. Optionally, at least one
support tab 61026 can protrude from two longitudinal sides of the compensation layer
61022a, 61022b. Further, adjacently positioned compensation layers 61022a, 61022b
can comprise corresponding support tabs 60126, such that the support tab 60126 that
extends from the first compensation layer 60122a can at least partially align with
the support tab 60126 that extends from the second compensation layer 60122b. Referring
again to
FIG. 168, a tissue thickness compensator 60820 can comprise a limiter plate 60828 between adjacent
compensation layers 60122a, 60122b. The limiter plate 60828 can be positioned in the
gap 60132 defined between the first compensation layer 60122a and the second compensation
layer 60122b, for example. As described in greater detail herein, support tab(s) 61026
and / or limiter plate(s) 60828 can control the deformation and / or deflection of
a support 60124 and / or the compensation layers 60122a, 60122b.
[0473] As described herein, the compensation layers 60022 of the tissue thickness compensator
60020 can comprise different materials, geometries and / or dimensions. Such tissue
thickness compensators 60020 can be assembled by a variety of manufacturing techniques.
Referring primarily to
FIG. 159, the tissue thickness compensator 60022 can be manufactured by lithographic, stereolithographic
(SLA), or silk screening processes. For example, a stereolithographic manufacturing
process can create a tissue thickness compensator 60020 in which each compensation
layer 60022 comprises different materials and / or geometric features. For example,
an ultraviolet light in a stereolithography machine can draw the geometry of a first
compensation layer 60022, such that the first compensation layer 60022 comprising
a first material, geometry and / or dimensions is cured by the ultraviolet light.
The ultraviolet light can subsequently draw the geometry of a second compensation
layer 60022, such that the second compensation layer 60022 comprising a second material,
geometry and / or dimensions is cured by the ultraviolet light. According to the invention,
a stereolithography machine can draw compensation layers 60022 on top of each other,
side-by-side, or a combination thereof. Further, the compensation layers 60022 can
be drawn such that pockets 60132 exist between adjacent compensation layers 60022.
Because a stereolithography machine can create very thin layers having unique geometries,
a tissue thickness compensator 60020 manufactured by a stereolithographic process
can comprise a very complex three-dimensional geometry.
[0474] Referring to
FIG. 169, the tissue thickness compensator 60920 can be positioned in the end effector 12 of
a surgical instrument 10
(FIG. 1). The tissue thickness compensator 60920 can be positioned relative to the staple cartridge
20000 of the end effector 12. For example, the tissue thickness compensator 60920
can be releasably secured to the staple cartridge 20000. At least one compensation
layer 60922 of the tissue thickness compensator 60920 can be positioned adjacent to
the top deck surface 20011
(FIG. 79) of the staple cartridge 20000. For example, a second compensation layer 60922b can
be secured to the top deck surface 20011 by an adhesive or by a wrap, similar to at
least one of the wraps described herein
(FIG. 16). The tissue thickness compensator 60920 can be integral to the staple cartridge 20000
such that the staple cartridge 20000 and the tissue thickness compensator 60920 are
formed as a single unit construction. For example, the staple cartridge 20000 can
comprise a first body portion, such as the rigid support portion 20010
(FIG. 79), and a second body portion, such as the tissue thickness compensator 60920.
[0475] Still referring to
FIG. 169, the tissue thickness compensator 60920 can comprise a first compensator portion 60920a
and a second compensator portion 60920b. The first compensator portion 60920a can
be positioned on a first longitudinal side of the staple cartridge 20000 and the second
compensator portion 60920b can be positioned on a second longitudinal side of the
staple cartridge 20000. Optionally, when the tissue thickness compensator 60920 is
positioned relative to the staple cartridge 20000, the longitudinal slot 20015
(FIG. 78) in the rigid support portion 20010
(FIG. 78) can extend between the first compensator portion 60920a and the second compensator
portion 60920b. When the cutting element 20052 on the staple-firing sled 20050
(FIG. 78) translates through the end effector 12, the cutting element 20052 can pass through
the longitudinal slot 20015 between the first compensator portion 60920a and the second
compensator portion 60920b without severing a portion of the tissue thickness compensator
60920, for example. Alternatively, the cutting element 20052 can be configured to
sever a portion of the tissue thickness compensator 60920.
[0476] Referring now to
FIG. 162, a tissue thickness compensator 63020 can be configured to fit in the end effector
12' of a circular surgical instrument. The tissue thickness compensator 62030 can
comprise a circular first compensation layer 63022a and a circular second compensation
layer 63022b. The second compensation layer 63022b can be positioned on a circular
top deck surface 20011' of a circular staple cartridge 20000', wherein the second
compensation layer 63022b can comprise a geometry that corresponds to the geometry
of the deck surface 20011'. For example, the deck surface 20011' can comprise a stepped
portion and the second compensation layer 63022b can comprise a corresponding stepped
portion. The tissue thickness compensator can further comprise at least one support
63024 and / or support tabs 63026, for example, extending around the tissue thickness
compensator 63020.
[0477] Referring again to
FIG. 170, fired staples 30030 can be configured to engage the tissue thickness compensator
60920. As described throughout the present disclosure, a fired staple 30030 can capture
a portion of the tissue thickness compensator 60920 and tissue T and apply a compressive
force to the tissue thickness compensator 60920. Further, referring primarily to
FIGS. 171-173, the tissue thickness compensator 60920 can be deformable. Optionally, as described
herein, a first compensation layer 60920a can be separated from a second compensation
layer 60920b by a separation gap 60932. Referring to FIG. 171, prior to compression
of the tissue thickness compensator 60920, the gap 60932 can comprise a first distance.
When a compressive force A is applied to the tissue thickness compensator 60920 and
tissue T, for example, by a fired staple 30030
(FIG. 170), the support 60924 can be configured to deform. Referring now to
FIG. 172, the single-bend support beam 60924 can bend under the compressive force A such that
the separation gap 60932 between the first compensation layer 60920a and the second
compensation layer 60920b is reduced to a second distance. Referring primarily to
FIG. 173, the first and second compensation layers 60922a, 60922b can also deform under the
compressive force A. The support tabs 60926 can control deformation of the compensation
layers 60920. For example, the support tabs 60926 can prevent excessive bending of
the compensation layers 60920 by supporting the longitudinal sides of the compensation
layer 60920 when they come into contact with one another. The support tabs 60926 can
also be configured to bend or bow under the compressive force A. Additionally or alternatively,
the limiter plate 60128
(FIG. 168) described in greater detail herein, can limit the deformation of the compensation
layers 60920 when the compensation layers 60920 and / or support tabs 60926 contact
the limiter plate 60128.
[0478] Furthermore, similar to various tissue thickness compensators described herein, tissue
thickness compensator 60920 can generate a springback or restoring force when deformed.
The restoring force generated by the deformed tissue thickness compensator can at
least depend on the orientation, dimensions, material, and / or geometry of the tissue
thickness compensator 60920, as well as the amount of the tissue thickness compensator
60920 that is deformed by the applied force. Furthermore, at least a portion of the
tissue thickness compensator 60920 can be resilient such that the tissue thickness
compensator 60920 generates a spring load or restoring force when deformed by a fired
staple 30030. The support 60924 can comprise an elastic material and / or at least
one compensation layer 60922 can comprise an elastic material such that the tissue
thickness compensator 60920 is resilient.
[0479] Referring now to FIG. 175, an end effector of a surgical stapling instrument can
comprise a first jaw and a second jaw, wherein at least one of the first jaw and the
second jaw can be configured to be moved relative to the other. The end effector can
comprise a first jaw including a staple cartridge channel 19070 and a second jaw including
an anvil 19060, wherein the anvil 19060 can be pivoted toward and/or away from the
staple cartridge channel 19070, for example. The staple cartridge channel 19070 can
be configured to receive a staple cartridge 19000, for example, which, for example,
can be removably retained within the staple cartridge channel 19070. The staple cartridge
19000 can comprise a cartridge body 19010 and a tissue thickness compensator 19020
wherein, the tissue thickness compensator 19020 can be removably attached to the cartridge
body 19010. Referring now to FIG. 176, the cartridge body 19010 can comprise a plurality
of staple cavities 19012 and a staple 19030 positioned within each staple cavity 19012.
Also, the staples 19030 can be supported by staple drivers 19040 positioned within
the cartridge body 19010 wherein a sled and/or firing member, for example, can be
advanced through the staple cartridge 19000 to lift the staple drivers 19040 upwardly
within the staple cavities 19012, as illustrated in FIG. 177, and eject the staples
19030 from the staple cavities 19012.
[0480] Referring primarily to FIGS. 175 and 176, the tissue thickness compensator 19020
can comprise resilient members 19022 and a vessel 19024 encapsulating the resilient
members 19022. The vessel 19024 can be sealed and can define a cavity containing an
inner atmosphere having a pressure which is different than the surrounding atmospheric
pressure. The pressure of the inner atmosphere can be greater than the pressure of
the surrounding atmosphere while, alternatively, the pressure of the inner atmosphere
can be less than the pressure of the surrounding atmosphere. In the embodiments in
which the vessel 19024 contains a pressure less than the pressure of the surrounding
atmosphere, the sidewall of the vessel 19024 can enclose a vacuum. In such cases,
the vacuum can cause the vessel 19024 to distort, collapse, and/or flatten wherein
the resilient members 19022 positioned within the vessel 19024 can be resiliently
compressed within the vessel 19024. When a vacuum is drawn on the vessel 19024, the
resilient members 19022 can deflect or deform downwardly and can be held in position
by the sidewalls of the vessel 19024 in a compressed, or vacuum-packed, state.
[0481] Resilient member 19022 and vessel 19024 are comprised of biocompatible materials.
Optionally, resilient member 19022 and/or vessel 19024 can be comprised of bioabsorbable
materials such as PLLA, PGA, and/or PCL, for example. Resilient member 19022 can be
comprised of a resilient material. Resilient member 19022 can also comprise structural
resilience. For example, resilient member 19022 can be in the form of a hollow tube.
[0482] Further to the above, the tissue thickness compensator 19020 can be positioned against
or adjacent to the deck surface 19011 of the cartridge body 19010. When the staples
19030 are at least partially fired, referring now to FIG. 177, the legs of the staples
19030 can puncture or rupture the vessel 19024. The vessel 19024 can comprise a central
portion 19026 which can be positioned over a cutting slot 19016 of the cartridge body
19010 such that, when a cutting member 19080 is advanced to incise tissue T positioned
between the staple cartridge 19000 and the anvil 19060, the cutting member 19080 can
also incise the central portion 19026 of the vessel 19024 thereby puncturing or rupturing
the vessel 19024. In either event, once the vessel 19024 has been ruptured, the inner
atmosphere within the vessel 19024 can equalize with the atmosphere surrounding the
tissue thickness compensator 19020 and allow the resilient members 19022 to resiliently
expand to regain, or at least partially regain, their undistorted and/or unflattened
configuration. In such circumstances, the resilient members 19022 can apply a biasing
force to the tissue T captured within the deformed staples 19020. More specifically,
after being deformed by the forming surfaces of pockets 19062 defined in the anvil
19060, the legs of the staples 19030 can capture tissue T and at least a portion of
a resilient member 19022 within the staples 19030 such that, when the vessel 19024
ruptures, the tissue thickness compensator 19020 can compensate for the thickness
of the tissue T captured within the staples 19030. For instance, when the tissue T
captured within a staple 19030 is thinner, a resilient member 19022 captured within
that staple 19030 can expand to fill gaps within the staple 19030 and apply a sufficient
compression force to the tissue T. Correspondingly, when the tissue T captured within
a staple 19030 is thicker, a resilient member 19022 captured within that staple 19030
can remain compressed to make room for the thicker tissue within the staple 19030
and, likewise, apply a sufficient compression force to the tissue T.
[0483] When the vessel 19024 is punctured, as outlined above, the resilient members 19022
can expand in an attempt to resiliently return to their original configuration. In
certain circumstances, the portion of resilient members 19022 that have been captured
within the staples 19030 may not be able to return to their original undistorted shape.
In such circumstances, the resilient members 19022 can comprise a spring which can
apply a compression force to the tissue T captured within the staples 19030. According
to the invention, a resilient member 19022 can emulate a linear spring wherein the
compression force applied by the resilient member 19022 is linearly proportional to
the amount, or distance, in which the resilient member 19022 remains deflected within
the staple 19030. Alternatively, a resilient member 19022 can emulate a non-linear
spring wherein the compression force applied by the resilient member 19022 is not
linearly proportional to the amount, or distance, in which the resilient member 19022
remains deflected within the staple 19030.
[0484] Referring primarily to FIGS. 178 and 179, a staple cartridge 19200 can comprise a
tissue thickness compensator 19220 which can comprise one or more sealed vessels 19222
therein. Each of the vessels 19222 can be sealed and can contain an inner atmosphere.
The pressure of the inner atmosphere within a sealed vessel 19222 can exceed atmospheric
pressure while, the pressure of the inner atmosphere within a sealed vessel 19222
can be below atmospheric pressure. Where the pressure of the inner atmosphere within
a vessel 19222 is below atmospheric pressure, the vessel 19222 can be described as
containing a vacuum. Optionally, one or more of the vessels 19222 can be wrapped or
contained in an outer shroud, container, wrap, and/or film 19224, for example, wherein
the tissue thickness compensator 19220 can be positioned above a deck surface 19011
of the cartridge body 19010. Each vessel 19222 can be manufactured from a tube having
a circular, or an at least substantially circular, cross-section, for example, having
a closed end and an open end. A vacuum can be drawn on the open end of the tube and,
when a sufficient vacuum has been reached within the tube, the open end can be closed
and sealed. For example, the tube can be comprised of a polymeric material, for example,
wherein the open end of the tube can be heat staked in order to close and seal the
same. In any event, the vacuum within each vessel 19222 can pull the sidewalls of
the tube inwardly and resiliently distort and/or flatten the tube. The vessels 19222
are illustrated in an at least partially flattened state in FIG. 179.
[0485] When the staples 19030 are in their unfired position, as illustrated in FIG. 179,
the tips of the staples 19030 can be positioned below the tissue thickness compensator
19220. For example, the staples 19030 can be positioned within their respective staple
cavities 19012 such that the staples 19030 do not contact the vessels 19222 until
the staples 19030 are moved from the unfired positions, illustrated in FIG. 179, to
their fired positions, illustrated in FIG. 180. The wrap 19224 of the tissue thickness
compensator 19220 can protect the vessels 19220 from being prematurely punctured by
the staples 19030. When the staples 19030 are at least partially fired, referring
now to FIG. 180, the legs of the staples 19030 can puncture or rupture the vessels
19222. In such circumstances, the inner atmospheres within the vessels 19222 can equalize
with the atmosphere surrounding the vessels 19222 and resiliently expand to regain,
or at least partially regain, their undistorted and/or unflattened configuration.
In such circumstances, the punctured vessels 19222 can apply a biasing force to the
tissue captured within the deformed staples 19030. More specifically, after being
deformed by the forming surfaces of pockets 19062 defined in the anvil 19060, the
legs of the staples 19030 can capture tissue T and at least a portion of a vessel
19222 within the staples 19030 such that, when the vessels 19222 rupture, the vessels
19222 can compensate for the thickness of the tissue T captured within the staples
19030. For instance, when the tissue T captured within a staple 19030 is thinner,
a vessel 19222 captured within that staple 19030 can expand to fill gaps within the
staple 19030 and, concurrently, apply a sufficient compression force to the tissue
T. Correspondingly, when the tissue T captured within a staple 19030 is thicker, a
vessel 19222 captured within that staple 19030 can remain compressed to make room
for the thicker tissue within the staple 19030 and, concurrently, apply a sufficient
compression force to the tissue T.
[0486] When the vessels 19222 are punctured, as outlined above, the vessels 19222 can expand
in an attempt to resiliently return to their original configuration. The portion of
vessels 19222 that have captured within the staples 19030 may not be able to return
to their original undistorted shape. In such circumstances, the vessel 19222 can comprise
a spring which can apply a compression force to the tissue T captured within the staples
19030. According to the invention, a vessel 19222 can emulate a linear spring wherein
the compression force applied by the vessel 19222 is linearly proportional to the
amount, or distance, in which the vessel 19222 remains deflected within the staple
19030. Alternatively, a vessel 19222 can emulate a non-linear spring wherein the compression
force applied by the vessel 19222 is not linearly proportional to the amount, or distance,
in which the vessel 19222 remains deflected within the staple 19030. The vessels 19222
can be hollow and, empty when they are in their sealed configuration. Alternatively,
each of the vessels 19222 can define a cavity and can further include at least one
medicament contained therein. The vessels 19222 can be comprised of at least one medicament
which can be released and/or bioabsorbed, for example.
[0487] The vessels 19222 of the tissue thickness compensator 19220 can be arranged in any
suitable manner. As illustrated in FIG. 178, the staple cavities 19012 defined in
the cartridge body 19010, and the staples 19030 positioned in the staple cavities
19012, can be arranged in rows. As illustrated, the staple cavities 19012 can be arranged
in six longitudinal, linear rows, for example; however, any suitable arrangement of
staple cavities 19012 could be utilized. As also illustrated in FIG. 178, the tissue
thickness compensator 19220 can comprise six vessels 19222 wherein each of the vessels
19222 can be aligned with, or positioned over, a row of staple cavities 19012. Each
of the staples 19030 within a row of staple cavities 19012 can be configured to puncture
the same vessel 19222. In certain situations, some of the staple legs of the staples
19030 may not puncture the vessel 19222 positioned thereover; however, where the vessel
19222 defines a continuous internal cavity, for example, the cavity can be sufficiently
punctured by at least one of the staples 19030 in order to allow the pressure of the
internal cavity atmosphere to equalize with the atmospheric pressure surrounding the
vessel 19222. Referring now to FIG. 185, a tissue thickness compensator can comprise
a vessel, such as vessel 19222', for example, which can extend in a direction which
is transverse to a line of staples 19030. For example, a vessel 19222' can extend
across multiple staple rows. Referring now to FIG. 186, a tissue thickness compensator
19220" can comprise a plurality of vessels 19222" which extend in a direction which
is perpendicular, or at least substantially perpendicular, to a line of staples 19030.
For example, some of the vessels 19222" may be punctured by the staples 19030 while
others may not be punctured by the staples 19030. The vessels 19222" can extend across
or through a cutting path in which a cutting member could transect and rupture the
vessels 19222", for example.
[0488] Optionally, as described above, a tissue thickness compensator, such as tissue thickness
compensator 19220, for example, can comprise a plurality of sealed vessels, such as
vessels 19222, for example. As also described above, each of the sealed vessels 19222
can comprise a separate internal atmosphere. The vessels 19222 can have different
internal pressures. For example, a first vessel 19222 can comprise an internal vacuum
having a first pressure and a second vessel 19222 can comprise an internal vacuum
having a second, different pressure, for example. For example, the amount of distortion
or flattening of a vessel 19222 can be a function of the vacuum pressure of the internal
atmosphere contained therein. For instance, a vessel 19222 having a greater vacuum
can be distorted or flattened a greater amount as compared to a vessel 19222 having
a smaller vacuum. The cavity of a vessel can be segmented into two or more separate,
sealed cavities wherein each separate, sealed cavity can comprise a separate internal
atmosphere. For example, some of the staples within a staple row can be configured
and arranged to puncture a first cavity defined in the vessel while other staples
within the staple row can be configured and arranged to puncture a second cavity defined
in the vessel, for example. In such cases, especially in embodiments in which the
staples in a staple row are sequentially fired from one end of the staple row to the
other, as described above, one of the cavities can remain intact and can maintain
its internal atmosphere when another cavity is ruptured. The first cavity can have
an inner atmosphere having a first vacuum pressure and the second cavity can have
an inner atmosphere having a second, different vacuum pressure, for example. According
to the invention, a cavity that remains intact can maintain its inner pressure until
the vessel is bioabsorbed thereby creating a timed pressure release.
[0489] Referring now to FIGS. 181 and 182, a tissue thickness compensator, such as tissue
thickness compensator 19120, for example, can be attached to an anvil 19160. Similar
to the above, the tissue thickness compensator 19120 can comprise a vessel 19124 and
a plurality of resilient members 19122 positioned therein. Also similar to the above,
the vessel 19124 can define a cavity containing an inner atmosphere having a pressure
which is less than or greater than the pressure of the atmosphere surrounding the
tissue thickness compensator 19120. Where the inner atmosphere within the vessel 19124
comprises a vacuum, the vessel 19124 and the resilient members 19122 positioned therein
can be distorted, collapsed, and/or flattened by the difference in pressure between
the vacuum in the vessel 19124 and the atmospheric pressure outside of the vessel
19124. In use, the anvil 19160 can be moved into a closed position in which it is
positioned opposite a staple cartridge 19100 and in which a tissue engaging surface
19121 on the vessel 19124 can engage the tissue T positioned intermediate the tissue
thickness compensator 19120 and a staple cartridge 19100. In use, the firing member
19080 can be advanced distally to fire the staples 19030, as described above, and,
at the same time, incise the tissue T. The tissue thickness compensator 19120 can
further comprise an intermediate portion 19126 which can be aligned with a cutting
slot defined in the anvil 19160 wherein, when the firing member 19080 is advanced
distally through the tissue thickness compensator 19120, the firing member 19080 can
puncture or rupture the vessel 19124. Also, similar to the above, the firing member
19080 can lift the staple drivers 19040 upwardly and fire the staples 19030 such that
the staples 19030 can contact the anvil 19160 and be deformed into their deformed
configuration, as illustrated in FIG. 183. When the staples 19030 are fired, the staples
19030 can pierce the tissue T and then pierce or rupture the vessel 19124 such that
the resilient members 19122 positioned within the vessel 19124 can at least partially
expand, as outlined above.
[0490] Further to the above, a tissue thickness compensator can be comprised of a biocompatible
material. The biocompatible material, such as, a foam, may comprise tackifiers, surfactants,
fillers, cross-linkers, pigments, dyes, antioxidants and other stabilizers and/or
combinations thereof to provide desired properties to the material. A biocompatible
foam may comprise a surfactant. The surfactant may be applied to the surface of the
material and/or dispersed within the material. Without wishing to be bound to any
particular theory, the surfactant applied to the biocompatible material may reduce
the surface tension of the fluids contacting the material. For example, the surfactant
may reduce the surface tension of water contacting the material to accelerate the
penetration of water into the material. The water may act as a catalyst. The surfactant
may increase the hydrophilicity of the material.
[0491] The surfactant may comprise an anionic surfactant, a cationic surfactant, and/or
a nonionic surfactant. Examples surfactants include, but are not limited to polyacrylic
acid, methalose, methyl cellulose, ethyl cellulose, propyl cellulose, hydroxy ethyl
cellulose, carboxy methyl cellulose, polyoxyethylene cetyl ether, polyoxyethylene
lauryl ether, polyoxyethylene octyl ether, polyoxyethylene octylphenyl ether, polyoxyethylene
oleyl ether, polyoxyethylene sorbitan monolaurate, polyoxyethylene stearyl ether,
polyoxyethylene nonylphenyl ether, dialkylphenoxy poly(ethyleneoxy) ethanol, and polyoxamers,
and combinations thereof. The surfactant may comprise a copolymer of polyethylene
glycol and polypropylene glycol. The surfactant may comprise a phospholipid surfactant.
The phospholipid surfactant may provide antibacterial stabilizing properties and/or
disperse other materials in the biocompatible material.
The tissue thickness compensator may comprise at least one medicament. The tissue
thickness compensator may comprise one or more of the natural materials, non-synthetic
materials, and/or synthetic materials described herein. The tissue thickness compensator
may comprise a biocompatible foam comprising gelatin, collagen, hyaluronic acid, oxidized
regenerated cellulose, polyglycolic acid, polycaprolactone, polyactic acid, polydioxanone,
polyhydroxyalkanoate, poliglecaprone, and combinations thereof. The tissue thickness
compensator may comprise a film comprising the at least one medicament. The tissue
thickness compensator may comprise a biodegradable film comprising the at least one
medicament. The medicament may comprise a liquid, gel, and/or powder. The medicaments
may comprise anticancer agents, such as, for example, cisplatin, mitomycin, and/or
adriamycin.
[0492] The tissue thickness compensator may comprise a biodegradable material to provide
controlled elution of the at least one medicament as the biodegradable material degrades.
The biodegradable material may degrade may decompose, or loses structural integrity,
when the biodegradable material contacts an activator, such as, for example an activator
fluid. The activator fluid may comprise saline or any other electrolyte solution,
for example. The biodegradable material may contact the activator fluid by conventional
techniques, including, but not limited to spraying, dipping, and/or brushing. In use,
for example, a surgeon may dip an end effector and/or a staple cartridge comprising
the tissue thickness compensator comprising the at least one medicament into an activator
fluid comprising a salt solution, such as sodium chloride, calcium chloride, and/or
potassium chloride. The tissue thickness compensator may release the medicament as
the tissue thickness compensator degrades. The elution of the medicament from the
tissue thickness compensator may be characterized by a rapid initial elution rate
and a slower sustained elution rate.
[0493] According to the invention, a tissue thickness compensator, for example, can be comprised
of a biocompatible material which may comprise an oxidizing agent. The oxidizing agent
may an organic peroxide and/or an inorganic peroxide. Examples of oxidizing agents
may include, but are not limited to, hydrogen peroxide, urea peroxide, calcium peroxide,
and magnesium peroxide, and sodium percarbonate. The oxidizing agent may comprise
peroxygen-based oxidizing agents and hypohalite-based oxidizing agents, such as, for
example, hydrogen peroxide, hypochlorous acid, hypochlorites, hypocodites, and percarbonates.
The oxidizing agent may comprise alkali metal chlorites, hypochlorites and perborates,
such as, for example, sodium chlorite, sodium hypochlorite and sodium perborate. The
oxidizing agent may comprise vanadate. The oxidizing agent may comprise ascorbic acid.
The oxidizing agent may comprise an active oxygen generator. According to the invention,
a tissue scaffold may comprise the biocompatible material comprising an oxidizing
agent.
[0494] The biocompatible material may comprise a liquid, gel, and/or powder. The oxidizing
agent may comprise microparticles and/or nanoparticles, for example. For example,
the oxidizing agent may be milled into microparticles and/or nanoparticles. The oxidizing
agent may be incorporated into the biocompatible material by suspending the oxidizing
agent in a polymer solution. The oxidizing agent may be incorporated into the biocompatible
material during the lyophylization process. After lyophylization, the oxidizing agent
may be attached to the cell walls of the biocompatible material to interact with the
tissue upon contact. The oxidizing agent may not be chemically bonded to the biocompatible
material. A percarbonate dry power may be embedded within a biocompatible foam to
provide a prolonged biological effect by the slow release of oxygen. A percarbonate
dry power may be embedded within a polymeric fiber in a non-woven structure to provide
a prolonged biological effect by the slow release of oxygen. The biocompatible material
may comprise an oxidizing agent and a medicament, such as, for example, doxycycline
and ascorbic acid.
[0495] The biocompatible material may comprise a rapid release oxidizing agent and/or a
slower sustained release oxidizing agent. The elution of the oxidizing agent from
the biocompatible material may be characterized by a rapid initial elution rate and
a slower sustained elution rate. The oxidizing agent may generate oxygen when the
oxidizing agent contacts bodily fluid, such as, for example, water. Examples of bodily
fluids may include, but are not limited to, blood, plasma, peritoneal fluid, cerebral
spinal fluid, urine, lymph fluid, synovial fluid, vitreous fluid, saliva, gastrointestinal
luminal contents, and/or bile. Without wishing to be bound to any particular theory,
the oxidizing agent may reduce cell death, enhance tissue viability and/or maintain
the mechanical strength of the tissue to tissue that may be damaged during cutting
and/or stapling.
The biocompatible material may comprise at least one microparticle and/or nanoparticle.
The biocompatible material may comprise one or more of the natural materials, non-synthetic
materials, and synthetic materials described herein. The biocompatible material may
comprise particles having a mean diameter of about 10 nm to about 100 nm and/or about
10 µm to about 100 µm, such as, for example, 45-50 nm and/or 45-50 µm. The biocompatible
material may comprise biocompatible foam comprising at least one microparticle and/or
nanoparticle embedded therein. The microparticle and/or nanoparticle may not be chemically
bonded to the biocompatible material. The microparticle and/or nanoparticle may provide
controlled release of the medicament. The microparticle and/or nanoparticle may comprise
at least one medicament. The microparticle and/or nanoparticle may comprise a hemostatic
agent, an anti-microbial agent, and/or an oxidizing agent, for example. The tissue
thickness compensator may comprise a biocompatible foam comprising an hemostatic agent
comprising oxidized regenerated cellulose, an anti-microbial agent comprising doxycline
and/or Gentamicin, and/or an oxidizing agent comprising a percarbant. The microparticle
and/or nanoparticle may provide controlled release of the medicament up to three days,
for example.
[0496] The microparticle and/or nanoparticle may be embedded in the biocompatible material
during a manufacturing process. For example, a biocompatible polymer, such as, for
example, a PGA/PCL, may contact a solvent, such as, for example, dioxane to form a
mixture. The biocompatible polymer may be ground to form particles. Dry particles,
with or without ORC particles, may be contacted with the mixture to form a suspension.
The suspension may be lyophilized to form a biocompatible foam comprising PGA/PCL
having dry particles and/or ORC particles embedded therein.
[0497] The tissue thickness compensators or layers disclosed herein can be comprised of
an absorbable polymer, for example. A tissue thickness compensator can be comprised
of foam, film, fibrous woven, fibrous non-woven PGA, PGA/PCL (Poly( glycolic acid-co-caprolactone)),
PLA/PCL (Poly( lactic acid-co- polycaprolactone)), PLLA/PCL, PGA/TMC (Poly(glycolic
acid-co-trimethylene carbonate)), PDS, PEPBO or other absorbable polyurethane, polyester,
polycarbonate, Polyorthoesters, Polyanhydrides, Polyesteramides, and/or Polyoxaesters,
for example. According to the invention, a tissue thickness compensator can be comprised
of PGA/PLA (Poly(glycolic acid-co-lactic acid)) and/or PDS/PLA (Poly(p-dioxanone-co-lactic
acid)), for example. According to the invention, a tissue thickness compensator can
be comprised of an organic material, for example. A tissue thickness compensator can
be comprised of Carboxymethyl Cellulose, Sodium Alginate, Cross-linked Hyaluronic
Acid, and/or Oxidized regenerated cellulose, for example. According to the invention,
a tissue thickness compensator can comprise a durometer in the 3-7 Shore A (30-50
Shore OO) ranges with a maximum stiffness of 15 Shore A (65 Shore OO), for example.
A tissue thickness compensator can undergo 40% compression under 3 lbf load, 60% compression
under 6 lbf load, and/or 80% compression under 20 lbf load, for example. One or more
gasses, such as air, nitrogen, carbon dioxide, and/or oxygen, for example, can be
bubbled through and/or contained within the tissue thickness compensator. A tissue
thickness compensator can comprise beads therein which comprise between approximately
50% and approximately 75% of the material stiffness comprising the tissue thickness
compensator.
[0498] According to the invention, a tissue thickness compensator can comprise hyaluronic
acid, nutrients, fibrin, thrombin, platelet rich plasma, Sulfasalazine (Azulfidine®
- 5ASA+Sulfapyridine diazo bond))- prodrug - colonic bacterial (Azoreductase), Mesalamine
(5ASA with different prodrug configurations for delayed release), asacol® (5ASA +
Eudragit-S coated - pH > 7 (coating dissolution)), Pentasa® (5ASA + ethylcellulose
coated - time/pH dependent slow release), Mesasal® (5ASA + Eudragit-L coated - pH
> 6), Olsalazine (5ASA + 5ASA - colonic bacterial (Azoreductase)), Balsalazide (5ASA
+ 4Aminobenzoyl-B-alanine) - colonic bacterial (Azoreductase)), Granulated mesalamine,
Lialda (delay and SR formulation of mesalamine), HMPL-004 (herbal mixture that may
inhibit TNF-alpha, interleukin-l beta, and nuclear-kappa B activation), CCX282-B (oral
chemokine receptor antagonist that interferes with trafficking of T lymphocytes into
the intestinal mucosa), Rifaximin (nonabsorbable broad-spectrum antibiotic ), Infliximab,
murine chymieric (monoclonal antibody directed against TNF-alpha-approved for reducing
signs/symptoms and maintaining clinical remission in adult/pediatric patients with
moderate/severe luminal and fistulizing Crohn's disease who have had inadequate response
to conventional therapy), adalimumab, Total Human IgG1 (anti-TNF-alpha monoclonal
antibody - approved for reducing signs/symptoms of Crohn's disease, and for the induction
and maintenance of clinical remission in adult patients with moderate/severe active
Crohn's disease with inadequate response to conventional therapies, or who become
intolerant to Infliximab), Certolizumab pegoll, humanized anti-TNF FAB' (monoclonal
antibody fragment linked to polyethylene glycol - approved for reducing signs/symptoms
of Crohn's disease and for the induction and maintenance of response in adult patients
w/ moderate/severe disease with inadequate response to conventional therapies), Natalizumab,
First non-TNF-alpha inhibitor (biologic compound approved for Crohn's disease), Humanized
monoclonal IgG4 antibody (directed against alpha-4 integrin - FDA approved for inducing
and maintaining clinical response and remission in patients with moderate/severe disease
with evidence of inflammation and who have had inadequate response to or are unable
to tolerate conventional Crohn's therapies and inhibitors of TNF-alpha), concomitant
Immunomodulators potentially given with Infliximab, azathioprine 6-Mercaptopurine
(purine synthesis inhibitor - prodrug), Methotrexate (binds dihydrofolate reductase
(DHFR) enzyme that participates in tetrahydrofolate synthesis, inhibits all purine
synthesis), allopurinol and Thioprine therapy, PPI, H2 for acid suppression to protect
the healing line, C-Diff - Flagyl, Vancomycin (fecal translocation treatment; probiotics;
repopulation of normal endoluminal flora), and/or Rifaximin (treatment of bacterial
overgrowth (notably hepatic encephalopahy); not absorbed in GI tract with action on
intraluminal bacteria), for example.
[0499] As described herein, a tissue thickness compensator can compensate for variations
in the thickness of tissue that is captured within the staples ejected from a staple
cartridge and/or contained within a staple line, for example. Stated another way,
certain staples within a staple line can capture thick portions of the tissue while
other staples within the staple line can capture thin portions of the tissue. In such
circumstances, the tissue thickness compensator can assume different heights or thicknesses
within the staples and apply a compressive force to the tissue captured within the
staples regardless of whether the captured tissue is thick or thin. According to the
invention, a tissue thickness compensator can compensate for variations in the hardness
of the tissue. For instance, certain staples within a staple line can capture highly
compressible portions of the tissue while other staples within the staple line can
capture portions of the tissue which are less compressible. In such circumstances,
the tissue thickness compensator can be configured to assume a smaller height within
the staples that have captured tissue having a lower compressibility, or higher hardness,
and, correspondingly, a larger height within the staples that have captured tissue
having a higher compressibility, or lower hardness, for example. In any event, a tissue
thickness compensator, regardless of whether it compensates for variations in tissue
thickness and/or variations in tissue hardness, for example, can be referred to as
a 'tissue compensator' and/or as a 'compensator', for example.
[0500] The devices disclosed herein can be designed to be disposed of after a single use,
or they can be designed to be used multiple times. In either case, however, the device
can be reconditioned for reuse after at least one use. Reconditioning can include
any combination of the steps of disassembly of the device, followed by cleaning or
replacement of particular pieces, and subsequent reassembly. In particular, the device
can be disassembled, and any number of the particular pieces or parts of the device
can be selectively replaced or removed in any combination. Upon cleaning and/or replacement
of particular parts, the device can be reassembled for subsequent use either at a
reconditioning facility, or by a surgical team immediately prior to a surgical procedure.
Those skilled in the art will appreciate that reconditioning of a device can utilize
a variety of techniques for disassembly, cleaning/replacement, and reassembly. Use
of such techniques, and the resulting reconditioned device, are all within the scope
of the present application.
[0501] Preferably, the invention described herein will be processed before surgery. First,
a new or used instrument is obtained and if necessary cleaned. The instrument can
then be sterilized. In one sterilization technique, the instrument is placed in a
closed and sealed container, such as a plastic or TYVEK bag. The container and instrument
are then placed in a field of radiation that can penetrate the container, such as
gamma radiation, x-rays, or high-energy electrons. The radiation kills bacteria on
the instrument and in the container. The sterilized instrument can then be stored
in the sterile container. The sealed container keeps the instrument sterile until
it is opened in the medical facility.
[0502] Any patent, publication, or other disclosure material, in whole or in part, that
is said to be incorporated by reference herein is incorporated herein only to the
extent that the incorporated materials does not conflict with existing definitions,
statements, or other disclosure material set forth in this disclosure. As such, and
to the extent necessary, the disclosure as explicitly set forth herein supersedes
any conflicting material incorporated herein by reference. Any material, or portion
thereof, that is said to be incorporated by reference herein, but which conflicts
with existing definitions, statements, or other disclosure material set forth herein
will only be incorporated to the extent that no conflict arises between that incorporated
material and the existing disclosure material.
[0503] While this invention has been described as having exemplary designs, the present
invention may be further modified within the spirit and scope of the disclosure. This
application is therefore intended to cover any variations, uses, or adaptations of
the invention using its general principles. Further, this application is intended
to cover such departures from the present disclosure as come within known or customary
practice in the art to which this invention pertains.